Clarify command loop's role in undo boundary (Bug#2433).
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / misc / gnus.texi
CommitLineData
4009494e
GM
1\input texinfo
2
db78a8cb 3@setfilename ../../info/gnus
4009494e
GM
4@settitle Gnus Manual
5@syncodeindex fn cp
6@syncodeindex vr cp
7@syncodeindex pg cp
8
01c52d31
MB
9@documentencoding ISO-8859-1
10
4009494e 11@copying
e3e955fe 12Copyright @copyright{} 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
c57008f6 132003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4009494e
GM
14
15@quotation
16Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
6a2c4aec 17under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
4009494e 18any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
debf4439
GM
19Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual'',
20and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
21is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
4009494e 22
6f093307
GM
23(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
24modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
25developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
4009494e
GM
26@end quotation
27@end copying
28
29@iftex
30@iflatex
31\documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
32\usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
33\usepackage{pagestyle}
34\usepackage{epsfig}
35\usepackage{pixidx}
36\input{gnusconfig.tex}
37
38\ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
39\else
40\usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
41\usepackage{thumbpdf}
42\pdfcompresslevel=9
43\fi
44
45\makeindex
46\begin{document}
47
48% Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
c7ff939a 49\newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.13}
4009494e
GM
50\newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
51\newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
52
53\newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
54
55\newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
56\ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
57\newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
58\else
59\newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
60\fi
61\newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
62\newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
63
64\newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
65\newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
66
67\newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
68\newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
69\newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
70\newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
71\newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
72\newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73\newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
74\newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75\newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
76\newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
77\newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
78\newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
79\newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
80\newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
81\newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
82\newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83\newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
84\newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
85\newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
86\newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
87\newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
88\newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
89\newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
90\newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
91
92\newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
93\newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
94\newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
95\newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
96\newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
97\newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
98\newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
99\newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
100\newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
101\newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
102\newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
103\newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
104\newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
105
106\newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
107\newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
108\marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
109}
110
111\newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
112
113\newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
114{\mbox{}}
115}
116
117\newdimen{\gnusdimen}
118\gnusdimen 0pt
119
120\newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
121\gnuscleardoublepage
122\ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
123\chapter{#2}
124\renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
125\renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
126\thispagestyle{empty}
127\hspace*{-2cm}
128\begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
129\put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
130\put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
131\end{picture}
132\clearpage
133}
134
135\newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
136\begin{figure}
137\mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
138#3
139\end{picture}
140\caption{#1}
141\end{figure}
142}
143
144\newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
145\marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
146}
147
148\newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
149\margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
150}
151
152\newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
153\margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
154}
155
156\newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
157\margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
158}
159
160\newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
161
162\newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
163\renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
164\section{#1}
165}
166
167\newenvironment{codelist}%
168{\begin{list}{}{
169}
170}{\end{list}}
171
172\newenvironment{asislist}%
173{\begin{list}{}{
174}
175}{\end{list}}
176
177\newenvironment{kbdlist}%
178{\begin{list}{}{
179\labelwidth=0cm
180}
181}{\end{list}}
182
183\newenvironment{dfnlist}%
184{\begin{list}{}{
185}
186}{\end{list}}
187
188\newenvironment{stronglist}%
189{\begin{list}{}{
190}
191}{\end{list}}
192
193\newenvironment{samplist}%
194{\begin{list}{}{
195}
196}{\end{list}}
197
198\newenvironment{varlist}%
199{\begin{list}{}{
200}
201}{\end{list}}
202
203\newenvironment{emphlist}%
204{\begin{list}{}{
205}
206}{\end{list}}
207
208\newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
209\setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
210\addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
211
212\newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
213{
214{
215\ifodd\count0
216{
217\hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
218}
219\else
220{
221\hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
222}
223}
224\fi
225}
226}
227{
228\ifodd\count0
229\mbox{} \hfill
230\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
231\else
232\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
233\hfill \mbox{}
234\fi
235}
236
237\newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
238{
239{
240\ifodd\count0
241{
242\hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
243}
244\else
245{
246\hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
247}
248\fi
249}
250}
251{
252\ifodd\count0
253\mbox{} \hfill
254\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
255\else
256\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
257\hfill \mbox{}
258\fi
259}
260
261\newpagestyle{gnus}%
262{
263{
264\ifodd\count0
265{
266\makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
267}
268\else
269{
270\makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
271}
272\fi
273}
274}
275{
276\ifodd\count0
277\mbox{} \hfill
278\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
279\else
280\raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
281\hfill \mbox{}
282\fi
283}
284
285\pagenumbering{roman}
286\pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
287
288@end iflatex
289@end iftex
290
291@iftex
292@iflatex
293
294\begin{titlepage}
295{
296
297%\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
298%\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
299\parindent=0cm
300\addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
301
302\gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
303\rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
304\vfill
305\hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
306\vfill
307\rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
308\gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
309\newpage
310}
311
312\mbox{}
313\vfill
314
315\thispagestyle{empty}
316
317@c @insertcopying
318\newpage
319\end{titlepage}
320@end iflatex
321@end iftex
322
4009494e
GM
323@dircategory Emacs
324@direntry
62e034c2 325* Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
4009494e
GM
326@end direntry
327@iftex
328@finalout
329@end iftex
4009494e
GM
330
331
332@titlepage
333@title Gnus Manual
334
335@author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
336@page
337@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
338@insertcopying
339@end titlepage
340
5dc584b5
KB
341@summarycontents
342@contents
4009494e
GM
343
344@node Top
345@top The Gnus Newsreader
346
347@ifinfo
348
349You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
350can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
351spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
352luck.
353
354@c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
c7ff939a 355This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
4009494e 356
5dc584b5
KB
357@ifnottex
358@insertcopying
359@end ifnottex
360
4009494e
GM
361@end ifinfo
362
363@iftex
364
365@iflatex
366\tableofcontents
367\gnuscleardoublepage
368@end iflatex
369
370Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
371unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
372
373Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
374being accused of plagiarism:
375
376Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
377about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
378you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
379can even read news with it!
380
381Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
382people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
383allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
384like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
385people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
386the program.
387
9b3ebcb6 388@c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
2e4089ab 389This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
9b3ebcb6
MB
390
391@heading Other related manuals
392@itemize
393@item Message manual: Composing messages
394@item Emacs-MIME: Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
395@item Sieve: Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
396@item PGG: @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
2e4089ab 397@item SASL: @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
9b3ebcb6
MB
398@end itemize
399
4009494e
GM
400@end iftex
401
402@menu
403* Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
404* Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
405* Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
406* Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
407* Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
408* Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
409* Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
410* Various:: General purpose settings.
411* The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
412* Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
413* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
414* Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
415* Key Index:: Key Index.
416
417Other related manuals
418
419* Message:(message). Composing messages.
420* Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
421* Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
422* PGG:(pgg). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
01c52d31 423* SASL:(sasl). @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
4009494e
GM
424
425@detailmenu
426 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
427
428Starting Gnus
429
430* Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
431* The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
432* The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
433* Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
434* Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
435* New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
436* Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
437* Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
438* Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
439* The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
440* Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
441
442New Groups
443
444* Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
445* Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
446* Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
447
448Group Buffer
449
450* Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
451* Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
452* Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
453* Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
454* Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
455* Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
456* Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
457* Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
458* Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
459* Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
460* Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
461* Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
462* Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
463* Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
464* Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
465* Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
01c52d31 466* Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
4009494e
GM
467* Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
468
469Group Buffer Format
470
471* Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
472* Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
473* Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
474
475Group Topics
476
477* Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
478* Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
479* Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
480* Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
481* Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
482
483Misc Group Stuff
484
485* Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
486* Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
487* Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
488* File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
489* Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
490
491Summary Buffer
492
493* Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
494* Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
495* Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
496* Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
497* Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
498* Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
499* Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
500* Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
501* Threading:: How threads are made.
502* Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
503* Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
504* Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
505* Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
01c52d31 506* Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4009494e
GM
507* Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
508* Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
509* Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
510* Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
511* MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
512* Charsets:: Character set issues.
513* Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
514* Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
515* Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
516* Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
517* Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
518* Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
519* Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
520* Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
521 or reselecting the current group.
522* Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
523* Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
524* Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
525* Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
526
527Summary Buffer Format
528
529* Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
530* To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
531* Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
532* Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
533
534Choosing Articles
535
536* Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
537* Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
538
539Reply, Followup and Post
540
541* Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
542* Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
543* Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
544* Canceling and Superseding::
545
546Marking Articles
547
548* Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
549* Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
550* Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
551* Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
552* Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
553* Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
554
555Threading
556
557* Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
558* Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
559
560Customizing Threading
561
562* Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
563* Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
564* More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
565* Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
566
567Decoding Articles
568
569* Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
570* Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
571* PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
572* Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
573* Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
574* Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
575
576Decoding Variables
577
578* Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
579* Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
580* Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
581
582Article Treatment
583
584* Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
585* Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
586* Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
587* Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
588* Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
589* Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
590* Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
591* Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
592* Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
593* Article Signature:: What is a signature?
594* Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
595
596Alternative Approaches
597
598* Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
599* Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
600
601Various Summary Stuff
602
603* Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
604* Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
605* Summary Generation Commands::
606* Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
607
608Article Buffer
609
610* Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
611* Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
612* Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
613* Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
614* Misc Article:: Other stuff.
615
616Composing Messages
617
618* Mail:: Mailing and replying.
619* Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
620* POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
621* Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
622* Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
623* Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
624* Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
625* Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
626* Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
627
628Select Methods
629
630* Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
631* Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
632* Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
633* Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
634* IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
635* Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
636* Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
637* Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
638* Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
639
640Server Buffer
641
642* Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
643* Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
644* Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
645* Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
646* Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
647* Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
648* Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
649
650Getting News
651
652* NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
653* News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
654
655@acronym{NNTP}
656
657* Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
658* Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
659* Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
01c52d31 660* NNTP marks:: Storing marks for @acronym{NNTP} servers.
4009494e
GM
661
662Getting Mail
663
664* Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
665* Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
666* Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
667* Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
668* Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
669* Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
670* Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
671* Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
672* Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
673* Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
674* Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
675* Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
676* Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
677
678Mail Sources
679
680* Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
681* Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
682* Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
683
684Choosing a Mail Back End
685
686* Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
bc79f9ab 687* Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
4009494e
GM
688* Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
689* MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
690* Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
691* Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
692* Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
693
694Browsing the Web
695
696* Archiving Mail::
697* Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
698* Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
699* Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
700* Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
701* RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
702* Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
703
704@acronym{IMAP}
705
706* Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
707* Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
708* Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
709* Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
710* A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
711* Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
712
713Other Sources
714
715* Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
716* Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
717* Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
718* SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
719* Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
720
721Document Groups
722
723* Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
724
725SOUP
726
727* SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
728* SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
729* SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
730
731Combined Groups
732
733* Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
734* Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
735
736Email Based Diary
737
738* The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
739* The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
740* Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
741
742The NNDiary Back End
743
744* Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
745* Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
746* Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
747
748The Gnus Diary Library
749
750* Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
751* Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
752* Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
753* Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
754
755Gnus Unplugged
756
757* Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
758* Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
759* Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
760* Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
761* Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
762* Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
763* Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
01c52d31 764* Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
4009494e
GM
765* Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
766* Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
767* Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
768* Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
769* Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
770* Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
771
772Agent Categories
773
774* Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
775* Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
776* Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
777
778Agent Commands
779
780* Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
781* Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
782* Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
783
784Scoring
785
786* Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
787* Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
788* Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
789* Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
790* Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
791* Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
792* Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
793* Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
794* Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
795* Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
796* Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
797* Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
798* Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
799* Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
4009494e
GM
800* Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
801* Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
802
4009494e
GM
803Advanced Scoring
804
805* Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
806* Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
807* Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
808
809Various
810
811* Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
812* Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
813* Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
814* Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
815* Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
816* Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
817* Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
818* Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
819* Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
820* Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
821* Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
822* NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
823* Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
824* Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
825* Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
826* Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
827* Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
828* Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
829* Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
64763fe3 830* The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
4009494e
GM
831* Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
832* Various Various:: Things that are really various.
833
834Formatting Variables
835
836* Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
837* Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
838* Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
839* User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
840* Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
841* Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
842* Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
843* Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
844
845Image Enhancements
846
847* X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
848* Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
849* Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
850 meant to be shown.
851* Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
852* XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
853
854Thwarting Email Spam
855
856* The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
857* Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
858* SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
859* Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
860
861Spam Package
862
863* Spam Package Introduction::
864* Filtering Incoming Mail::
865* Detecting Spam in Groups::
866* Spam and Ham Processors::
867* Spam Package Configuration Examples::
868* Spam Back Ends::
869* Extending the Spam package::
870* Spam Statistics Package::
871
872Spam Statistics Package
873
874* Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
875* Splitting mail using spam-stat::
876* Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
877
878Appendices
879
880* XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
881* History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
882* On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
883* Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
884* Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
885* Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
886* Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
887* Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
888* Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
889
890History
891
892* Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
893* Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
894* Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
895* Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
896* Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
897* Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
898* Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
899* Contributors:: Oodles of people.
900* New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
901
902New Features
903
904* ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
905* September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
906* Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
907* Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
908* Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
909* Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
01c52d31 910* No Gnus:: Very punny.
4009494e
GM
911
912Customization
913
914* Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
915* Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
916* Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
917* Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
918
919Gnus Reference Guide
920
921* Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
922* Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
923* Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
924* Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
925* Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
926* Group Info:: The group info format.
927* Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
928* Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
929* Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
930
931Back End Interface
932
933* Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
934* Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
935* Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
936* Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
937* Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
938* Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
939
940Various File Formats
941
942* Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
943* Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
944
945Emacs for Heathens
946
947* Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
948* Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
949
950@end detailmenu
951@end menu
952
953@node Starting Up
954@chapter Starting Gnus
955@cindex starting up
956
957If you haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs for
958Heathens} first.
959
960@kindex M-x gnus
961@findex gnus
962If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
963and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
964your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
965@code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
966minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
967@code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
968
969@findex gnus-other-frame
970@kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
971If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
972@kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
973
974If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
975variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
976@file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
977
978If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
979terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
980
981@menu
982* Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
983* The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
984* The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
985* Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
986* New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
987* Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
988* Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
989* Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
990* The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
991* Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
992@end menu
993
994
995@node Finding the News
996@section Finding the News
997@cindex finding news
998
999@vindex gnus-select-method
1000@c @head
1001The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
1002news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
1003@dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
1004native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
1005foreign groups.
1006
1007For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
1008you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
1009
1010@lisp
1011(setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
1012@end lisp
1013
1014If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
1015
1016@lisp
1017(setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
1018@end lisp
1019
1020If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
1021certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
1022server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
1023server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
1024
1025@vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1026@cindex NNTPSERVER
1027@cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1028If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1029@env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1030Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1031(@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1032If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1033as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1034
1035@vindex gnus-nntp-server
1036If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
1037@code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
1038@code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
1039
1040@vindex gnus-secondary-servers
1041@vindex gnus-nntp-server
1042You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
1043@acronym{NNTP} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
1044(i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
1045in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
1046type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
1047will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
1048gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
1049server.)
1050
1051@findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1052@kindex B (Group)
1053However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1054interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1055better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1056let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1057to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1058maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1059
1060@vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1061@c @head
1062A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1063@code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1064listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1065@code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1066files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1067appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1068groups are.
1069
1070For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1071you would typically set this variable to
1072
1073@lisp
1074(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1075@end lisp
1076
01c52d31
MB
1077Note: the @acronym{NNTP} back end stores marks in marks files
1078(@pxref{NNTP marks}). This feature makes it easy to share marks between
1079several Gnus installations, but may slow down things a bit when fetching
1080new articles. @xref{NNTP marks}, for more information.
1081
4009494e
GM
1082
1083@node The First Time
1084@section The First Time
1085@cindex first time usage
1086
1087If no startup files exist (@pxref{Startup Files}), Gnus will try to
1088determine what groups should be subscribed by default.
1089
1090@vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
1091If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
1092will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
1093killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1094something useful.
1095
1096Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1097picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1098here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1099
1100You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1101help you with most common problems.
1102
1103If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1104use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1105special.
1106
1107
1108@node The Server is Down
1109@section The Server is Down
1110@cindex server errors
1111
1112If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1113problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1114the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1115
1116Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1117without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1118will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1119given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1120for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1121groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1122buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1123
1124@findex gnus-no-server
1125@kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1126@c @head
1127If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1128your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1129@code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1130if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1131your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
11321 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1133levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1134
1135
1136@node Slave Gnusae
1137@section Slave Gnusae
1138@cindex slave
1139
1140You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1141same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1142are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1143that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1144
1145The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1146@file{.newsrc} file.
1147
1148To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1149Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1150@dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1151taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1152conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1153me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1154Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1155
1156@findex gnus-slave
1157Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1158however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1159@kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1160files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1161on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1162starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1163information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1164they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1165
1166Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1167information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1168
1169If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1170slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1171file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1172incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1173messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1174
1175
1176
1177@node New Groups
1178@section New Groups
1179@cindex new groups
1180@cindex subscription
1181
1182@vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1183If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1184you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1185also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1186@code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1187@kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1188is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1189@code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1190when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1191
1192@menu
1193* Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1194* Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1195* Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1196@end menu
1197
1198
1199@node Checking New Groups
1200@subsection Checking New Groups
1201
1202Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1203list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1204dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1205@code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1206server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1207cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1208groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1209@code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1210Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1211Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1212
1213I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1214server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1215fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1216@code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1217few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1218work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1219supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1220You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1221whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1222it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1223@samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1224
1225This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1226issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1227subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1228if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1229that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1230Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1231
1232
1233@node Subscription Methods
1234@subsection Subscription Methods
1235
1236@vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1237What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1238@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1239
1240This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1241with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1242
1243Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1244
1245@table @code
1246
1247@item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1248@vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1249Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1250zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1251(with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1252
1253@item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1254@vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1255Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1256new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1257
1258@item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1259@vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1260Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1261
1262@item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1263@vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1264Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1265function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1266@code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1267alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1268hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1269@samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1270up. Or something like that.
1271
1272@item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1273@vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1274Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1275you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1276to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1277
1278@item gnus-subscribe-killed
1279@vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1280Kill all new groups.
1281
1282@item gnus-subscribe-topics
1283@vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1284Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1285parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1286topic parameter that looks like
1287
1288@example
1289"nnslashdot"
1290@end example
1291
1292will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1293that topic.
1294
1295If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1296top-level topic.
1297
1298@end table
1299
1300@vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1301A closely related variable is
1302@code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1303mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1304hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1305will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1306hierarchy or not.
1307
1308One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1309(@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1310@code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1311will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1312
1313
1314@node Filtering New Groups
1315@subsection Filtering New Groups
1316
1317A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1318subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1319the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1320
1321@example
1322options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1323@end example
1324
1325@vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1326This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1327person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1328groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1329be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1330be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1331subscribing these groups.
1332@code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1333variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1334
1335@vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1336@vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1337If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1338set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1339@code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1340same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1341and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1342subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1343
1344@vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1345Yet another variable that meddles here is
1346@code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1347@code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1348but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1349more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1350used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1351groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1352@code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, and @code{nnmaildir})
1353subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this variable to
1354@code{nil}.
1355
1356New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1357@code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1358
1359
1360@node Changing Servers
1361@section Changing Servers
1362@cindex changing servers
1363
1364Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1365This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1366very flaky and you want to use another.
1367
1368Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1369@code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1370
1371@emph{Wrong!}
1372
1373Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1374@acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1375you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1376change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1377worthless.
1378
1379Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1380file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1381common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1382functions more than absolutely necessary.
1383
1384@kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1385@findex gnus-change-server
1386If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1387the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1388article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1389gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1390will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1391
1392@kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1393@findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1394You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1395gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1396move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1397
1398@kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1399@findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1400If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1401and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1402gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1403that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1404
1405@kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1406@findex gnus-group-clear-data
1407Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1408list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1409
1410After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1411since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1412affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1413@code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1414to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1415can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1416cache for all groups).
1417
1418
1419@node Startup Files
1420@section Startup Files
1421@cindex startup files
1422@cindex .newsrc
1423@cindex .newsrc.el
1424@cindex .newsrc.eld
1425
1426Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1427@file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1428groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1429read.
1430
1431Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1432keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1433@file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1434the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1435the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1436files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1437@sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1438
1439That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1440@file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1441@file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1442recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1443never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1444not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1445
1446@vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1447@vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1448You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1449@code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1450the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1451However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1452Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1453@code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1454@file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1455convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1456want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1457news reader.
1458
1459@vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1460If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1461will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1462save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1463will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1464so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1465You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1466@code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1467Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1468the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1469saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1470several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1471
1472@vindex gnus-startup-file
1473@vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1474@vindex version-control
1475The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1476The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1477file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1478If you want version control for this file, set
1479@code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1480@code{version-control} variable.
1481
1482@vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1483@vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1484@vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1485@code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1486files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1487saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1488@code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1489@file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1490control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1491startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1492
1493@lisp
1494(defun turn-off-backup ()
1495 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1496
1497(add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1498(add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1499@end lisp
1500
1501@vindex gnus-init-file
1502@vindex gnus-site-init-file
1503When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1504(@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1505(@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1506and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1507@file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1508with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1509suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1510@file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1511and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1512the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1513Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1514@code{gnus-init-file}.
1515
1516
1517@node Auto Save
1518@section Auto Save
1519@cindex dribble file
1520@cindex auto-save
1521
1522Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1523catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1524special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1525Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1526@file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1527this file.
1528
1529If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1530read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1531saved.
1532
1533@vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1534If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1535maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1536
1537@vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1538Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1539this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1540into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1541normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1542file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1543
1544@vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1545If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1546read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1547
1548
1549@node The Active File
1550@section The Active File
1551@cindex active file
1552@cindex ignored groups
1553
1554When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1555articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1556file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1557
1558@vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1559Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1560regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1561any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1562ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1563recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1564Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1565
1566@c This variable is
1567@c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1568@c if you set it to anything else.
1569
1570@vindex gnus-read-active-file
1571@c @head
1572The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1573can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1574reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1575
1576Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1577you actually subscribe to.
1578
1579Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1580variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1581present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1582considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1583
1584This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1585attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1586servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1587support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1588at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1589is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1590
1591Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1592instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1593servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1594variable.
1595
1596If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1597lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1598@acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1599read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1600performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1601@code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1602
1603If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1604different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1605
1606In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1607kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1608
1609Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1610secondary select methods.
1611
1612
1613@node Startup Variables
1614@section Startup Variables
1615
1616@table @code
1617
1618@item gnus-load-hook
1619@vindex gnus-load-hook
1620A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1621normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1622times you start Gnus.
1623
1624@item gnus-before-startup-hook
1625@vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
e3e955fe 1626A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is started.
4009494e
GM
1627
1628@item gnus-startup-hook
1629@vindex gnus-startup-hook
1630A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1631
1632@item gnus-started-hook
1633@vindex gnus-started-hook
1634A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1635successfully.
1636
1637@item gnus-setup-news-hook
1638@vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1639A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1640generating the group buffer.
1641
1642@item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1643@vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1644If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1645startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1646@file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1647bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1648best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1649in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1650
1651@item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1652@vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1653If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1654your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1655of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1656@file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1657
1658@item gnus-no-groups-message
1659@vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1660Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1661
1662@item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1663@vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1664If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1665
1666@item gnus-startup-jingle
1667@vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1668Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1669default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1670
1671@end table
1672
1673
1674@node Group Buffer
1675@chapter Group Buffer
1676@cindex group buffer
1677
1678@c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1679@c
1680@c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1681@c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1682@c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1683@c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1684@c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1685@c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1686@c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1687@c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1688@c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1689@c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1690@c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1691@c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1692@c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1693@c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1694@c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1695@c human rights at 9...
1696
1697
1698The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1699is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1700long as Gnus is active.
1701
1702@iftex
1703@iflatex
1704\gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1705\put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1706\put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1707\put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1708\put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1709\put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1710\put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1711\put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1712}
1713@end iflatex
1714@end iftex
1715
1716@menu
1717* Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1718* Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1719* Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1720* Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1721* Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1722* Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1723* Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1724* Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1725* Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1726* Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1727* Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1728* Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1729* Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1730* Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1731* Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1732* Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
01c52d31 1733* Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
e6d2d263 1734* Searching:: Mail search engines.
4009494e
GM
1735* Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1736@end menu
1737
1738
1739@node Group Buffer Format
1740@section Group Buffer Format
1741
1742@menu
1743* Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1744* Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1745* Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1746@end menu
1747
1748You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1749customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1750available in Emacs.
1751
1752The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1753cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1754slower. You can disable this via the variable
1755@code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1756Emacs version.
1757
1758@node Group Line Specification
1759@subsection Group Line Specification
1760@cindex group buffer format
1761
1762The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1763make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1764
1765Here's a couple of example group lines:
1766
1767@example
1768 25: news.announce.newusers
1769 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1770@end example
1771
1772Quite simple, huh?
1773
1774You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1775@samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1776ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1777asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1778
1779@vindex gnus-group-line-format
1780You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1781@code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1782lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1783a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1784@xref{Formatting Variables}.
1785
1786@samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1787
1788There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1789the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1790Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1791displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1792Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1793
1794(Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1795layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1796instead of wasting time reading news.)
1797
1798Here's a list of all available format characters:
1799
1800@table @samp
1801
1802@item M
1803An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1804
1805@item S
1806Whether the group is subscribed.
1807
1808@item L
1809Level of subscribedness.
1810
1811@item N
1812Number of unread articles.
1813
1814@item I
1815Number of dormant articles.
1816
1817@item T
1818Number of ticked articles.
1819
1820@item R
1821Number of read articles.
1822
1823@item U
1824Number of unseen articles.
1825
1826@item t
1827Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1828minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1829
1830Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1831efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1832the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1833hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1834unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1835interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
01c52d31
MB
1836end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job.
1837
1838The nnml backend (@pxref{Mail Spool}) has a feature called ``group
1839compaction'' which circumvents this deficiency: the idea is to
1840renumber all articles from 1, removing all gaps between numbers, hence
1841getting a correct total count. Other backends may support this in the
1842future. In order to keep your total article count relatively up to
1843date, you might want to compact your groups (or even directly your
1844server) from time to time. @xref{Misc Group Stuff}, @xref{Server Commands}.
4009494e
GM
1845
1846@item y
1847Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1848
1849@item i
1850Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1851
1852@item g
1853Full group name.
1854
1855@item G
1856Group name.
1857
1858@item C
1859Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1860comment element in the group parameters.
1861
1862@item D
1863Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1864before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1865@code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1866command.
1867
1868@item o
1869@samp{m} if moderated.
1870
1871@item O
1872@samp{(m)} if moderated.
1873
1874@item s
1875Select method.
1876
1877@item B
1878If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1879
1880@item n
1881Select from where.
1882
1883@item z
1884A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1885used.
1886
1887@item P
1888Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1889
1890@item c
1891@vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1892Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1893variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1894The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1895@samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1896
1897@item m
1898@vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1899@cindex %
1900@samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1901the group lately.
1902
1903@item p
1904@samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1905
1906@item d
1907A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1908Timestamp}).
1909
01c52d31
MB
1910@item F
1911The disk space used by the articles fetched by both the cache and
1912agent. The value is automatically scaled to bytes(B), kilobytes(K),
1913megabytes(M), or gigabytes(G) to minimize the column width. A format
1914of %7F is sufficient for a fixed-width column.
1915
4009494e
GM
1916@item u
1917User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1918be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1919@code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1920following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1921parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1922be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1923specifier.
1924@end table
1925
1926@cindex *
1927All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1928if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1929group, or a bogus native group.
1930
1931
1932@node Group Mode Line Specification
1933@subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1934@cindex group mode line
1935
1936@vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1937The mode line can be changed by setting
1938@code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1939doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1940
1941@table @samp
1942@item S
1943The native news server.
1944@item M
1945The native select method.
1946@end table
1947
1948
1949@node Group Highlighting
1950@subsection Group Highlighting
1951@cindex highlighting
1952@cindex group highlighting
1953
1954@vindex gnus-group-highlight
1955Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1956@code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1957that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1958something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1959
1960Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1961background is dark:
1962
1963@lisp
1964(cond (window-system
1965 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1966 (defface my-group-face-1
1967 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1968 (defface my-group-face-2
1969 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1970 "Second group face")
1971 (defface my-group-face-3
1972 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1973 (defface my-group-face-4
1974 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1975 (defface my-group-face-5
1976 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1977
1978(setq gnus-group-highlight
1979 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1980 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1981 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1982 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1983 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1984@end lisp
1985
1986Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1987
1988Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1989include:
1990
1991@table @code
1992@item group
1993The group name.
1994@item unread
1995The number of unread articles in the group.
1996@item method
1997The select method.
1998@item mailp
1999Whether the group is a mail group.
2000@item level
2001The level of the group.
2002@item score
2003The score of the group.
2004@item ticked
2005The number of ticked articles in the group.
2006@item total
2007The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
2008@var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
2009@item topic
2010When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
2011topic being inserted.
2012@end table
2013
2014When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
2015of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
2016functions for snarfing info on the group.
2017
2018@vindex gnus-group-update-hook
2019@findex gnus-group-highlight-line
2020@code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
2021It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
2022calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
2023
2024
2025@node Group Maneuvering
2026@section Group Maneuvering
2027@cindex group movement
2028
2029All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
2030expected, hopefully.
2031
2032@table @kbd
2033
2034@item n
2035@kindex n (Group)
2036@findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
2037Go to the next group that has unread articles
2038(@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
2039
2040@item p
2041@itemx DEL
2042@kindex DEL (Group)
2043@kindex p (Group)
2044@findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
2045Go to the previous group that has unread articles
2046(@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
2047
2048@item N
2049@kindex N (Group)
2050@findex gnus-group-next-group
2051Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2052
2053@item P
2054@kindex P (Group)
2055@findex gnus-group-prev-group
2056Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2057
2058@item M-n
2059@kindex M-n (Group)
2060@findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2061Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2062(@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2063
2064@item M-p
2065@kindex M-p (Group)
2066@findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2067Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2068(@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2069@end table
2070
2071Three commands for jumping to groups:
2072
2073@table @kbd
2074
2075@item j
2076@kindex j (Group)
2077@findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2078Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2079(@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2080like living groups.
2081
2082@item ,
2083@kindex , (Group)
2084@findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2085Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2086(@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2087
2088@item .
2089@kindex . (Group)
2090@findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2091Jump to the first group with unread articles
2092(@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2093@end table
2094
2095@vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2096If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2097commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2098the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2099is @code{t}.
2100
01c52d31
MB
2101@vindex gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit
2102If @code{gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit} is @code{t}, when a summary is
2103exited, the point in the group buffer is moved to the next unread group.
2104Otherwise, the point is set to the group just exited. The default is
2105@code{t}.
4009494e
GM
2106
2107@node Selecting a Group
2108@section Selecting a Group
2109@cindex group selection
2110
2111@table @kbd
2112
2113@item SPACE
2114@kindex SPACE (Group)
2115@findex gnus-group-read-group
2116Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2117first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2118unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2119this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2120group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2121determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2122positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2123negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2124
2125Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2126articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2127- 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2128
2129When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2130@kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2131ones.
2132
2133@item RET
2134@kindex RET (Group)
2135@findex gnus-group-select-group
2136Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2137(@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2138@code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2139does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2140entry.
2141
2142@item M-RET
2143@kindex M-RET (Group)
2144@findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2145This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2146minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2147scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2148expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2149enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2150(i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2151which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2152summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2153
2154@item M-SPACE
2155@kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2156@findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2157This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2158command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2159(@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2160
2161@item C-M-RET
2162@kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2163@findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2164Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2165doing any processing of its contents
2166(@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2167turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2168manner will have no permanent effects.
2169
2170@end table
2171
2172@vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2173The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2174consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2175considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2176(unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2177before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2178articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2179negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2180fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2181most recently will be fetched.
2182
2183@vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2184@code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2185@code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2186newsgroups.
2187
4b70e299 2188@vindex gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles
4009494e
GM
2189In groups in some news servers, there might be a big gap between a few
2190very old articles that will never be expired and the recent ones. In
2191such a case, the server will return the data like @code{(1 . 30000000)}
2192for the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, for example. Even if there
2193are actually only the articles 1-10 and 29999900-30000000, Gnus doesn't
2194know it at first and prepares for getting 30000000 articles. However,
2195it will consume hundreds megabytes of memories and might make Emacs get
2196stuck as the case may be. If you use such news servers, set the
4b70e299
MB
2197variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} to a positive number.
2198The value means that Gnus ignores articles other than this number of the
2199latest ones in every group. For instance, the value 10000 makes Gnus
2200get only the articles 29990001-30000000 (if the latest article number is
220130000000 in a group). Note that setting this variable to a number might
2202prevent you from reading very old articles. The default value of the
2203variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} is @code{nil}, which
2204means Gnus never ignores old articles.
4009494e
GM
2205
2206@vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2207@vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2208@vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2209If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2210automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
867d4bb3 2211Which article this is controlled by the
4009494e
GM
2212@code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2213variable are:
2214
2215@table @code
2216
2217@item unread
2218Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2219
2220@item first
2221Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2222
2223@item unseen
2224Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2225
2226@item unseen-or-unread
2227Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2228there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2229unread article.
2230
2231@item best
2232Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2233
2234@end table
2235
2236This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2237will be called to place point on a subject line.
2238
2239If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2240binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2241@code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2242@code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2243selected.
2244
2245
2246@node Subscription Commands
2247@section Subscription Commands
2248@cindex subscription
2249
2250@table @kbd
2251
2252@item S t
2253@itemx u
2254@kindex S t (Group)
2255@kindex u (Group)
2256@findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2257@c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2258Toggle subscription to the current group
2259(@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2260
2261@item S s
2262@itemx U
2263@kindex S s (Group)
2264@kindex U (Group)
2265@findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2266Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2267subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2268(@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2269
2270@item S k
2271@itemx C-k
2272@kindex S k (Group)
2273@kindex C-k (Group)
2274@findex gnus-group-kill-group
2275@c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2276Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2277
2278@item S y
2279@itemx C-y
2280@kindex S y (Group)
2281@kindex C-y (Group)
2282@findex gnus-group-yank-group
2283Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2284
2285@item C-x C-t
2286@kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2287@findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2288Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2289really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2290kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2291
2292@item S w
2293@itemx C-w
2294@kindex S w (Group)
2295@kindex C-w (Group)
2296@findex gnus-group-kill-region
2297Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2298
2299@item S z
2300@kindex S z (Group)
2301@findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2302Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2303
2304@item S C-k
2305@kindex S C-k (Group)
2306@findex gnus-group-kill-level
2307Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2308These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2309be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2310really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2311groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2312kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2313@file{.newsrc} file.
2314
2315@end table
2316
2317Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2318
2319
2320@node Group Data
2321@section Group Data
2322
2323@table @kbd
2324
2325@item c
2326@kindex c (Group)
2327@findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2328@vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2329@c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2330Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2331(@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2332@code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2333the group buffer.
2334
2335@item C
2336@kindex C (Group)
2337@findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2338Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2339(@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2340
2341@item M-c
2342@kindex M-c (Group)
2343@findex gnus-group-clear-data
2344Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2345read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2346
2347@item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2348@kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2349@findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2350If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2351and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2352clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2353caution.
2354
2355@end table
2356
2357
2358@node Group Levels
2359@section Group Levels
2360@cindex group level
2361@cindex level
2362
2363All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2364group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2365can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2366(@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2367a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2368
2369Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2370
2371@table @kbd
2372
2373@item S l
2374@kindex S l (Group)
2375@findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2376Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2377next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2378prompted for a level.
2379@end table
2380
2381@vindex gnus-level-killed
2382@vindex gnus-level-zombie
2383@vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2384@vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2385Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2386@code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2387@code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2388@code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2389unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2390(default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2391(default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2392same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2393you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2394groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2395reasons of efficiency.
2396
2397It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2398low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2399
2400Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2401understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2402subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2403empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2404go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2405groups are hidden, in a way.
2406
2407Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2408are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2409unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2410information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2411and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2412aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2413
2414Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2415a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2416group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2417but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2418the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2419list of killed groups.)
2420
2421If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2422Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2423them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2424
2425@vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2426@vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2427Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2428(default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2429which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2430(un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2431relevant valid ranges.
2432
2433@vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2434If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2435will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2436particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2437will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2438handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2439rest.
2440
2441If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2442one with the best level.
2443
2444@vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2445All groups with a level less than or equal to
2446@code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2447by default.
2448
2449@vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2450If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2451groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2452@code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2453listed.
2454
2455@vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2456If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2457give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2458use this level as the ``work'' level.
2459
2460@vindex gnus-activate-level
2461Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2462on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2463activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2464to 5. The default is 6.
2465
2466
2467@node Group Score
2468@section Group Score
2469@cindex group score
2470@cindex group rank
2471@cindex rank
2472
2473You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2474is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2475group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2476reason?
2477
2478This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2479to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2480the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2481score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2482called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2483a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2484of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2485least significant part.))
2486
2487@findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2488If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2489read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2490the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2491sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2492action after each summary exit, you can add
2493@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2494@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2495slow things down somewhat.
2496
2497
2498@node Marking Groups
2499@section Marking Groups
2500@cindex marking groups
2501
2502If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2503subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2504numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2505bidding on those groups.
2506
2507However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2508perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2509with the process mark and then execute the command.
2510
2511@table @kbd
2512
2513@item #
2514@kindex # (Group)
2515@itemx M m
2516@kindex M m (Group)
2517@findex gnus-group-mark-group
2518Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2519
2520@item M-#
2521@kindex M-# (Group)
2522@itemx M u
2523@kindex M u (Group)
2524@findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2525Remove the mark from the current group
2526(@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2527
2528@item M U
2529@kindex M U (Group)
2530@findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2531Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2532
2533@item M w
2534@kindex M w (Group)
2535@findex gnus-group-mark-region
2536Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2537
2538@item M b
2539@kindex M b (Group)
2540@findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2541Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2542
2543@item M r
2544@kindex M r (Group)
2545@findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2546Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2547(@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2548@end table
2549
2550Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2551
2552@findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2553If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2554with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2555(@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2556the command to be executed.
2557
2558
2559@node Foreign Groups
2560@section Foreign Groups
2561@cindex foreign groups
2562
2563Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2564groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2565special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2566groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2567consulted.
2568
2569Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2570@file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2571variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2572
2573@table @kbd
2574
2575@item G m
2576@kindex G m (Group)
2577@findex gnus-group-make-group
2578@cindex making groups
2579Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2580for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2581to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2582
2583@item G M
2584@kindex G M (Group)
2585@findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2586Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2587will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2588
2589@item G r
2590@kindex G r (Group)
2591@findex gnus-group-rename-group
2592@cindex renaming groups
2593Rename the current group to something else
2594(@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2595groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2596on some back ends.
2597
2598@item G c
2599@kindex G c (Group)
2600@cindex customizing
2601@findex gnus-group-customize
2602Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2603
2604@item G e
2605@kindex G e (Group)
2606@findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2607@cindex renaming groups
2608Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2609group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2610
2611@item G p
2612@kindex G p (Group)
2613@findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2614Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2615(@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2616
2617@item G E
2618@kindex G E (Group)
2619@findex gnus-group-edit-group
2620Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2621(@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2622
2623@item G d
2624@kindex G d (Group)
2625@findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2626@cindex nndir
2627Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2628for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2629
2630@item G h
2631@kindex G h (Group)
2632@cindex help group
2633@findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2634Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2635
2636@item G a
2637@kindex G a (Group)
2638@cindex (ding) archive
2639@cindex archive group
2640@findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2641@vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2642@vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2643Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2644default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2645(@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2646group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2647
2648@item G k
2649@kindex G k (Group)
2650@findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2651@cindex nnkiboze
2652Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2653match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2654strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2655@xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2656
2657@item G D
2658@kindex G D (Group)
2659@findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2660@cindex nneething
2661Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2662@code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2663@xref{Anything Groups}.
2664
2665@item G f
2666@kindex G f (Group)
2667@findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2668@cindex ClariNet Briefs
2669@cindex nndoc
2670Make a group based on some file or other
2671(@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2672command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2673Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2674@code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2675@code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2676@code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2677@code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2678you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2679type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2680
2681@item G u
2682@kindex G u (Group)
2683@vindex gnus-useful-groups
2684@findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2685Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2686(@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2687
2688@item G w
2689@kindex G w (Group)
2690@findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2691@cindex Google
2692@cindex nnweb
2693@cindex gmane
2694Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2695(@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2696command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2697search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2698include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2699@xref{Web Searches}.
2700
2701If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2702to a particular group by using a match string like
2703@samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2704
2705@item G R
2706@kindex G R (Group)
2707@findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2708Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2709(@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2710@xref{RSS}.
2711
2712@item G DEL
2713@kindex G DEL (Group)
2714@findex gnus-group-delete-group
2715This function will delete the current group
2716(@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2717actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2718group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2719absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2720read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2721
2722@item G V
2723@kindex G V (Group)
2724@findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2725Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2726(@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2727
2728@item G v
2729@kindex G v (Group)
2730@findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2731Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2732(@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2733@end table
2734
2735@xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2736methods.
2737
2738@vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2739If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2740Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2741This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2742groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2743@code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2744newsgroups.
2745
2746
9b3ebcb6
MB
2747The following commands create ephemeral groups. They can be called not
2748only from the Group buffer, but in any Gnus buffer.
2749
2750@table @code
2751@item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2752@findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2753@vindex gnus-gmane-group-download-format
2754Read an ephemeral group on Gmane.org. The articles are downloaded via
2755HTTP using the URL specified by @code{gnus-gmane-group-download-format}.
2756Gnus will prompt you for a group name, the start article number and an
2757the article range.
2758
2759@item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2760@findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2761This command is similar to @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group}, but
2762the group name and the article number and range are constructed from a
2763given @acronym{URL}. Supported @acronym{URL} formats include e.g.
2764@url{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12300/focus=12399},
2765@url{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2766@url{http://article.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2767@url{http://permalink.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/}, and
2768@url{http://news.gmane.org/group/gmane.foo.bar/thread=12345}.
2769
2770@item gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2771@findex gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2772Read an Emacs bug report in an ephemeral group. Gnus will prompt for a
2773bug number. The default is the number at point. The @acronym{URL} is
2774specified in @code{gnus-bug-group-download-format-alist}.
2775
2776@item gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2777@findex gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2778Read a Debian bug report in an ephemeral group. Analog to
2779@code{gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group}.
2780@end table
2781
2782Some of these command are also useful for article buttons, @xref{Article
2783Buttons}.
2784
2785Here is an example:
2786@lisp
2787(require 'gnus-art)
2788(add-to-list
2789 'gnus-button-alist
2790 '("#\\([0-9]+\\)\\>" 1
2791 (string-match "\\<emacs\\>" (or gnus-newsgroup-name ""))
2792 gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group 1))
2793@end lisp
2794
2795
4009494e
GM
2796@node Group Parameters
2797@section Group Parameters
2798@cindex group parameters
2799
2800The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
87035689
MB
2801
2802Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
2803group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
2804presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
2805silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
2806parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
2807Additionally, you can set group parameters via the
2808@code{gnus-parameters} variable, see below.
2809
4009494e
GM
2810Here's an example group parameter list:
2811
2812@example
2813((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2814 (auto-expire . t))
2815@end example
2816
2817We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2818the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2819parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2820not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2821
2822Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2823is an alist of regexps and values.
2824
2825The following group parameters can be used:
2826
2827@table @code
2828@item to-address
2829@cindex to-address
2830Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2831
2832@example
2833(to-address . "some@@where.com")
2834@end example
2835
2836This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2837lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2838the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2839ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2840that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2841
2842Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2843or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2844@samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2845the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2846group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2847list address instead.
2848
2849See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2850
2851@item to-list
2852@cindex to-list
2853Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2854
2855@example
2856(to-list . "some@@where.com")
2857@end example
2858
2859It is totally ignored
2860when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2861you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2862
2863If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2864@code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2865then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2866sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2867@vindex gnus-add-to-list
2868
2869@findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2870@cindex mail list groups
2871If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2872entering summary buffer.
2873
2874See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2875
2876@anchor{subscribed}
2877@item subscribed
2878@cindex subscribed
2879@cindex Mail-Followup-To
2880@findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2881If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2882to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2883mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2884(only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2885headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2886following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2887
2888@lisp
2889(setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2890 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2891@end lisp
2892
2893@xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2894a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2895
2896@item visible
2897@cindex visible
2898If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2899that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2900of whether it has any unread articles.
2901
2902This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2903@code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2904
2905@item broken-reply-to
2906@cindex broken-reply-to
2907Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2908headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2909if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2910can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2911has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2912itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2913
2914@item to-group
2915@cindex to-group
2916Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2917posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2918
2919@item newsgroup
2920@cindex newsgroup
2921If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2922will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2923This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2924news group.
2925
2926@item gcc-self
2927@cindex gcc-self
2928If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2929composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2930@code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2931generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2932be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2933precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2934(@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2935
2936@strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2937@code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2938doesn't accept articles.
2939
2940@item auto-expire
2941@cindex auto-expire
2942@cindex expiring mail
2943If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2944. t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2945alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2946
2947See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2948
2949@item total-expire
2950@cindex total-expire
2951@cindex expiring mail
2952If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2953@code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2954expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2955caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2956expiry.
2957
2958See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2959
2960@item expiry-wait
2961@cindex expiry-wait
2962@vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2963If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2964@code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2965@code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2966(@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2967can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2968symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2969
2970@item expiry-target
2971@cindex expiry-target
2972Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2973@code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2974
2975@item score-file
2976@cindex score file group parameter
2977Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2978@file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2979interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2980
2981@item adapt-file
2982@cindex adapt file group parameter
2983Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2984@file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2985All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2986
2987@item admin-address
2988@cindex admin-address
2989When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2990unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2991messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2992put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2993
2994@item display
2995@cindex display
2996Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2997display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2998
2999@table @code
3000@item all
3001Display all articles, both read and unread.
3002
3003@item an integer
3004Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
3005entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
3006
3007@item default
3008Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
3009ticked articles.
3010
3011@item an array
3012Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
3013
3014Here are some examples:
3015
3016@table @code
3017@item [unread]
3018Display only unread articles.
3019
3020@item [not expire]
3021Display everything except expirable articles.
3022
3023@item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
3024Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
3025responded to.
3026@end table
3027
3028The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
3029Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
3030@code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
3031@code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
3032@code{cache}, @code{forward}, @code{unseen} and @code{recent}.
3033
3034@end table
3035
3036The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
3037the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
3038command (@pxref{Limiting}).
3039
3040@item comment
3041@cindex comment
3042Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
3043arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
3044group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
3045
3046@item charset
3047@cindex charset
3048Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
3049@code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
3050used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
3051
3052See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
3053
3054@item ignored-charsets
3055@cindex ignored-charset
3056Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
3057will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
3058default charset will be used for decoding articles.
3059
3060See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
3061
3062@item posting-style
3063@cindex posting-style
3064You can store additional posting style information for this group
3065here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
3066@code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
3067the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
3068take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
3069
3070For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
3071instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
3072like this in the group parameters:
3073
3074@example
3075(posting-style
3076 (name "Funky Name")
3077 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
3078 (signature "Funky Signature"))
3079@end example
3080
01c52d31
MB
3081If you're using topics to organize your group buffer
3082(@pxref{Group Topics}), note that posting styles can also be set in
3083the topics parameters. Posting styles in topic parameters apply to all
3084groups in this topic. More precisely, the posting-style settings for a
3085group result from the hierarchical merging of all posting-style
3086entries in the parameters of this group and all the topics it belongs
3087to.
3088
3089
4009494e
GM
3090@item post-method
3091@cindex post-method
3092If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
3093instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
3094
a1da1e37
MB
3095@item mail-source
3096@cindex mail-source
3097If it is set, and the setting of @code{mail-sources} includes a
3098@code{group} mail source (@pxref{Mail Sources}), the value is a
3099mail source for this group.
3100
4009494e
GM
3101@item banner
3102@cindex banner
3103An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
3104that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
3105@var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
3106last signature or any of the elements of the alist
3107@code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
3108
3109@item sieve
3110@cindex sieve
3111This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
3112that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
3113Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
3114condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
3115
3116For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
3117address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
3118translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
3119Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
3120
3121@example
01c52d31
MB
3122if address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com" @{
3123 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3124@}
3125@end example
3126
3127To generate tests for multiple email-addresses use a group parameter
3128like @code{(sieve address "sender" ("name@@one.org" else@@two.org"))}.
3129When generating a sieve script (@pxref{Sieve Commands}) Sieve code
3130like the following is generated:
3131
3132@example
3133if address "sender" ["name@@one.org", "else@@two.org"] @{
3134 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
4009494e
GM
3135@}
3136@end example
3137
01c52d31
MB
3138See @pxref{Sieve Commands} for commands and variables that might be of
3139interest in relation to the sieve parameter.
3140
4009494e
GM
3141The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
3142Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
3143
3144@item (agent parameters)
3145If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of the its parameters
3146to control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
3147Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
3148agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
3149minimize the configuration effort.
3150
3151@item (@var{variable} @var{form})
3152You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
3153are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
3154you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
3155that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
3156in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
3157@code{eval}ed there.
3158
e3e955fe
MB
3159Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer
3160if and only if @var{variable} has been bound as a variable. Otherwise,
3161only evaluating the form will take place. So, you may want to bind the
3162variable in advance using @code{defvar} or other if the result of the
3163form needs to be set to it.
3164
4009494e
GM
3165But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3166message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3167message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3168question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3169Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3170parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
e6d2d263 3171@file{~/.gnus.el} file:
4009494e
GM
3172
3173@lisp
3174(add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3175@end lisp
3176
3177@vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3178A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3179the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
3180
3181@example
3182nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3183@end example
3184
3185has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3186tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3187the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3188into the group parameters for the group.
3189
3190This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3191hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
e3e955fe
MB
3192@code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group. If
3193@code{dummy-variable} has been bound (see above), it will be set to the
3194(meaningless) result of the @code{(ding)} form.
4009494e
GM
3195
3196Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3197pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3198following is added to a group parameter
3199
3200@lisp
3201(gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3202 '(lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3203@end lisp
3204
3205when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3206expired.
3207
3208@end table
3209
4009494e
GM
3210@vindex gnus-parameters
3211Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3212But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3213case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3214For example:
3215
3216@lisp
3217(setq gnus-parameters
3218 '(("mail\\..*"
3219 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3220 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3221 (gnus-summary-line-format
3222 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3223 (gcc-self . t)
3224 (display . all))
3225
3226 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3227 (to-group . "\\1"))
3228
3229 ("mail\\.me"
3230 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3231
3232 ("list\\..*"
3233 (total-expire . t)
3234 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3235@end lisp
3236
3237String value of parameters will be subjected to regexp substitution, as
3238the @code{to-group} example shows.
3239
3240@vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3241By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3242specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3243or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3244@code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3245value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3246example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3247applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3248group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3249value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3250@code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3251always in a case-insensitive manner.
3252
01c52d31
MB
3253You can define different sorting to different groups via
3254@code{gnus-parameters}. Here is an example to sort an @acronym{NNTP}
3255group by reverse date to see the latest news at the top and an
3256@acronym{RSS} group by subject. In this example, the first group is the
3257Debian daily news group @code{gmane.linux.debian.user.news} from
3258news.gmane.org. The @acronym{RSS} group corresponds to the Debian
3259weekly news RSS feed
3260@url{http://packages.debian.org/unstable/newpkg_main.en.rdf},
3261@xref{RSS}.
3262
3263@lisp
3264(setq
3265 gnus-parameters
3266 '(("nntp.*gmane\\.debian\\.user\\.news"
3267 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3268 (gnus-article-sort-functions '((not gnus-article-sort-by-date)))
3269 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3270 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
3271 ("nnrss.*debian"
3272 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3273 (gnus-article-sort-functions 'gnus-article-sort-by-subject)
3274 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3275 (gnus-use-scoring t)
3276 (gnus-score-find-score-files-function 'gnus-score-find-single)
3277 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%d %I%(%[ %s %]%)\n"))))
3278@end lisp
3279
4009494e
GM
3280
3281@node Listing Groups
3282@section Listing Groups
3283@cindex group listing
3284
3285These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3286
3287@table @kbd
3288
3289@item l
3290@itemx A s
3291@kindex A s (Group)
3292@kindex l (Group)
3293@findex gnus-group-list-groups
3294List all groups that have unread articles
3295(@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3296command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3297only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3298@code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3299groups).
3300
3301@item L
3302@itemx A u
3303@kindex A u (Group)
3304@kindex L (Group)
3305@findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3306List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3307(@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3308this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3309it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3310unsubscribed groups).
3311
3312@item A l
3313@kindex A l (Group)
3314@findex gnus-group-list-level
3315List all unread groups on a specific level
3316(@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3317with no unread articles.
3318
3319@item A k
3320@kindex A k (Group)
3321@findex gnus-group-list-killed
3322List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3323prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3324currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3325from the server.
3326
3327@item A z
3328@kindex A z (Group)
3329@findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3330List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3331
3332@item A m
3333@kindex A m (Group)
3334@findex gnus-group-list-matching
3335List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3336(@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3337
3338@item A M
3339@kindex A M (Group)
3340@findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3341List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3342
3343@item A A
3344@kindex A A (Group)
3345@findex gnus-group-list-active
3346List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3347server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3348might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3349to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3350thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3351don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3352Take the output with some grains of salt.
3353
3354@item A a
3355@kindex A a (Group)
3356@findex gnus-group-apropos
3357List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3358(@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3359
3360@item A d
3361@kindex A d (Group)
3362@findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3363List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3364(@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3365
3366@item A c
3367@kindex A c (Group)
3368@findex gnus-group-list-cached
3369List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3370
3371@item A ?
3372@kindex A ? (Group)
3373@findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3374List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3375
3376@item A /
3377@kindex A / (Group)
3378@findex gnus-group-list-limit
3379List groups limited within the current selection
3380(@code{gnus-group-list-limit}).
3381
3382@item A f
3383@kindex A f (Group)
3384@findex gnus-group-list-flush
3385Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3386
3387@item A p
3388@kindex A p (Group)
3389@findex gnus-group-list-plus
3390List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3391
3392@end table
3393
3394@vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3395@cindex visible group parameter
3396Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3397always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3398add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3399get the same effect.
3400
3401@vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3402Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3403group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3404@code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3405groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3406
3407
3408@node Sorting Groups
3409@section Sorting Groups
3410@cindex sorting groups
3411
3412@kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3413@findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3414@vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3415The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3416group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3417@code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3418include:
3419
3420@table @code
3421
3422@item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3423@findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3424Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3425
3426@item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3427@findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3428Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3429
3430@item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3431@findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3432Sort by group level.
3433
3434@item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3435@findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3436Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3437
3438@item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3439@findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3440Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3441are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3442
3443@item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3444@findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3445Sort by number of unread articles.
3446
3447@item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3448@findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3449Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3450
3451@item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3452@findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3453Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3454
3455
3456@end table
3457
3458@code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3459functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3460the last one.
3461
3462
3463There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3464some sorting criteria:
3465
3466@table @kbd
3467@item G S a
3468@kindex G S a (Group)
3469@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3470Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3471(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3472
3473@item G S u
3474@kindex G S u (Group)
3475@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3476Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3477(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3478
3479@item G S l
3480@kindex G S l (Group)
3481@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3482Sort the group buffer by group level
3483(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3484
3485@item G S v
3486@kindex G S v (Group)
3487@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3488Sort the group buffer by group score
3489(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3490
3491@item G S r
3492@kindex G S r (Group)
3493@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3494Sort the group buffer by group rank
3495(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3496
3497@item G S m
3498@kindex G S m (Group)
3499@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3500Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3501(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3502
3503@item G S n
3504@kindex G S n (Group)
3505@findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3506Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3507(@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3508
3509@end table
3510
3511All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3512(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3513
3514When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3515commands will sort in reverse order.
3516
3517You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3518
3519@table @kbd
3520@item G P a
3521@kindex G P a (Group)
3522@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3523Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3524(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3525
3526@item G P u
3527@kindex G P u (Group)
3528@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3529Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3530(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3531
3532@item G P l
3533@kindex G P l (Group)
3534@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3535Sort the groups by group level
3536(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3537
3538@item G P v
3539@kindex G P v (Group)
3540@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3541Sort the groups by group score
3542(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3543
3544@item G P r
3545@kindex G P r (Group)
3546@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3547Sort the groups by group rank
3548(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3549
3550@item G P m
3551@kindex G P m (Group)
3552@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3553Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3554(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3555
3556@item G P n
3557@kindex G P n (Group)
3558@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3559Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3560(@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3561
3562@item G P s
3563@kindex G P s (Group)
3564@findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3565Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3566
3567@end table
3568
3569And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3570move groups around.
3571
3572
3573@node Group Maintenance
3574@section Group Maintenance
3575@cindex bogus groups
3576
3577@table @kbd
3578@item b
3579@kindex b (Group)
3580@findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3581Find bogus groups and delete them
3582(@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3583
3584@item F
3585@kindex F (Group)
3586@findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3587Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3588With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3589for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3590to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3591zombies.
3592
3593@item C-c C-x
3594@kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3595@findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3596@cindex expiring mail
3597Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3598process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3599all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3600(@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3601
3602@item C-c C-M-x
3603@kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3604@findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3605@cindex expiring mail
3606Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3607(@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3608
3609@end table
3610
3611
3612@node Browse Foreign Server
3613@section Browse Foreign Server
3614@cindex foreign servers
3615@cindex browsing servers
3616
3617@table @kbd
3618@item B
3619@kindex B (Group)
3620@findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3621You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3622then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3623(@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3624@end table
3625
3626@findex gnus-browse-mode
3627A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3628will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3629a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3630
3631Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3632
3633@table @kbd
3634@item n
3635@kindex n (Browse)
3636@findex gnus-group-next-group
3637Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3638
3639@item p
3640@kindex p (Browse)
3641@findex gnus-group-prev-group
3642Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3643
3644@item SPACE
3645@kindex SPACE (Browse)
3646@findex gnus-browse-read-group
3647Enter the current group and display the first article
3648(@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3649
3650@item RET
3651@kindex RET (Browse)
3652@findex gnus-browse-select-group
3653Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3654
3655@item u
3656@kindex u (Browse)
3657@findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3658Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3659subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3660
3661@item l
3662@itemx q
3663@kindex q (Browse)
3664@kindex l (Browse)
3665@findex gnus-browse-exit
3666Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3667
3668@item d
3669@kindex d (Browse)
3670@findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3671Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3672
3673@item ?
3674@kindex ? (Browse)
3675@findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3676Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3677there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3678@end table
3679
3680
3681@node Exiting Gnus
3682@section Exiting Gnus
3683@cindex exiting Gnus
3684
3685Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3686
3687@table @kbd
3688@item z
3689@kindex z (Group)
3690@findex gnus-group-suspend
3691Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3692but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3693is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3694
3695@item q
3696@kindex q (Group)
3697@findex gnus-group-exit
3698@c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3699Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3700
3701@item Q
3702@kindex Q (Group)
3703@findex gnus-group-quit
3704Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3705The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3706@end table
3707
3708@vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3709@vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3710@vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3711@code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3712@code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3713@code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3714exiting Gnus.
3715
3716Note:
3717
3718@quotation
3719Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3720numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3721behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3722plastic chair.
3723@end quotation
3724
3725
3726@node Group Topics
3727@section Group Topics
3728@cindex topics
3729
3730If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3731them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3732here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3733you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3734even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3735groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3736
3737@iftex
3738@iflatex
3739\gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3740\put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3741}
3742@end iflatex
3743@end iftex
3744
3745Here's an example:
3746
3747@example
3748Gnus
3749 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3750 3: comp.emacs
3751 2: alt.religion.emacs
3752 Naughty Emacs
3753 452: alt.sex.emacs
3754 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3755 Misc
3756 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3757 13: comp.sources.unix
3758@end example
3759
3760@findex gnus-topic-mode
3761@kindex t (Group)
3762To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3763@code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3764is a toggling command.)
3765
3766Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3767dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3768Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3769under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3770Hot and bothered?
3771
3772If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3773the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3774@file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3775
3776@lisp
3777(add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3778@end lisp
3779
3780@menu
3781* Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3782* Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3783* Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3784* Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3785* Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3786@end menu
3787
3788
3789@node Topic Commands
3790@subsection Topic Commands
3791@cindex topic commands
3792
3793When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3794available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3795definitions slightly.
3796
3797In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3798First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3799groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3800like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3801shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3802groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3803
3804Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3805the way you like.
3806
3807@table @kbd
3808
3809@item T n
3810@kindex T n (Topic)
3811@findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3812Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3813(@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3814
3815@item T TAB
3816@itemx TAB
3817@kindex T TAB (Topic)
3818@kindex TAB (Topic)
3819@findex gnus-topic-indent
3820``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3821previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3822``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3823
3824@item M-TAB
3825@kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3826@findex gnus-topic-unindent
3827``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3828parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3829
3830@end table
3831
3832The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3833They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3834@kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3835kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3836
3837@table @kbd
3838
3839@item C-k
3840@kindex C-k (Topic)
3841@findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3842Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3843topic will be removed along with the topic.
3844
3845@item C-y
3846@kindex C-y (Topic)
3847@findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3848Yank the previously killed group or topic
3849(@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3850before all groups.
3851
3852So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3853@kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3854move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3855topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3856paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3857
3858You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3859you can move topics around as well as groups.
3860
3861@end table
3862
3863After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3864hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3865key.
3866
3867@table @kbd
3868
3869@item RET
3870@kindex RET (Topic)
3871@findex gnus-topic-select-group
3872@itemx SPACE
3873Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3874When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3875usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3876visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3877toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3878prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3879
3880@end table
3881
3882Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3883
3884@table @kbd
3885
3886@item T m
3887@kindex T m (Topic)
3888@findex gnus-topic-move-group
3889Move the current group to some other topic
3890(@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3891convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3892
3893@item T j
3894@kindex T j (Topic)
3895@findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3896Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3897
3898@item T c
3899@kindex T c (Topic)
3900@findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3901Copy the current group to some other topic
3902(@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3903convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3904
3905@item T h
3906@kindex T h (Topic)
3907@findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3908Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3909a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3910
3911@item T s
3912@kindex T s (Topic)
3913@findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3914Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3915a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3916
3917@item T D
3918@kindex T D (Topic)
3919@findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3920Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3921This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3922topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3923remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3924the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3925(which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3926topic.
3927
3928This command uses the process/prefix convention
3929(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3930
3931@item T M
3932@kindex T M (Topic)
3933@findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3934Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3935(@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3936
3937@item T C
3938@kindex T C (Topic)
3939@findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3940Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3941(@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3942
3943@item T H
3944@kindex T H (Topic)
3945@findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3946Toggle hiding empty topics
3947(@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3948
3949@item T #
3950@kindex T # (Topic)
3951@findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3952Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3953(@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3954sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3955
3956@item T M-#
3957@kindex T M-# (Topic)
3958@findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3959Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3960(@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3961sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3962
3963@item C-c C-x
3964@kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3965@findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3966@cindex expiring mail
3967Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3968expiry process (if any)
3969(@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3970
3971@item T r
3972@kindex T r (Topic)
3973@findex gnus-topic-rename
3974Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3975
3976@item T DEL
3977@kindex T DEL (Topic)
3978@findex gnus-topic-delete
3979Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3980
3981@item A T
3982@kindex A T (Topic)
3983@findex gnus-topic-list-active
3984List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3985(@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3986
3987@item T M-n
3988@kindex T M-n (Topic)
3989@findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3990Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3991
3992@item T M-p
3993@kindex T M-p (Topic)
3994@findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
01c52d31 3995Go to the previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
4009494e
GM
3996
3997@item G p
3998@kindex G p (Topic)
3999@findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
4000@cindex group parameters
4001@cindex topic parameters
4002@cindex parameters
4003Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
4004@xref{Topic Parameters}.
4005
4006@end table
4007
4008
4009@node Topic Variables
4010@subsection Topic Variables
4011@cindex topic variables
4012
4013The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
4014This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
4015
4016@vindex gnus-topic-line-format
4017The topic lines themselves are created according to the
4018@code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4019Valid elements are:
4020
4021@table @samp
4022@item i
4023Indentation.
4024@item n
4025Topic name.
4026@item v
4027Visibility.
4028@item l
4029Level.
4030@item g
4031Number of groups in the topic.
4032@item a
4033Number of unread articles in the topic.
4034@item A
4035Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
4036@end table
4037
4038@vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
4039Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
4040@code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
4041The default is 2.
4042
4043@vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
4044@code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
4045
4046@vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
4047The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
4048topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
4049
4050
4051@node Topic Sorting
4052@subsection Topic Sorting
4053@cindex topic sorting
4054
4055You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
4056commands:
4057
4058
4059@table @kbd
4060@item T S a
4061@kindex T S a (Topic)
4062@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
4063Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
4064(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
4065
4066@item T S u
4067@kindex T S u (Topic)
4068@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
4069Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
4070(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
4071
4072@item T S l
4073@kindex T S l (Topic)
4074@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
4075Sort the current topic by group level
4076(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
4077
4078@item T S v
4079@kindex T S v (Topic)
4080@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
4081Sort the current topic by group score
4082(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
4083
4084@item T S r
4085@kindex T S r (Topic)
4086@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
4087Sort the current topic by group rank
4088(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
4089
4090@item T S m
4091@kindex T S m (Topic)
4092@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
4093Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
4094(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
4095
4096@item T S e
4097@kindex T S e (Topic)
4098@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
4099Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
4100(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
4101
4102@item T S s
4103@kindex T S s (Topic)
4104@findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
4105Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
4106@code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
4107(@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
4108
4109@end table
4110
4111When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
4112order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
4113sorting.
4114
4115
4116@node Topic Topology
4117@subsection Topic Topology
4118@cindex topic topology
4119@cindex topology
4120
4121So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
4122
4123@example
4124@group
4125Gnus
4126 Emacs -- I wuw it!
4127 3: comp.emacs
4128 2: alt.religion.emacs
4129 Naughty Emacs
4130 452: alt.sex.emacs
4131 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4132 Misc
4133 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4134 13: comp.sources.unix
4135@end group
4136@end example
4137
4138So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
4139that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
4140just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
4141follows:
4142
4143@lisp
4144(("Gnus" visible)
4145 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
4146 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
4147 (("Misc" visible)))
4148@end lisp
4149
4150@vindex gnus-topic-topology
4151This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
4152for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
4153file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
4154to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
4155setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
4156
4157This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
4158and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
4159allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
4160
4161
4162@node Topic Parameters
4163@subsection Topic Parameters
4164@cindex topic parameters
4165
4166All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
4167(and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
4168topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
4169enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
4170Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
4171
4172In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
4173parameters:
4174
4175@table @code
4176@item subscribe
4177When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
4178@code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
4179value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
4180topic.
4181
4182@item subscribe-level
4183When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4184the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4185@code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4186
4187@end table
4188
4189Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4190parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4191know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4192verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4193
4194@example
4195@group
4196Gnus
4197 Emacs
4198 3: comp.emacs
4199 2: alt.religion.emacs
4200 452: alt.sex.emacs
4201 Relief
4202 452: alt.sex.emacs
4203 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4204 Misc
4205 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4206 13: comp.sources.unix
4207 452: alt.sex.emacs
4208@end group
4209@end example
4210
4211The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4212. "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4213@code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4214topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4215@* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4216. "religion.SCORE")}.
4217
4218Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4219will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4220group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4221score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4222get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4223
4224This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4225there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4226parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4227@code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4228gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4229of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4230happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4231happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4232
4233
01c52d31
MB
4234@node Non-ASCII Group Names
4235@section Accessing groups of non-English names
4236@cindex non-ascii group names
4237
4238There are some news servers that provide groups of which the names are
4239expressed with their native languages in the world. For instance, in a
4240certain news server there are some newsgroups of which the names are
4241spelled in Chinese, where people are talking in Chinese. You can, of
4242course, subscribe to such news groups using Gnus. Currently Gnus
4243supports non-@acronym{ASCII} group names not only with the @code{nntp}
4244back end but also with the @code{nnml} back end and the @code{nnrss}
4245back end.
4246
4247Every such group name is encoded by a certain charset in the server
4248side (in an @acronym{NNTP} server its administrator determines the
4249charset, but for groups in the other back ends it is determined by you).
4250Gnus has to display the decoded ones for you in the group buffer and the
4251article buffer, and needs to use the encoded ones when communicating
4252with servers. However, Gnus doesn't know what charset is used for each
4253non-@acronym{ASCII} group name. The following two variables are just
4254the ones for telling Gnus what charset should be used for each group:
4255
4256@table @code
4257@item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4258@vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4259An alist of select methods and charsets. The default value is
4260@code{nil}. The names of groups in the server specified by that select
4261method are all supposed to use the corresponding charset. For example:
4262
4263@lisp
4264(setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4265 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4266@end lisp
4267
4268Charsets specified for groups with this variable are preferred to the
4269ones specified for the same groups with the
4270@code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} variable (see below).
4271
4272A select method can be very long, like:
4273
4274@lisp
4275(nntp "gmane"
4276 (nntp-address "news.gmane.org")
4277 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
4278 (nntp-open-connection-function
4279 nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
4280 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
4281 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
4282 ("-C" "-t" "-e" "none"))
4283 (nntp-via-address @dots{}))
4284@end lisp
4285
4286In that case, you can truncate it into @code{(nntp "gmane")} in this
4287variable. That is, it is enough to contain only the back end name and
4288the server name.
4289
4290@item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4291@cindex UTF-8 group names
4292@vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4293An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names.
4294@code{((".*" . utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported,
4295otherwise the default is @code{nil}. For example:
4296
4297@lisp
4298(setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4299 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)
4300 (".*" . utf-8)))
4301@end lisp
4302
4303Note that this variable is ignored if the match is made with
4304@code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist}.
4305@end table
4306
4307Those two variables are used also to determine the charset for encoding
4308and decoding non-@acronym{ASCII} group names that are in the back ends
4309other than @code{nntp}. It means that it is you who determine it. If
4310you do nothing, the charset used for group names in those back ends will
4311all be @code{utf-8} because of the last element of
4312@code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4313
4314There is one more important variable for non-@acronym{ASCII} group
26b9f88d 4315names:
01c52d31
MB
4316
4317@table @code
4318@item nnmail-pathname-coding-system
26b9f88d
MB
4319@vindex nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4320The value of this variable should be a coding system or @code{nil}. The
4321default is @code{nil} in Emacs, or is the aliasee of the coding system
4322named @code{file-name} (a certain coding system of which an alias is
4323@code{file-name}) in XEmacs.
4324
4325The @code{nnml} back end, the @code{nnrss} back end, the @acronym{NNTP}
4326marks feature (@pxref{NNTP marks}), the agent, and the cache use
4327non-@acronym{ASCII} group names in those files and directories. This
4328variable overrides the value of @code{file-name-coding-system} which
4329specifies the coding system used when encoding and decoding those file
4330names and directory names.
01c52d31
MB
4331
4332In XEmacs (with the @code{mule} feature), @code{file-name-coding-system}
4333is the only means to specify the coding system used to encode and decode
26b9f88d 4334file names. On the other hand, Emacs uses the value of
01c52d31 4335@code{default-file-name-coding-system} if @code{file-name-coding-system}
26b9f88d
MB
4336is @code{nil} or it is bound to the value of
4337@code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} which is @code{nil}.
4338
4339Normally the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system} in Emacs or
4340@code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} in XEmacs is initialized according
4341to the locale, so you will need to do nothing if the value is suitable
4342to encode and decode non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
01c52d31
MB
4343
4344The value of this variable (or @code{default-file-name-coding-system})
4345does not necessarily need to be the same value that is determined by
4346@code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} and
4347@code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4348
26b9f88d
MB
4349If @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable is
4350initialized by default to @code{iso-latin-1} for example, although you
4351want to subscribe to the groups spelled in Chinese, that is the most
4352typical case where you have to customize
4353@code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}. The @code{utf-8} coding system is
4354a good candidate for it. Otherwise, you may change the locale in your
4355system so that @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable
4356may be initialized to an appropriate value.
01c52d31
MB
4357@end table
4358
4359Note that when you copy or move articles from a non-@acronym{ASCII}
4360group to another group, the charset used to encode and decode group
4361names should be the same in both groups. Otherwise the Newsgroups
4362header will be displayed incorrectly in the article buffer.
4363
4364
e6d2d263
MB
4365@node Searching
4366@section Searching
4367
4368@menu
4369* nnir:: Searching on IMAP, with swish, namazu, etc.
4370* nnmairix:: Searching maildir, MH or mbox with Mairix.
4371@end menu
4372
4373@cindex Searching
4374
4375FIXME: This node is a stub.
4376
4377FIXME: Add a brief overview of Gnus search capabilities. A brief
4378comparison of nnir, nnmairix, contrib/gnus-namazu would be nice
4379as well.
4380
4381FIXME: Explain difference to @ref{Searching for Articles}, add reference
4382and back-reference.
4383
4384@node nnir
4385@subsection nnir
4386
4387FIXME: As a first step, convert the commentary of @file{nnir} to texi.
4388@cindex nnir
4389
4390@node nnmairix
4391@subsection nnmairix
4392
867d4bb3 4393@cindex mairix
e6d2d263
MB
4394@cindex nnmairix
4395This paragraph describes how to set up mairix and the back end
4396@code{nnmairix} for indexing and searching your mail from within
4397Gnus. Additionally, you can create permanent ``smart'' groups which are
4398bound to mairix searches and are automatically updated.
4399
4400@menu
4401* About mairix:: About the mairix mail search engine
4402* nnmairix requirements:: What you will need for using nnmairix
4403* What nnmairix does:: What does nnmairix actually do?
4404* Setting up mairix:: Set up your mairix installation
4405* Configuring nnmairix:: Set up the nnmairix back end
4406* nnmairix keyboard shortcuts:: List of available keyboard shortcuts
4407* Propagating marks:: How to propagate marks from nnmairix groups
4408* nnmairix tips and tricks:: Some tips, tricks and examples
4409* nnmairix caveats:: Some more stuff you might want to know
4410@end menu
4411
2b968687
MB
4412@c FIXME: The markup in this section might need improvement.
4413@c E.g. adding @samp, @var, @file, @command, etc.
4414@c Cf. (info "(texinfo)Indicating")
e6d2d263
MB
4415
4416@node About mairix
4417@subsubsection About mairix
4418
4419Mairix is a tool for indexing and searching words in locally stored
4420mail. It was written by Richard Curnow and is licensed under the
4421GPL. Mairix comes with most popular GNU/Linux distributions, but it also
4422runs under Windows (with cygwin), Mac OS X and Solaris. The homepage can
4423be found at
4424@uref{http://www.rpcurnow.force9.co.uk/mairix/index.html}
4425
4426Though mairix might not be as flexible as other search tools like
4427swish++ or namazu, which you can use via the @code{nnir} back end, it
4428has the prime advantage of being incredibly fast. On current systems, it
4429can easily search through headers and message bodies of thousands and
4430thousands of mails in well under a second. Building the database
4431necessary for searching might take a minute or two, but only has to be
4432done once fully. Afterwards, the updates are done incrementally and
4433therefore are really fast, too. Additionally, mairix is very easy to set
4434up.
4435
4436For maximum speed though, mairix should be used with mails stored in
4437@code{Maildir} or @code{MH} format (this includes the @code{nnml} back
4438end), although it also works with mbox. Mairix presents the search
4439results by populating a @emph{virtual} maildir/MH folder with symlinks
4440which point to the ``real'' message files (if mbox is used, copies are
4441made). Since mairix already presents search results in such a virtual
4442mail folder, it is very well suited for using it as an external program
4443for creating @emph{smart} mail folders, which represent certain mail
4444searches. This is similar to a Kiboze group (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}),
4445but much faster.
4446
4447@node nnmairix requirements
4448@subsubsection nnmairix requirements
4449
2b968687 4450Mairix searches local mail---that means, mairix absolutely must have
e6d2d263
MB
4451direct access to your mail folders. If your mail resides on another
4452server (e.g. an @acronym{IMAP} server) and you happen to have shell
4453access, @code{nnmairix} supports running mairix remotely, e.g. via ssh.
4454
4455Additionally, @code{nnmairix} only supports the following Gnus back
2b968687
MB
4456ends: @code{nnml}, @code{nnmaildir}, and @code{nnimap}. You must use
4457one of these back ends for using @code{nnmairix}. Other back ends, like
4458@code{nnmbox}, @code{nnfolder} or @code{nnmh}, won't work.
e6d2d263
MB
4459
4460If you absolutely must use mbox and still want to use @code{nnmairix},
4461you can set up a local @acronym{IMAP} server, which you then access via
4462@code{nnimap}. This is a rather massive setup for accessing some mbox
030cca00
MB
4463files, so just change to MH or Maildir already... However, if you're
4464really, really passionate about using mbox, you might want to look into
4465the package @file{mairix.el}, which comes with Emacs 23.
e6d2d263
MB
4466
4467@node What nnmairix does
4468@subsubsection What nnmairix does
4469
4470The back end @code{nnmairix} enables you to call mairix from within Gnus,
4471either to query mairix with a search term or to update the
4472database. While visiting a message in the summary buffer, you can use
4473several pre-defined shortcuts for calling mairix, e.g. to quickly
4474search for all mails from the sender of the current message or to
4475display the whole thread associated with the message, even if the
4476mails are in different folders.
4477
4478Additionally, you can create permanent @code{nnmairix} groups which are bound
4479to certain mairix searches. This way, you can easily create a group
4480containing mails from a certain sender, with a certain subject line or
4481even for one specific thread based on the Message-ID. If you check for
4482new mail in these folders (e.g. by pressing @kbd{g} or @kbd{M-g}), they
867d4bb3 4483automatically update themselves by calling mairix.
e6d2d263
MB
4484
4485You might ask why you need @code{nnmairix} at all, since mairix already
4486creates the group, populates it with links to the mails so that you can
030cca00 4487then access it with Gnus, right? Well, this @emph{might} work, but often
2b968687 4488does not---at least not without problems. Most probably you will get
e6d2d263
MB
4489strange article counts, and sometimes you might see mails which Gnus
4490claims have already been canceled and are inaccessible. This is due to
4491the fact that Gnus isn't really amused when things are happening behind
4492its back. Another problem can be the mail back end itself, e.g. if you
4493use mairix with an @acronym{IMAP} server (I had Dovecot complaining
4494about corrupt index files when mairix changed the contents of the search
4495group). Using @code{nnmairix} should circumvent these problems.
4496
030cca00
MB
4497@code{nnmairix} is not really a mail back end---it's actually more like
4498a wrapper, sitting between a ``real'' mail back end where mairix stores
4499the searches and the Gnus front end. You can choose between three
4500different mail back ends for the mairix folders: @code{nnml},
4501@code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnimap}. @code{nnmairix} will call the mairix
4502binary so that the search results are stored in folders named
e6d2d263 4503@code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>} on this mail back end, but it will
030cca00
MB
4504present these folders in the Gnus front end only with @code{<NAME>}.
4505You can use an existing mail back end where you already store your mail,
4506but if you're uncomfortable with @code{nnmairix} creating new mail
4507groups alongside your other mail, you can also create e.g. a new
4508@code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml} server exclusively for mairix, but then
4509make sure those servers do not accidentally receive your new mail
4510(@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). A special case exists if you want to use
4511mairix remotely on an IMAP server with @code{nnimap}---here the mairix
4512folders and your other mail must be on the same @code{nnimap} back end.
e6d2d263
MB
4513
4514@node Setting up mairix
4515@subsubsection Setting up mairix
4516
4517First: create a backup of your mail folders (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}).
4518
4519Setting up mairix is easy: simply create a @file{.mairixrc} file with
4520(at least) the following entries:
4521
4522@example
4523# Your Maildir/MH base folder
4524base=~/Maildir
4525@end example
4526
2b968687
MB
4527This is the base folder for your mails. All the following directories
4528are relative to this base folder. If you want to use @code{nnmairix}
4529with @code{nnimap}, this base directory has to point to the mail
4530directory where the @acronym{IMAP} server stores the mail folders!
e6d2d263 4531
e6d2d263
MB
4532@example
4533maildir= ... your maildir folders which should be indexed ...
4534mh= ... your nnml/mh folders which should be indexed ...
4535mbox = ... your mbox files which should be indexed ...
4536@end example
4537
9e601b8d
MB
4538This specifies all your mail folders and mbox files (relative to the
4539base directory!) you want to index with mairix. Note that the
4540@code{nnml} back end saves mails in MH format, so you have to put those
4541directories in the @code{mh} line. See the example at the end of this
4542section and mairixrc's man-page for further details.
e6d2d263
MB
4543
4544@example
4545omit=zz_mairix-*
4546@end example
4547
4548@vindex nnmairix-group-prefix
4549This should make sure that you don't accidentally index the mairix
4550search results. You can change the prefix of these folders with the
4551variable @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
4552
e6d2d263
MB
4553@example
4554mformat= ... 'maildir' or 'mh' ...
4555database= ... location of database file ...
4556@end example
4557
4558The @code{format} setting specifies the output format for the mairix
4559search folder. Set this to @code{mh} if you want to access search results
4560with @code{nnml}. Otherwise choose @code{maildir}.
4561
2b968687
MB
4562To summarize, here is my shortened @file{.mairixrc} file as an example:
4563
4564@example
4565base=~/Maildir
4566maildir=.personal:.work:.logcheck:.sent
4567mh=../Mail/nnml/*...
4568mbox=../mboxmail/mailarchive_year*
4569mformat=maildir
4570omit=zz_mairix-*
4571database=~/.mairixdatabase
4572@end example
4573
4574In this case, the base directory is @file{~/Maildir}, where all my Maildir
4575folders are stored. As you can see, the folders are separated by
4576colons. If you wonder why every folder begins with a dot: this is
4577because I use Dovecot as @acronym{IMAP} server, which again uses
4578@code{Maildir++} folders. For testing nnmairix, I also have some
4579@code{nnml} mail, which is saved in @file{~/Mail/nnml}. Since this has
4580to be specified relative to the @code{base} directory, the @code{../Mail}
4581notation is needed. Note that the line ends in @code{*...}, which means
4582to recursively scan all files under this directory. Without the three
4583dots, the wildcard @code{*} will not work recursively. I also have some
4584old mbox files with archived mail lying around in @file{~/mboxmail}.
4585The other lines should be obvious.
4586
4587See the man page for @code{mairixrc} for details and further options,
4588especially regarding wildcard usage, which may be a little different
4589than you are used to.
4590
4591Now simply call @code{mairix} to create the index for the first time.
4592Note that this may take a few minutes, but every following index will do
4593the updates incrementally and hence is very fast.
e6d2d263
MB
4594
4595@node Configuring nnmairix
4596@subsubsection Configuring nnmairix
4597
4598In group mode, type @kbd{G b c}
4599(@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). This will ask you for all
4600necessary information and create a @code{nnmairix} server as a foreign
4601server. You will have to specify the following:
4602
4603@itemize @bullet
4604
4605@item
2b968687 4606The @strong{name} of the @code{nnmairix} server---choose whatever you
e6d2d263
MB
4607want.
4608
4609@item
9e601b8d
MB
4610The name of the @strong{back end server} where mairix should store its
4611searches. This must be a full server name, like @code{nnml:mymail}.
4612Just hit @kbd{TAB} to see the available servers. Currently, servers
4613which are accessed through @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnimap} and
4614@code{nnml} are supported. As explained above, for locally stored
4615mails, this can be an existing server where you store your mails.
030cca00
MB
4616However, you can also create e.g. a new @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml}
4617server exclusively for @code{nnmairix} in your secondary select methods
4618(@pxref{Finding the News}). If you use a secondary @code{nnml} server
4619just for mairix, make sure that you explicitly set the server variable
4620@code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}, or you might loose mail
4621(@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). If you want to use mairix remotely on an
9e601b8d
MB
4622@acronym{IMAP} server, you have to choose the corresponding
4623@code{nnimap} server here.
e6d2d263
MB
4624
4625@item
4626@vindex nnmairix-mairix-search-options
4627The @strong{command} to call the mairix binary. This will usually just
4628be @code{mairix}, but you can also choose something like @code{ssh
4629SERVER mairix} if you want to call mairix remotely, e.g. on your
4630@acronym{IMAP} server. If you want to add some default options to
4631mairix, you could do this here, but better use the variable
4632@code{nnmairix-mairix-search-options} instead.
4633
4634@item
4635The name of the @strong{default search group}. This will be the group
4636where all temporary mairix searches are stored, i.e. all searches which
4637are not bound to permanent @code{nnmairix} groups. Choose whatever you
4638like.
4639
4640@item
4641If the mail back end is @code{nnimap} or @code{nnmaildir}, you will be
4642asked if you work with @strong{Maildir++}, i.e. with hidden maildir
4643folders (=beginning with a dot). For example, you have to answer
4644@samp{yes} here if you work with the Dovecot @acronym{IMAP}
4645server. Otherwise, you should answer @samp{no} here.
4646
4647@end itemize
4648
4649@node nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
4650@subsubsection nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
4651
4652In group mode:
4653
4654@table @kbd
4655
4656@item G b c
4657@kindex G b c (Group)
4658@findex nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group
4659Creates @code{nnmairix} server and default search group for this server
4660(@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). You should have done
4661this by now (@pxref{Configuring nnmairix}).
4662
4663@item G b s
4664@kindex G b s (Group)
4665@findex nnmairix-search
4666Prompts for query which is then sent to the mairix binary. Search
4667results are put into the default search group which is automatically
4668displayed (@code{nnmairix-search}).
4669
4670@item G b m
4671@kindex G b m (Group)
4672@findex nnmairix-widget-search
4673Allows you to create a mairix search or a permanent group more
4674comfortably using graphical widgets, similar to a customization
4675group. Just try it to see how it works (@code{nnmairix-widget-search}).
4676
4677@item G b i
4678@kindex G b i (Group)
4679@findex nnmairix-search-interactive
4680Another command for creating a mairix query more comfortably, but uses
4681only the minibuffer (@code{nnmairix-search-interactive}).
4682
4683@item G b g
4684@kindex G b g (Group)
4685@findex nnmairix-create-search-group
4686Creates a permanent group which is associated with a search query
4687(@code{nnmairix-create-search-group}). The @code{nnmairix} back end
4688automatically calls mairix when you update this group with @kbd{g} or
4689@kbd{M-g}.
4690
4691@item G b q
4692@kindex G b q (Group)
4693@findex nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group
4694Changes the search query for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor
4695(@code{nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group}).
4696
4697@item G b t
4698@kindex G b t (Group)
4699@findex nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group
4700Toggles the 'threads' parameter for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor,
4701i.e. if you want see the whole threads of the found messages
4702(@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group}).
4703
4704@item G b u
4705@kindex G b u (Group)
4706@findex nnmairix-update-database
4707@vindex nnmairix-mairix-update-options
4708Calls mairix binary for updating the database
4709(@code{nnmairix-update-database}). The default parameters are @code{-F}
4710and @code{-Q} for making this as fast as possible (see variable
4711@code{nnmairix-mairix-update-options} for defining these default
4712options).
4713
4714@item G b r
4715@kindex G b r (Group)
4716@findex nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group
4717Keep articles in this @code{nnmairix} group always read or unread, or leave the
4718marks unchanged (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group}).
4719
4720@item G b d
4721@kindex G b d (Group)
4722@findex nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group
4723Recreate @code{nnmairix} group on the ``real'' mail back end
4724(@code{nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group}). You can do this if
4725you always get wrong article counts with a @code{nnmairix} group.
4726
4727@item G b a
4728@kindex G b a (Group)
4729@findex nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group
4730Toggles the @code{allow-fast} parameters for group under cursor
4731(@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group}). The default
4732behavior of @code{nnmairix} is to do a mairix search every time you
4733update or enter the group. With the @code{allow-fast} parameter set,
4734mairix will only be called when you explicitly update the group, but not
4735upon entering. This makes entering the group faster, but it may also
4736lead to dangling symlinks if something changed between updating and
4737entering the group which is not yet in the mairix database.
4738
4739@item G b p
4740@kindex G b p (Group)
4741@findex nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group
4742Toggle marks propagation for this group
4743(@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group}). (@pxref{Propagating
4744marks}).
4745
4746@item G b o
4747@kindex G b o (Group)
4748@findex nnmairix-propagate-marks
4749Manually propagate marks (@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks}); needed only when
4750@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} is set to @code{nil}.
4751
4752@end table
4753
4754In summary mode:
4755
4756@table @kbd
4757
4758@item $ m
4759@kindex $ m (Summary)
4760@findex nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article
4761Allows you to create a mairix query or group based on the current
4762message using graphical widgets (same as @code{nnmairix-widget-search})
4763(@code{nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article}).
4764
4765@item $ g
4766@kindex $ g (Summary)
4767@findex nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message
4768Interactively creates a new search group with query based on the current
4769message, but uses the minibuffer instead of graphical widgets
4770(@code{nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message}).
4771
4772@item $ t
4773@kindex $ t (Summary)
4774@findex nnmairix-search-thread-this-article
4775Searches thread for the current article
4776(@code{nnmairix-search-thread-this-article}). This is effectively a
4777shortcut for calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{m:msgid} of the
4778current article and enabled threads.
4779
4780@item $ f
4781@kindex $ f (Summary)
4782@findex nnmairix-search-from-this-article
4783Searches all messages from sender of the current article
4784(@code{nnmairix-search-from-this-article}). This is a shortcut for
4785calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{f:From}.
4786
4787@item $ o
4788@kindex $ o (Summary)
4789@findex nnmairix-goto-original-article
4790(Only in @code{nnmairix} groups!) Tries determine the group this article
4791originally came from and displays the article in this group, so that
4792e.g. replying to this article the correct posting styles/group
4793parameters are applied (@code{nnmairix-goto-original-article}). This
4794function will use the registry if available, but can also parse the
2b968687 4795article file name as a fallback method.
e6d2d263
MB
4796
4797@item $ u
4798@kindex $ u (Summary)
4799@findex nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article
4800Remove possibly existing tick mark from original article
4801(@code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article}). (@pxref{nnmairix
4802tips and tricks}).
4803
4804@end table
4805
4806@node Propagating marks
4807@subsubsection Propagating marks
4808
4809First of: you really need a patched mairix binary for using the marks
4810propagation feature efficiently. Otherwise, you would have to update
4811the mairix database all the time. You can get the patch at
4812
030cca00 4813@uref{http://www.randomsample.de/mairix-maildir-patch.tar}
e6d2d263
MB
4814
4815You need the mairix v0.21 source code for this patch; everything else
4816is explained in the accompanied readme file. If you don't want to use
4817marks propagation, you don't have to apply these patches, but they also
4818fix some annoyances regarding changing maildir flags, so it might still
4819be useful to you.
4820
4821With the patched mairix binary, you can use @code{nnmairix} as an
4822alternative to mail splitting (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}). For
4823example, instead of splitting all mails from @samp{david@@foobar.com}
4824into a group, you can simply create a search group with the query
4825@samp{f:david@@foobar.com}. This is actually what ``smart folders'' are
4826all about: simply put everything in one mail folder and dynamically
4827create searches instead of splitting. This is more flexible, since you
4828can dynamically change your folders any time you want to. This also
4829implies that you will usually read your mails in the @code{nnmairix}
4830groups instead of your ``real'' mail groups.
4831
4832There is one problem, though: say you got a new mail from
2b968687 4833@samp{david@@foobar.com}; it will now show up in two groups, the
e6d2d263
MB
4834``real'' group (your INBOX, for example) and in the @code{nnmairix}
4835search group (provided you have updated the mairix database). Now you
4836enter the @code{nnmairix} group and read the mail. The mail will be
2b968687 4837marked as read, but only in the @code{nnmairix} group---in the ``real''
e6d2d263
MB
4838mail group it will be still shown as unread.
4839
4840You could now catch up the mail group (@pxref{Group Data}), but this is
4841tedious and error prone, since you may overlook mails you don't have
4842created @code{nnmairix} groups for. Of course, you could first use
4843@code{nnmairix-goto-original-article} (@pxref{nnmairix keyboard
4844shortcuts}) and then read the mail in the original group, but that's
4845even more cumbersome.
4846
4847Clearly, the easiest way would be if marks could somehow be
4848automatically set for the original article. This is exactly what
4849@emph{marks propagation} is about.
4850
4851Marks propagation is deactivated by default. You can activate it for a
4852certain @code{nnmairix} group with
4853@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group} (bound to @kbd{G b
4854p}). This function will warn you if you try to use it with your default
4855search group; the reason is that the default search group is used for
4856temporary searches, and it's easy to accidentally propagate marks from
4857this group. However, you can ignore this warning if you really want to.
4858
4859With marks propagation enabled, all the marks you set in a @code{nnmairix}
4860group should now be propagated to the original article. For example,
4861you can now tick an article (by default with @kbd{!}) and this mark should
4862magically be set for the original article, too.
4863
4864A few more remarks which you may or may not want to know:
4865
4866@vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close
4867Marks will not be set immediately, but only upon closing a group. This
4868not only makes marks propagation faster, it also avoids problems with
4869dangling symlinks when dealing with maildir files (since changing flags
4870will change the file name). You can also control when to propagate marks
4871via @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} (see the doc-string for
4872details).
4873
4874Obviously, @code{nnmairix} will have to look up the original group for every
4875article you want to set marks for. If available, @code{nnmairix} will first use
4876the registry for determining the original group. The registry is very
4877fast, hence you should really, really enable the registry when using
4878marks propagation. If you don't have to worry about RAM and disc space,
4879set @code{gnus-registry-max-entries} to a large enough value; to be on
4880the safe side, choose roughly the amount of mails you index with mairix.
4881
4882@vindex nnmairix-only-use-registry
4883If you don't want to use the registry or the registry hasn't seen the
2b968687
MB
4884original article yet, @code{nnmairix} will use an additional mairix
4885search for determining the file name of the article. This, of course, is
4886way slower than the registry---if you set hundreds or even thousands of
4887marks this way, it might take some time. You can avoid this situation by
4888setting @code{nnmairix-only-use-registry} to t.
e6d2d263
MB
4889
4890Maybe you also want to propagate marks the other way round, i.e. if you
4891tick an article in a "real" mail group, you'd like to have the same
4892article in a @code{nnmairix} group ticked, too. For several good
4893reasons, this can only be done efficiently if you use maildir. To
4894immediately contradict myself, let me mention that it WON'T work with
4895@code{nnmaildir}, since @code{nnmaildir} stores the marks externally and
4896not in the file name. Therefore, propagating marks to @code{nnmairix}
4897groups will usually only work if you use an IMAP server which uses
4898maildir as its file format.
4899
4900@vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups
4901If you work with this setup, just set
4902@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t} and see what
4903happens. If you don't like what you see, just set it to @code{nil} again. One
4904problem might be that you get a wrong number of unread articles; this
4905usually happens when you delete or expire articles in the original
4906groups. When this happens, you can recreate the @code{nnmairix} group on the
4907back end using @kbd{G b d}.
4908
4909@node nnmairix tips and tricks
4910@subsubsection nnmairix tips and tricks
4911
4912@itemize
4913@item
4914Checking Mail
4915
4916@findex nnmairix-update-groups
4917I put all my important mail groups at group level 1. The mairix groups
4918have group level 5, so they do not get checked at start up (@pxref{Group
4919Levels}).
4920
4921I use the following to check for mails:
4922
4923@lisp
4924(defun my-check-mail-mairix-update (level)
4925 (interactive "P")
4926 ;; if no prefix given, set level=1
4927 (gnus-group-get-new-news (or level 1))
4928 (nnmairix-update-groups "mairixsearch" t t)
4929 (gnus-group-list-groups))
4930
4931(define-key gnus-group-mode-map "g" 'my-check-mail-mairix-update)
4932@end lisp
4933
4934Instead of @samp{"mairixsearch"} use the name of your @code{nnmairix}
4935server. See the doc string for @code{nnmairix-update-groups} for
4936details.
4937
4938@item
4939Example: search group for ticked articles
4940
4941For example, you can create a group for all ticked articles, where the
4942articles always stay unread:
4943
4944Hit @kbd{G b g}, enter group name (e.g. @samp{important}), use
4945@samp{F:f} as query and do not include threads.
4946
4947Now activate marks propagation for this group by using @kbd{G b p}. Then
4948activate the always-unread feature by using @kbd{G b r} twice.
4949
2b968687 4950So far so good---but how do you remove the tick marks in the @code{nnmairix}
e6d2d263
MB
4951group? There are two options: You may simply use
4952@code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article} (bound to @kbd{$ u}) to remove
4953tick marks from the original article. The other possibility is to set
4954@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t}, but see the above
4955comments about this option. If it works for you, the tick marks should
4956also exist in the @code{nnmairix} group and you can remove them as usual,
4957e.g. by marking an article as read.
4958
4959When you have removed a tick mark from the original article, this
4960article should vanish from the @code{nnmairix} group after you have updated the
4961mairix database and updated the group. Fortunately, there is a function
4962for doing exactly that: @code{nnmairix-update-groups}. See the previous code
4963snippet and the doc string for details.
4964
4965@item
4966Dealing with auto-subscription of mail groups
4967
4968As described before, all @code{nnmairix} groups are in fact stored on
4969the mail back end in the form @samp{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can
4970see them when you enter the back end server in the server buffer. You
4971should not subscribe these groups! Unfortunately, these groups will
2b968687 4972usually get @emph{auto-subscribed} when you use @code{nnmaildir} or
e6d2d263
MB
4973@code{nnml}, i.e. you will suddenly see groups of the form
4974@samp{zz_mairix*} pop up in your group buffer. If this happens to you,
4975simply kill these groups with C-k. For avoiding this, turn off
4976auto-subscription completely by setting the variable
4977@code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups} to @code{nil} (@pxref{Filtering New
4978Groups}), or if you like to keep this feature use the following kludge
4979for turning it off for all groups beginning with @samp{zz_}:
4980
4981@lisp
4982(setq gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
4983 "^\\(nnml\\|nnfolder\\|nnmbox\\|nnmh\\|nnbabyl\\|nnmaildir\\).*:\\([^z]\\|z$\\|\\z[^z]\\|zz$\\|zz[^_]\\|zz_$\\).*")
4984@end lisp
4985
4986@end itemize
4987
4988@node nnmairix caveats
4989@subsubsection nnmairix caveats
4990
4991@itemize
4992@item
030cca00
MB
4993You can create a secondary @code{nnml} server just for nnmairix, but then
4994you have to explicitly set the corresponding server variable
4995@code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}. Otherwise, new mail might get
4996put into this secondary server (and would never show up again). Here's
4997an example server definition:
4998
4999@lisp
5000(nnml "mairix" (nnml-directory "mairix") (nnml-get-new-mail nil))
5001@end lisp
5002
5003(The @code{nnmaildir} back end also has a server variabe
5004@code{get-new-mail}, but its default value is @code{nil}, so you don't
5005have to explicitly set it if you use a @code{nnmaildir} server just for
5006mairix.)
e6d2d263
MB
5007
5008@item
5009If you use the Gnus registry: don't use the registry with
5010@code{nnmairix} groups (put them in
2b968687
MB
5011@code{gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups}). Be @emph{extra careful} if
5012you use @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}; mails which are
e6d2d263
MB
5013split into @code{nnmairix} groups are usually gone for good as soon as
5014you check the group for new mail (yes, it has happened to me...).
5015
5016@item
2b968687 5017Therefore: @emph{Never ever} put ``real'' mails into @code{nnmairix}
e6d2d263
MB
5018groups (you shouldn't be able to, anyway).
5019
030cca00
MB
5020@item
5021If you use the Gnus agent (@pxref{Gnus Unplugged}): don't agentize
5022@code{nnmairix} groups (though I have no idea what happens if you do).
5023
e6d2d263
MB
5024@item
5025mairix does only support us-ascii characters.
5026
5027@item
5028@code{nnmairix} uses a rather brute force method to force Gnus to
5029completely reread the group on the mail back end after mairix was
2b968687 5030called---it simply deletes and re-creates the group on the mail
e6d2d263
MB
5031back end. So far, this has worked for me without any problems, and I
5032don't see how @code{nnmairix} could delete other mail groups than its
5033own, but anyway: you really should have a backup of your mail
5034folders.
5035
5036@item
5037All necessary information is stored in the group parameters
5038(@pxref{Group Parameters}). This has the advantage that no active file
5039is needed, but also implies that when you kill a @code{nnmairix} group,
5040it is gone for good.
5041
5042@item
5043@findex nnmairix-purge-old-groups
5044If you create and kill a lot of @code{nnmairix} groups, the
5045``zz_mairix-*'' groups will accumulate on the mail back end server. To
5046delete old groups which are no longer needed, call
5047@code{nnmairix-purge-old-groups}. Note that this assumes that you don't
5048save any ``real'' mail in folders of the form
5049@code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can change the prefix of
5050@code{nnmairix} groups by changing the variable
5051@code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
5052
5053@item
2b968687 5054The following only applies if you @emph{don't} use the mentioned patch
e6d2d263
MB
5055for mairix (@pxref{Propagating marks}):
5056
5057A problem can occur when using @code{nnmairix} with maildir folders and
5058comes with the fact that maildir stores mail flags like @samp{Seen} or
5059@samp{Replied} by appending chars @samp{S} and @samp{R} to the message
5060file name, respectively. This implies that currently you would have to
5061update the mairix database not only when new mail arrives, but also when
5062mail flags are changing. The same applies to new mails which are indexed
5063while they are still in the @samp{new} folder but then get moved to
5064@samp{cur} when Gnus has seen the mail. If you don't update the database
5065after this has happened, a mairix query can lead to symlinks pointing to
5066non-existing files. In Gnus, these messages will usually appear with
5067``(none)'' entries in the header and can't be accessed. If this happens
5068to you, using @kbd{G b u} and updating the group will usually fix this.
5069
5070@end itemize
5071
4009494e
GM
5072@node Misc Group Stuff
5073@section Misc Group Stuff
5074
5075@menu
5076* Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
5077* Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
5078* Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
5079* File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
5080* Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
5081@end menu
5082
5083@table @kbd
5084
5085@item v
5086@kindex v (Group)
5087@cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
5088The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
5089command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
5090
5091@lisp
5092(define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
5093 (lambda ()
5094 (interactive)
5095 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
5096@end lisp
5097
5098On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
5099@xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
5100
5101@item ^
5102@kindex ^ (Group)
5103@findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
5104Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
5105@xref{Server Buffer}.
5106
5107@item a
5108@kindex a (Group)
5109@findex gnus-group-post-news
5110Start composing a message (a news by default)
5111(@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
5112under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5113Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
5114article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
5115with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
5116
5117@item m
5118@kindex m (Group)
5119@findex gnus-group-mail
5120Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
5121use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
5122prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5123@xref{Composing Messages}.
5124
5125@item i
5126@kindex i (Group)
5127@findex gnus-group-news
5128Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
5129post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
5130for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
5131
5132This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5133This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5134sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5135in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5136for this to work though.
5137
01c52d31
MB
5138@item G z
5139@kindex G z (Group)
5140@findex gnus-group-compact-group
5141
5142Compact the group under point (@code{gnus-group-compact-group}).
5143Currently implemented only in nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes
5144gaps between article numbers, hence getting a correct total article
5145count.
5146
4009494e
GM
5147@end table
5148
5149Variables for the group buffer:
5150
5151@table @code
5152
5153@item gnus-group-mode-hook
5154@vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
5155is called after the group buffer has been
5156created.
5157
5158@item gnus-group-prepare-hook
5159@vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
5160is called after the group buffer is
5161generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
5162unnatural way.
5163
5164@item gnus-group-prepared-hook
5165@vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
5166is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
5167generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
5168
5169@item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
5170@vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
5171Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
5172whether they are empty or not.
5173
4009494e
GM
5174@end table
5175
5176@node Scanning New Messages
5177@subsection Scanning New Messages
5178@cindex new messages
5179@cindex scanning new news
5180
5181@table @kbd
5182
5183@item g
5184@kindex g (Group)
5185@findex gnus-group-get-new-news
5186@c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
5187Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
5188this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
5189(@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
5190command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
5191back end(s).
5192
5193@item M-g
5194@kindex M-g (Group)
5195@findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
5196@vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
5197@c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
5198Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
5199(@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
5200@code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
5201to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
5202
5203@findex gnus-activate-all-groups
5204@cindex activating groups
5205@item C-c M-g
5206@kindex C-c M-g (Group)
5207Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
5208
5209@item R
5210@kindex R (Group)
5211@cindex restarting
5212@findex gnus-group-restart
5213Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
5214file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
5215Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
5216
5217@end table
5218
5219@vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
5220@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
5221
5222@vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
5223@code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
5224news.
5225
5226
5227@node Group Information
5228@subsection Group Information
5229@cindex group information
5230@cindex information on groups
5231
5232@table @kbd
5233
5234
5235@item H f
5236@kindex H f (Group)
5237@findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
5238@vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
5239@cindex FAQ
5240@cindex ange-ftp
5241Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} for the current group
5242(@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the @acronym{FAQ}
5243from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on
5244a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
5245In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
5246between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be
5247used for fetching the file.
5248
5249If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
5250through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
5251
5252@item H c
5253@kindex H c (Group)
5254@findex gnus-group-fetch-charter
5255@vindex gnus-group-charter-alist
5256@cindex charter
5257Try to open the charter for the current group in a web browser
5258(@code{gnus-group-fetch-charter}). Query for a group if given a
5259prefix argument.
5260
5261Gnus will use @code{gnus-group-charter-alist} to find the location of
5262the charter. If no location is known, Gnus will fetch the control
5263messages for the group, which in some cases includes the charter.
5264
5265@item H C
5266@kindex H C (Group)
5267@findex gnus-group-fetch-control
5268@vindex gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url
5269@cindex control message
5270Fetch the control messages for the group from the archive at
5271@code{ftp.isc.org} (@code{gnus-group-fetch-control}). Query for a
5272group if given a prefix argument.
5273
5274If @code{gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url} is non-@code{nil},
5275Gnus will open the control messages in a browser using
5276@code{browse-url}. Otherwise they are fetched using @code{ange-ftp}
5277and displayed in an ephemeral group.
5278
5279Note that the control messages are compressed. To use this command
5280you need to turn on @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed
5281Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
5282
5283@item H d
5284@itemx C-c C-d
5285@c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
5286@kindex H d (Group)
5287@kindex C-c C-d (Group)
5288@cindex describing groups
5289@cindex group description
5290@findex gnus-group-describe-group
5291Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
5292a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
5293
5294@item M-d
5295@kindex M-d (Group)
5296@findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
5297Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
5298prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
5299
5300@item H v
5301@itemx V
5302@kindex V (Group)
5303@kindex H v (Group)
5304@cindex version
5305@findex gnus-version
5306Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
5307
5308@item ?
5309@kindex ? (Group)
5310@findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
5311Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
5312
5313@item C-c C-i
5314@kindex C-c C-i (Group)
5315@cindex info
5316@cindex manual
5317@findex gnus-info-find-node
5318Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
5319@end table
5320
5321
5322@node Group Timestamp
5323@subsection Group Timestamp
5324@cindex timestamps
5325@cindex group timestamps
5326
5327It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
5328group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
5329@code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
5330
5331@lisp
5332(add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
5333@end lisp
5334
5335After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
5336
5337This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
5338use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
5339
5340@lisp
5341(setq gnus-group-line-format
5342 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
5343@end lisp
5344
5345This will result in lines looking like:
5346
5347@example
5348* 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
5349 0: custom 19961002T012713
5350@end example
5351
5352As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
5353may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
5354something like:
5355
5356@lisp
5357(setq gnus-group-line-format
5358 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
5359@end lisp
5360
5361If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
5362user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
5363trick:
5364
5365@lisp
5366(setq gnus-group-line-format
5367 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
5368(defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
5369 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
5370 (if time
5371 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
5372 "")))
5373@end lisp
5374
5375
5376@node File Commands
5377@subsection File Commands
5378@cindex file commands
5379
5380@table @kbd
5381
5382@item r
5383@kindex r (Group)
5384@findex gnus-group-read-init-file
5385@vindex gnus-init-file
5386@cindex reading init file
5387Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
5388@file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
5389
5390@item s
5391@kindex s (Group)
5392@findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
5393@cindex saving .newsrc
5394Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
5395(@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
5396file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
5397
5398@c @item Z
5399@c @kindex Z (Group)
5400@c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
5401@c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
5402
5403@end table
5404
5405
5406@node Sieve Commands
5407@subsection Sieve Commands
5408@cindex group sieve commands
5409
5410Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
5411the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
5412sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
5413commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
5414script that can be transfered to the server somehow.
5415
5416@vindex gnus-sieve-file
5417@vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
5418@vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
5419The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
5420default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
5421between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
5422@code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
5423outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
5424regenerate the Sieve script.
5425
5426@vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
5427The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
5428is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
5429placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
5430is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
5431example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
5432"owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
5433code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
5434@code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
5435except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
5436
5437@example
5438if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
5439 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
5440 stop;
5441@}
5442@end example
5443
5444@xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
5445
5446@table @kbd
5447
5448@item D g
5449@kindex D g (Group)
5450@findex gnus-sieve-generate
5451@vindex gnus-sieve-file
5452@cindex generating sieve script
5453Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
5454put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
5455
5456@item D u
5457@kindex D u (Group)
5458@findex gnus-sieve-update
5459@vindex gnus-sieve-file
5460@cindex updating sieve script
5461Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
5462@code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
5463server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
5464
5465@end table
5466
5467
5468@node Summary Buffer
5469@chapter Summary Buffer
5470@cindex summary buffer
5471
5472A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
5473move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
5474
5475The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
5476group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
5477
5478You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
5479
5480You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
5481customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
5482available in Emacs.
5483
5484@kindex v (Summary)
5485@cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
5486The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
5487command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
5488@lisp
5489(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
5490@end lisp
5491
5492@menu
5493* Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
5494* Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
5495* Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
5496* Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
5497* Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
5498* Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
5499* Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
5500* Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
5501* Threading:: How threads are made.
5502* Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
5503* Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
5504* Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
5505* Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
01c52d31 5506* Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4009494e
GM
5507* Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
5508* Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
5509* Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
5510* Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
5511* MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
5512* Charsets:: Character set issues.
5513* Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
5514* Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
5515* Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
5516* Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
5517* Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
5518* Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
5519* Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
5520* Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
5521 or reselecting the current group.
5522* Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
5523* Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
5524* Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
5525* Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
5526@end menu
5527
5528
5529@node Summary Buffer Format
5530@section Summary Buffer Format
5531@cindex summary buffer format
5532
5533@iftex
5534@iflatex
5535\gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
5536\put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
5537\put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
5538}
5539@end iflatex
5540@end iftex
5541
5542@menu
5543* Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
5544* To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
5545* Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
5546* Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
5547@end menu
5548
5549@findex mail-extract-address-components
5550@findex gnus-extract-address-components
5551@vindex gnus-extract-address-components
5552Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
5553variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
5554@code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
5555@code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
5556fast, and too simplistic solution; and
5557@code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
5558slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
5559cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
5560
5561@lisp
5562(setq gnus-extract-address-components
5563 'mail-extract-address-components)
5564@end lisp
5565
5566@vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
5567@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
5568article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
5569with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
5570
5571
5572@node Summary Buffer Lines
5573@subsection Summary Buffer Lines
5574
5575@vindex gnus-summary-line-format
5576You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
5577the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
5578lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
5579(@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
5580
5581There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
5582the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
5583performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
5584possible to change this. Just write a new function
5585@code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
5586@xref{Positioning Point}.
5587
5588The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
5589
5590The following format specification characters and extended format
5591specification(s) are understood:
5592
5593@table @samp
5594@item N
5595Article number.
5596@item S
5597Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
5598@code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
5599@item s
5600Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
5601had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
5602(@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
5603@item F
5604Full @code{From} header.
5605@item n
5606The name (from the @code{From} header).
5607@item f
5608The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
5609From Newsgroups}).
5610@item a
5611The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
5612spec in that it uses the function designated by the
5613@code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
5614may be more thorough.
5615@item A
5616The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
5617the @code{a} spec.
5618@item L
5619Number of lines in the article.
5620@item c
5621Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
5622in some methods (like nnfolder).
5623@item k
5624Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
5625for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
5626@item I
5627Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
5628@item B
5629A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
5630lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
5631
5632@example
5633>
5634+->
5635| +->
5636| | \->
5637| | \->
5638| \->
5639+->
5640\->
5641@end example
5642
5643You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
5644that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
5645replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
5646line-drawing glyphs.
5647@table @code
5648@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
5649@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
5650Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
5651instead. The default is @samp{> }.
5652
5653@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
5654@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
5655Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
5656@code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
5657
5658@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
5659@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
5660Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
5661instead. The default is @samp{}.
5662
5663@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
5664@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
5665Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
5666
5667@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
5668@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
5669Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
5670
5671@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
5672@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
5673Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
5674
5675@item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
5676@vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
5677Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
5678
5679@end table
5680
5681@item T
5682Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
5683pushes everything after it off the screen).
5684@item [
5685Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
5686for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
5687@item ]
5688Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
5689for adopted articles.
5690@item >
5691One space for each thread level.
5692@item <
5693Twenty minus thread level spaces.
5694@item U
5695Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
5696
5697@item R
5698This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
5699mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
5700or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
5701
5702@item i
5703Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
5704@item z
5705@vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
5706Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
5707default level. If the difference between
5708@code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
5709@code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
5710@item V
5711Total thread score.
5712@item x
5713@code{Xref}.
5714@item D
5715@code{Date}.
5716@item d
5717The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
5718@item o
5719The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
5720@item M
5721@code{Message-ID}.
5722@item r
5723@code{References}.
5724@item t
5725Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
5726down summary buffer generation somewhat.
5727@item e
5728An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
5729article has any children.
5730@item P
5731The line number.
5732@item O
5733Download mark.
5734@item *
5735Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
5736@item &user-date;
5737Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
5738@code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
5739@item u
5740User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
5741be a letter. Gnus will call the function
5742@code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
5743following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
5744argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
5745into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
5746@end table
5747
5748Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
5749@code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
5750There can only be one such area.
5751
5752The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
5753have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
5754compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
5755that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
5756variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
5757buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
5758
5759The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
5760(Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
5761
5762This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
5763
5764
5765@node To From Newsgroups
5766@subsection To From Newsgroups
5767@cindex To
5768@cindex Newsgroups
5769
5770In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
5771isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
5772you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
5773headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
5774gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
5775
5776@enumerate
5777@item
5778@vindex gnus-extra-headers
5779The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
5780@code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
5781instance:
5782
5783@lisp
5784(setq gnus-extra-headers
5785 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
5786@end lisp
5787
5788This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
5789storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
5790
5791@item
5792@findex gnus-extra-header
5793The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
5794@code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
5795access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
5796
5797@example
5798"%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
5799@end example
5800
5801@item
5802@vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5803The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
5804summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
5805@code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
5806@code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
5807headers are used instead.
5808
01c52d31
MB
5809To distinguish regular articles from those where the @code{From} field
5810has been swapped, a string is prefixed to the @code{To} or
5811@code{Newsgroups} header in the summary line. By default the string is
5812@samp{-> } for @code{To} and @samp{=> } for @code{Newsgroups}, you can
5813customize these strings with @code{gnus-summary-to-prefix} and
5814@code{gnus-summary-newsgroup-prefix}.
5815
4009494e
GM
5816@end enumerate
5817
5818@vindex nnmail-extra-headers
5819A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
5820to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
5821If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
5822changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
5823and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
5824regeneration.
5825
5826@vindex gnus-summary-line-format
5827You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
5828@code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
5829@code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
5830
5831In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
5832@file{~/.gnus.el}:
5833
5834@lisp
5835(setq gnus-extra-headers
5836 '(To Newsgroups))
5837(setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
5838(setq gnus-summary-line-format
5839 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
5840(setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5841 "Your Name Here")
5842@end lisp
5843
5844(The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
5845to fit your needs.)
5846
5847A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
5848convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
5849support:
5850
5851The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
5852the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
5853nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
5854
5855@example
5856Newsgroups:full
5857@end example
5858
5859to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
5860as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
5861
5862
5863@node Summary Buffer Mode Line
5864@subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
5865
5866@vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
5867You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
5868Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
5869like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
5870
5871Here are the elements you can play with:
5872
5873@table @samp
5874@item G
5875Group name.
5876@item p
5877Unprefixed group name.
5878@item A
5879Current article number.
5880@item z
5881Current article score.
5882@item V
5883Gnus version.
5884@item U
5885Number of unread articles in this group.
5886@item e
5887Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
5888summary buffer.
5889@item Z
5890A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
5891either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
5892articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
5893and no unselected ones.
5894@item g
5895Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
5896shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
5897@item S
5898Subject of the current article.
5899@item u
5900User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
5901@item s
5902Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
5903@item d
5904Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5905@item t
5906Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5907@item r
5908Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
5909@item E
5910Number of articles expunged by the score files.
5911@end table
5912
5913
5914@node Summary Highlighting
5915@subsection Summary Highlighting
5916
5917@table @code
5918
5919@item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5920@vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5921This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
5922highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
5923@code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5924
5925@item gnus-summary-update-hook
5926@vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
5927This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
5928@code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5929
5930@item gnus-summary-selected-face
5931@vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
5932This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
5933highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
5934
5935@item gnus-summary-highlight
5936@vindex gnus-summary-highlight
5937Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
5938list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
5939. @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
5940italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
5941to something like
5942@lisp
5943(((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
5944 ((> score default) . bold))
5945@end lisp
5946As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
5947@var{face} will be applied to the line.
5948@end table
5949
5950
5951@node Summary Maneuvering
5952@section Summary Maneuvering
5953@cindex summary movement
5954
5955All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
5956behave pretty much as you'd expect.
5957
5958None of these commands select articles.
5959
5960@table @kbd
5961@item G M-n
5962@itemx M-n
5963@kindex M-n (Summary)
5964@kindex G M-n (Summary)
5965@findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
5966Go to the next summary line of an unread article
5967(@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
5968
5969@item G M-p
5970@itemx M-p
5971@kindex M-p (Summary)
5972@kindex G M-p (Summary)
5973@findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
5974Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
5975(@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
5976
5977@item G g
5978@kindex G g (Summary)
5979@findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
5980Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
5981without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
5982@end table
5983
5984If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
5985can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
5986buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
5987to the group buffer.
5988
5989Variables related to summary movement:
5990
5991@table @code
5992
5993@vindex gnus-auto-select-next
5994@item gnus-auto-select-next
5995If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
5996no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
5997the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
5998empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
5999this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
6000next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
6001is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
6002confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
6003will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
6004Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
6005command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
6006@pxref{Group Levels}.
6007
6008@item gnus-auto-select-same
6009@vindex gnus-auto-select-same
6010If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
6011article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
6012mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
6013for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
6014articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
6015
6016This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
6017
6018@item gnus-summary-check-current
6019@vindex gnus-summary-check-current
6020If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
6021to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
6022Instead, they will choose the current article.
6023
6024@item gnus-auto-center-summary
6025@vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
6026If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
6027centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
6028slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
6029set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
6030action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
6031buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
6032threads.
6033
6034This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
6035the given number of lines from the top.
6036
6037@end table
6038
6039
6040@node Choosing Articles
6041@section Choosing Articles
6042@cindex selecting articles
6043
6044@menu
6045* Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
6046* Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
6047@end menu
6048
6049
6050@node Choosing Commands
6051@subsection Choosing Commands
6052
6053None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
6054and they all select and display an article.
6055
6056If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
6057@ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
6058
6059@table @kbd
6060@item SPACE
6061@kindex SPACE (Summary)
6062@findex gnus-summary-next-page
6063Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
6064unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
6065
6066If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
6067again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
6068@kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
6069
6070@item G n
6071@itemx n
6072@kindex n (Summary)
6073@kindex G n (Summary)
6074@findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
6075@c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
6076Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
6077
6078@item G p
6079@itemx p
6080@kindex p (Summary)
6081@findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
6082@c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
6083Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
6084
6085@item G N
6086@itemx N
6087@kindex N (Summary)
6088@kindex G N (Summary)
6089@findex gnus-summary-next-article
6090Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
6091
6092@item G P
6093@itemx P
6094@kindex P (Summary)
6095@kindex G P (Summary)
6096@findex gnus-summary-prev-article
6097Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
6098
6099@item G C-n
6100@kindex G C-n (Summary)
6101@findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
6102Go to the next article with the same subject
6103(@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
6104
6105@item G C-p
6106@kindex G C-p (Summary)
6107@findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
6108Go to the previous article with the same subject
6109(@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
6110
6111@item G f
6112@itemx .
6113@kindex G f (Summary)
6114@kindex . (Summary)
6115@findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
6116Go to the first unread article
6117(@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
6118
6119@item G b
6120@itemx ,
6121@kindex G b (Summary)
6122@kindex , (Summary)
6123@findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
6124Go to the unread article with the highest score
6125(@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
6126go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
6127
6128@item G l
6129@itemx l
6130@kindex l (Summary)
6131@kindex G l (Summary)
6132@findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
6133Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
6134
6135@item G o
6136@kindex G o (Summary)
6137@findex gnus-summary-pop-article
6138@cindex history
6139@cindex article history
6140Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
6141(@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
6142command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
6143history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
6144For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
6145@pxref{Article Backlog}.
6146
6147@item G j
6148@itemx j
6149@kindex j (Summary)
6150@kindex G j (Summary)
6151@findex gnus-summary-goto-article
6152Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
6153article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
6154
6155@end table
6156
6157
6158@node Choosing Variables
6159@subsection Choosing Variables
6160
6161Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
6162
6163@table @code
6164@item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
6165@vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
6166All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
6167article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
6168this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
6169the server and display it in the article buffer.
6170
6171@item gnus-select-article-hook
6172@vindex gnus-select-article-hook
6173This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
6174@code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
6175you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
6176hook will do so.
6177
6178@item gnus-mark-article-hook
6179@vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
6180@findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
6181@findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
6182@findex gnus-unread-mark
6183This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
6184be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
6185@code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
6186mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
6187articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
6188expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
6189marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
6190instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
6191@code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
6192
6193@end table
6194
6195
6196@node Paging the Article
6197@section Scrolling the Article
6198@cindex article scrolling
6199
6200@table @kbd
6201
6202@item SPACE
6203@kindex SPACE (Summary)
6204@findex gnus-summary-next-page
6205Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
6206or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
6207next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
6208
6209@vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
6210@vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
6211If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
6212the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
6213skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
6214what is considered uninteresting with
6215@code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
6216pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
6217
6218@item DEL
6219@kindex DEL (Summary)
6220@findex gnus-summary-prev-page
6221Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
6222
6223@item RET
6224@kindex RET (Summary)
6225@findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
6226Scroll the current article one line forward
6227(@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
6228
6229@item M-RET
6230@kindex M-RET (Summary)
6231@findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
6232Scroll the current article one line backward
6233(@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
6234
6235@item A g
6236@itemx g
6237@kindex A g (Summary)
6238@kindex g (Summary)
6239@findex gnus-summary-show-article
6240@vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
6241(Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
6242given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
6243article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
6244the way it came from the server.
6245
e3e955fe 6246@cindex charset, view article with different charset
4009494e
GM
6247If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
6248@kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
6249encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
6250
6251@lisp
6252(setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
6253 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
6254 (2 . big5)))
6255@end lisp
6256
6257then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
6258
6259@item A <
6260@itemx <
6261@kindex < (Summary)
6262@kindex A < (Summary)
6263@findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
6264Scroll to the beginning of the article
6265(@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
6266
6267@item A >
6268@itemx >
6269@kindex > (Summary)
6270@kindex A > (Summary)
6271@findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
6272Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
6273
6274@item A s
6275@itemx s
6276@kindex A s (Summary)
6277@kindex s (Summary)
6278@findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
6279Perform an isearch in the article buffer
6280(@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
6281
6282@item h
6283@kindex h (Summary)
6284@findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
6285Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
6286
6287@end table
6288
6289
6290@node Reply Followup and Post
6291@section Reply, Followup and Post
6292
6293@menu
6294* Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
6295* Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
6296* Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
6297* Canceling and Superseding::
6298@end menu
6299
6300
6301@node Summary Mail Commands
6302@subsection Summary Mail Commands
6303@cindex mail
6304@cindex composing mail
6305
6306Commands for composing a mail message:
6307
6308@table @kbd
6309
6310@item S r
6311@itemx r
6312@kindex S r (Summary)
6313@kindex r (Summary)
6314@findex gnus-summary-reply
6315@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
6316@c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
6317Mail a reply to the author of the current article
6318(@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
6319
6320@item S R
6321@itemx R
6322@kindex R (Summary)
6323@kindex S R (Summary)
6324@findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
6325@c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
6326Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
6327original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
6328command uses the process/prefix convention.
6329
6330@item S w
6331@kindex S w (Summary)
6332@findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
6333Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
6334(@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
6335goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
6336@code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
6337present, that's used instead.
6338
6339@item S W
6340@kindex S W (Summary)
6341@findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
6342Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
6343message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
6344the process/prefix convention.
6345
6346@item S v
6347@kindex S v (Summary)
6348@findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
6349Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
6350(@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
6351that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
6352@code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
6353articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
6354
6355@item S V
6356@kindex S V (Summary)
6357@findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
6358Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
6359original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
6360command uses the process/prefix convention.
6361
6362@item S B r
6363@kindex S B r (Summary)
6364@findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
6365Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
6366@code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
6367If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
6368@code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
6369the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
6370correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
6371
6372@item S B R
6373@kindex S B R (Summary)
6374@findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
6375Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
6376original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
6377(@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
6378
6379@item S o m
6380@itemx C-c C-f
6381@kindex S o m (Summary)
6382@kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
6383@findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
6384@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
6385Forward the current article to some other person
6386(@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
6387is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
6388and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
6389message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
6390as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
6391forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
6392directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
6393but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
6394default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
6395section.
6396
6397@item S m
6398@itemx m
6399@kindex m (Summary)
6400@kindex S m (Summary)
6401@findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
6402@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
6403Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
6404the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
6405If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
6406
6407@item S i
6408@itemx i
6409@kindex i (Summary)
6410@kindex S i (Summary)
6411@findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
6412Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
6413post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
6414prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
6415
6416This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
6417This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
6418sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
6419in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
6420for this to work though.
6421
6422@item S D b
6423@kindex S D b (Summary)
6424@findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
6425@cindex bouncing mail
6426If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
6427reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
6428resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
6429will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
6430sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
6431the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
6432that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
6433very well fail, though.
6434
6435@item S D r
6436@kindex S D r (Summary)
6437@findex gnus-summary-resend-message
6438Not to be confused with the previous command,
6439@code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
6440send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
6441headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
6442@code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
6443means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
6444header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
6445So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
6446
6447This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
6448ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
6449@code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
6450to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
6451@code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
6452
6453This command understands the process/prefix convention
6454(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6455
6456@item S D e
6457@kindex S D e (Summary)
6458@findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
6459
6460Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
6461if it were a new message before resending.
6462
6463@item S O m
6464@kindex S O m (Summary)
6465@findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
6466Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
6467result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
6468uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6469
6470@item S M-c
6471@kindex S M-c (Summary)
6472@findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
6473@cindex crossposting
6474@cindex excessive crossposting
6475Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
6476current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
6477
6478@findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
6479This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
6480crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
6481using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
6482command understands the process/prefix convention
6483(@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
6484
6485@end table
6486
6487Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
6488Manual}, for more information.
6489
6490
6491@node Summary Post Commands
6492@subsection Summary Post Commands
6493@cindex post
6494@cindex composing news
6495
6496Commands for posting a news article:
6497
6498@table @kbd
6499@item S p
6500@itemx a
6501@kindex a (Summary)
6502@kindex S p (Summary)
6503@findex gnus-summary-post-news
6504@c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
6505Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
6506default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
6507If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
6508
6509@item S f
6510@itemx f
6511@kindex f (Summary)
6512@kindex S f (Summary)
6513@findex gnus-summary-followup
6514@c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
6515Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
6516
6517@item S F
6518@itemx F
6519@kindex S F (Summary)
6520@kindex F (Summary)
6521@c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
6522@findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
6523Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
6524(@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
6525process/prefix convention.
6526
6527@item S n
6528@kindex S n (Summary)
6529@findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
6530Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
6531message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
6532
6533@item S N
6534@kindex S N (Summary)
6535@findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
6536Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
6537message through mail and include the original message
6538(@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
6539the process/prefix convention.
6540
6541@item S o p
6542@kindex S o p (Summary)
6543@findex gnus-summary-post-forward
6544Forward the current article to a newsgroup
6545(@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
6546 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
6547of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
6548(@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
6549message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
6550as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
6551forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
6552directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
6553but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
6554default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
6555
6556@item S O p
6557@kindex S O p (Summary)
6558@findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
6559@cindex digests
6560@cindex making digests
6561Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
6562(@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
6563process/prefix convention.
6564
6565@item S u
6566@kindex S u (Summary)
6567@findex gnus-uu-post-news
6568@c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
6569Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
6570(@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
6571@end table
6572
6573Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
6574Manual}, for more information.
6575
6576
6577@node Summary Message Commands
6578@subsection Summary Message Commands
6579
6580@table @kbd
6581@item S y
6582@kindex S y (Summary)
6583@findex gnus-summary-yank-message
6584Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
6585buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
6586what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
6587process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6588
6589@end table
6590
6591
6592@node Canceling and Superseding
6593@subsection Canceling Articles
6594@cindex canceling articles
6595@cindex superseding articles
6596
6597Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
6598really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
6599
6600Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
6601
6602@findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
6603@kindex C (Summary)
6604@c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
6605Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
6606articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
6607c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
6608canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
6609This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
6610
6611Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
6612live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
6613question.
6614
6615Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
6616want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
6617prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
6618
6619Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
6620@code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
6621message, Message Manual}).
6622
6623If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
6624corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
6625your original article.
6626
6627@findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
6628@kindex S (Summary)
6629Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
6630(@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
6631where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
6632usual way.
6633
6634The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
6635sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
6636have posted almost the same article twice.
6637
6638If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
6639there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
6640waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
6641to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
6642find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
6643the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
6644header by substituting one of those words for the word
6645@code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
6646you would do normally. The previous article will be
6647canceled/superseded.
6648
6649Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
6650
6651@node Delayed Articles
6652@section Delayed Articles
6653@cindex delayed sending
6654@cindex send delayed
6655
6656Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
6657example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
6658to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
6659there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
6660
6661@lisp
6662(gnus-delay-initialize)
6663@end lisp
6664
6665@findex gnus-delay-article
6666Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
6667Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
6668(@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
6669message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
6670
6671@itemize @bullet
6672@item
6673A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
6674@code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
6675(minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
6676(months) and @code{Y} (years).
6677
6678@item
6679A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
6680delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
6681See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
6682
6683@item
6684A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
6685stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
6686already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
6687o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
6688is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
6689that means a time tomorrow.
6690@end itemize
6691
6692The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
6693couple of variables:
6694
6695@table @code
6696@item gnus-delay-default-hour
6697@vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
6698When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
6699on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
6700
6701@item gnus-delay-default-delay
6702@vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
6703This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
6704formats described above.
6705
6706@item gnus-delay-group
6707@vindex gnus-delay-group
6708Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
6709they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
6710value is @code{"delayed"}.
6711
6712@item gnus-delay-header
6713@vindex gnus-delay-header
6714The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
6715is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
6716change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
6717@end table
6718
6719The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
6720@code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
6721calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
6722@code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
6723@code{nndraft:delayed} group.
6724
6725@findex gnus-delay-send-queue
6726And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
6727which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
6728function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
6729@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
6730Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
6731execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
6732
6733@table @code
6734@item gnus-delay-initialize
6735@findex gnus-delay-initialize
6736By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
6737@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
6738argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
6739@code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
6740argument is ignored.
6741
6742For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
6743Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
6744Just don't forget to set that up :-)
6745@end table
6746
6747
6748@node Marking Articles
6749@section Marking Articles
6750@cindex article marking
6751@cindex article ticking
6752@cindex marks
6753
6754There are several marks you can set on an article.
6755
6756You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
6757neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
6758@dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
6759
6760In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
6761
6762@ifinfo
6763There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
6764@end ifinfo
6765
6766@menu
6767* Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
6768* Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
6769* Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
6770* Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
6771* Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
6772* Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
6773@end menu
6774
6775
6776@node Unread Articles
6777@subsection Unread Articles
6778
6779The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
6780other.
6781
6782@table @samp
6783@item !
6784@vindex gnus-ticked-mark
6785Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
6786
6787@dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
6788you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
6789reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
6790tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
6791news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
6792you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
6793(@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
6794
6795@item ?
6796@vindex gnus-dormant-mark
6797Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
6798
6799@dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
6800are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
6801followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
6802Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
6803messages.
6804
6805@item SPACE
6806@vindex gnus-unread-mark
6807Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
6808
6809@dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
6810@end table
6811
6812
6813@node Read Articles
6814@subsection Read Articles
6815@cindex expirable mark
6816
6817All the following marks mark articles as read.
6818
6819@table @samp
6820
6821@item r
6822@vindex gnus-del-mark
6823These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
6824command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
6825
6826@item R
6827@vindex gnus-read-mark
6828Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
6829
6830@item O
6831@vindex gnus-ancient-mark
6832Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
6833@dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
6834
6835@item K
6836@vindex gnus-killed-mark
6837Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
6838
6839@item X
6840@vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
6841Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
6842
6843@item Y
6844@vindex gnus-low-score-mark
6845Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
6846
6847@item C
6848@vindex gnus-catchup-mark
6849Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
6850
6851@item G
6852@vindex gnus-canceled-mark
6853Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
6854
6855@item F
6856@vindex gnus-souped-mark
6857@sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
6858
6859@item Q
6860@vindex gnus-sparse-mark
6861Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
6862Threading}.
6863
6864@item M
6865@vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
6866Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
6867(@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
6868
6869@end table
6870
6871All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
6872They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
6873
6874One more special mark, though:
6875
6876@table @samp
6877@item E
6878@vindex gnus-expirable-mark
6879Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
6880
6881Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
6882automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
6883control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
6884articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
6885any time.
6886@end table
6887
6888
6889@node Other Marks
6890@subsection Other Marks
6891@cindex process mark
6892@cindex bookmarks
6893
6894There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
6895read or not.
6896
6897@itemize @bullet
6898
6899@item
6900You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
6901long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
6902before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
6903in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
6904encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
6905
6906@item
6907@vindex gnus-replied-mark
6908All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
6909answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
6910(@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
6911
6912@item
6913@vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
6914All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
6915the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
6916
6917@item
6918@vindex gnus-cached-mark
6919Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
6920the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6921
6922@item
6923@vindex gnus-saved-mark
6924Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
6925religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
6926(@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
6927
6928@item
6929@vindex gnus-recent-mark
6930Articles that according to the server haven't been shown to the user
6931before are marked with a @samp{N} in the second column
6932(@code{gnus-recent-mark}). Note that not all servers support this
6933mark, in which case it simply never appears. Compare with
6934@code{gnus-unseen-mark}.
6935
6936@item
6937@vindex gnus-unseen-mark
6938Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
6939with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
6940Compare with @code{gnus-recent-mark}.
6941
6942@item
6943@vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
6944When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
6945downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
6946@samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
6947(The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
6948use.)
6949
6950@item
6951@vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
6952When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
6953not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
6954are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
6955articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
6956@code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
6957
6958@item
6959@vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
6960The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
6961automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
6962download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
6963explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
6964(The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
6965use.)
6966
6967@item
6968@vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
6969@vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
6970If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
6971marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
6972@code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
6973
6974@item
6975@vindex gnus-process-mark
6976Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
6977variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
6978instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
6979all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
6980marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
6981
6982@end itemize
6983
6984You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
6985appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
6986replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
6987
6988Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
6989replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
6990you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
6991
6992
6993@node Setting Marks
6994@subsection Setting Marks
6995@cindex setting marks
6996
6997All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
6998
6999@table @kbd
7000@item M c
7001@itemx M-u
7002@kindex M c (Summary)
7003@kindex M-u (Summary)
7004@findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
7005@cindex mark as unread
7006Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
7007(@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
7008article as unread.
7009
7010@item M t
7011@itemx !
7012@kindex ! (Summary)
7013@kindex M t (Summary)
7014@findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
7015Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
7016@xref{Article Caching}.
7017
7018@item M ?
7019@itemx ?
7020@kindex ? (Summary)
7021@kindex M ? (Summary)
7022@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
7023Mark the current article as dormant
7024(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
7025
7026@item M d
7027@itemx d
7028@kindex M d (Summary)
7029@kindex d (Summary)
7030@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
7031Mark the current article as read
7032(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
7033
7034@item D
7035@kindex D (Summary)
7036@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
7037Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
7038(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
7039
7040@item M k
7041@itemx k
7042@kindex k (Summary)
7043@kindex M k (Summary)
7044@findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
7045Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
7046and then select the next unread article
7047(@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
7048
7049@item M K
7050@itemx C-k
7051@kindex M K (Summary)
7052@kindex C-k (Summary)
7053@findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
7054Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
7055(@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
7056
7057@item M C
7058@kindex M C (Summary)
7059@findex gnus-summary-catchup
7060@c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
7061Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
7062
7063@item M C-c
7064@kindex M C-c (Summary)
7065@findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
7066Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
7067articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
7068
7069@item M H
7070@kindex M H (Summary)
7071@findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
7072Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
7073(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
7074
7075@item M h
7076@kindex M h (Summary)
7077@findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
7078Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
7079(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
7080
7081@item C-w
7082@kindex C-w (Summary)
7083@findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
7084Mark all articles between point and mark as read
7085(@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
7086
7087@item M V k
7088@kindex M V k (Summary)
7089@findex gnus-summary-kill-below
7090Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
7091numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
7092
7093@item M e
7094@itemx E
7095@kindex M e (Summary)
7096@kindex E (Summary)
7097@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
7098Mark the current article as expirable
7099(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
7100
7101@item M b
7102@kindex M b (Summary)
7103@findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
7104Set a bookmark in the current article
7105(@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
7106
7107@item M B
7108@kindex M B (Summary)
7109@findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
7110Remove the bookmark from the current article
7111(@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
7112
7113@item M V c
7114@kindex M V c (Summary)
7115@findex gnus-summary-clear-above
7116Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
7117over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
7118
7119@item M V u
7120@kindex M V u (Summary)
7121@findex gnus-summary-tick-above
7122Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
7123numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
7124
7125@item M V m
7126@kindex M V m (Summary)
7127@findex gnus-summary-mark-above
7128Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
7129score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
7130(@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
7131@end table
7132
7133@vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
7134The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
7135be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
7136the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
7137one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
7138@code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
7139@kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
7140The default is @code{t}.
7141
7142
7143@node Generic Marking Commands
7144@subsection Generic Marking Commands
7145
7146Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
7147the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
7148article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
7149even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
7150previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
7151well.
7152
7153Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
7154you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
7155command should do.
7156
7157To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
7158different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
7159buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
7160to list in this manual.
7161
7162While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
7163altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
7164@kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
7165article, you could say something like:
7166
7167@lisp
7168@group
7169(add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
7170(defun my-alter-summary-map ()
7171 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
7172@end group
7173@end lisp
7174
7175@noindent
7176or
7177
7178@lisp
7179(defun my-alter-summary-map ()
7180 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
7181@end lisp
7182
7183
7184@node Setting Process Marks
7185@subsection Setting Process Marks
7186@cindex setting process marks
7187
7188Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
7189used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
7190process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
7191articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
7192articles into the cache. For more information,
7193@pxref{Process/Prefix}.
7194
7195@table @kbd
7196
7197@item M P p
7198@itemx #
7199@kindex # (Summary)
7200@kindex M P p (Summary)
7201@findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
7202Mark the current article with the process mark
7203(@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
7204@findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
7205
7206@item M P u
7207@itemx M-#
7208@kindex M P u (Summary)
7209@kindex M-# (Summary)
7210Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
7211(@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
7212
7213@item M P U
7214@kindex M P U (Summary)
7215@findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
7216Remove the process mark from all articles
7217(@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
7218
7219@item M P i
7220@kindex M P i (Summary)
7221@findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
7222Invert the list of process marked articles
7223(@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
7224
7225@item M P R
7226@kindex M P R (Summary)
7227@findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
7228Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
7229expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
7230
7231@item M P G
7232@kindex M P G (Summary)
7233@findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
7234Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
7235expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
7236
7237@item M P r
7238@kindex M P r (Summary)
7239@findex gnus-uu-mark-region
7240Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
7241
7242@item M P g
7243@kindex M P g (Summary)
7244@findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
7245Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
7246
7247@item M P t
7248@kindex M P t (Summary)
7249@findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
7250Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
7251(@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
7252
7253@item M P T
7254@kindex M P T (Summary)
7255@findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
7256Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
7257(@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
7258
7259@item M P v
7260@kindex M P v (Summary)
7261@findex gnus-uu-mark-over
7262Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
7263(@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
7264
7265@item M P s
7266@kindex M P s (Summary)
7267@findex gnus-uu-mark-series
7268Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
7269
7270@item M P S
7271@kindex M P S (Summary)
7272@findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
7273Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
7274(@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
7275
7276@item M P a
7277@kindex M P a (Summary)
7278@findex gnus-uu-mark-all
7279Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
7280
7281@item M P b
7282@kindex M P b (Summary)
7283@findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
7284Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
7285(@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
7286
7287@item M P k
7288@kindex M P k (Summary)
7289@findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
7290Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
7291(@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
7292
7293@item M P y
7294@kindex M P y (Summary)
7295@findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
7296Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
7297(@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
7298
7299@item M P w
7300@kindex M P w (Summary)
7301@findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
7302Push the current process mark set onto the stack
7303(@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
7304
7305@end table
7306
7307Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
7308set process marks based on article body contents.
7309
7310
7311@node Limiting
7312@section Limiting
7313@cindex limiting
7314
7315It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
7316subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
7317commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
7318buffer.
7319
26b9f88d
MB
7320Limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched from
7321the servers. These commands don't query the server for additional
7322articles.
4009494e
GM
7323
7324@table @kbd
7325
7326@item / /
7327@itemx / s
7328@kindex / / (Summary)
7329@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
7330Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
7331(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
7332matching articles.
7333
7334@item / a
7335@kindex / a (Summary)
7336@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
7337Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
7338(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
7339matching articles.
7340
01c52d31
MB
7341@item / R
7342@kindex / R (Summary)
7343@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient
7344Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some recipient
7345(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient}). If given a prefix, exclude
7346matching articles.
7347
7348@item / A
7349@kindex / A (Summary)
7350@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-address
7351Limit the summary buffer to articles in which contents of From, To or Cc
7352header match a given address (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-address}). If
7353given a prefix, exclude matching articles.
7354
7355@item / S
7356@kindex / S (Summary)
7357@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons
7358Limit the summary buffer to articles that aren't part of any displayed
7359threads (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons}). If given a prefix,
7360limit to articles that are part of displayed threads.
7361
4009494e
GM
7362@item / x
7363@kindex / x (Summary)
7364@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
7365Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
7366headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
7367(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
7368matching articles.
7369
7370@item / u
7371@itemx x
7372@kindex / u (Summary)
7373@kindex x (Summary)
7374@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
7375Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
7376(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
7377buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
7378dormant articles will also be excluded.
7379
7380@item / m
7381@kindex / m (Summary)
7382@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
7383Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
7384with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
7385
7386@item / t
7387@kindex / t (Summary)
7388@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
7389Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
7390(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
7391articles younger than that number of days.
7392
7393@item / n
7394@kindex / n (Summary)
7395@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
7396With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
7397articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
7398instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
7399
7400@item / w
7401@kindex / w (Summary)
7402@findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
7403Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
7404(@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
7405the stack.
7406
7407@item / .
7408@kindex / . (Summary)
7409@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
7410Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
7411(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
7412
7413@item / v
7414@kindex / v (Summary)
7415@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
7416Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
7417score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
7418
7419@item / p
7420@kindex / p (Summary)
7421@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
7422Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
7423group parameter predicate
7424(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
7425Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
7426
01c52d31
MB
7427@item / r
7428@kindex / r (Summary)
7429@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-replied
7430Limit the summary buffer to replied articles
7431(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-replied}). If given a prefix, exclude
7432replied articles.
7433
4009494e
GM
7434@item / E
7435@itemx M S
7436@kindex M S (Summary)
7437@kindex / E (Summary)
7438@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
7439Include all expunged articles in the limit
7440(@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
7441
7442@item / D
7443@kindex / D (Summary)
7444@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
7445Include all dormant articles in the limit
7446(@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
7447
7448@item / *
7449@kindex / * (Summary)
7450@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
7451Include all cached articles in the limit
7452(@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
7453
7454@item / d
7455@kindex / d (Summary)
7456@findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
7457Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
7458(@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
7459
7460@item / M
7461@kindex / M (Summary)
7462@findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
7463Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
7464
7465@item / T
7466@kindex / T (Summary)
7467@findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
7468Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
7469
7470@item / c
7471@kindex / c (Summary)
7472@findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
7473Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
7474(@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
7475
7476@item / C
7477@kindex / C (Summary)
7478@findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
7479Mark all excluded unread articles as read
7480(@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
7481also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
7482
01c52d31
MB
7483@item / b
7484@kindex / b (Summary)
7485@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies
7486Limit the summary buffer to articles that have bodies that match a
7487certain regexp (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies}). If given a
7488prefix, reverse the limit. This command is quite slow since it
7489requires selecting each article to find the matches.
7490
7491@item / h
7492@kindex / h (Summary)
7493@findex gnus-summary-limit-to-headers
7494Like the previous command, only limit to headers instead
7495(@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-headers}).
7496
4009494e
GM
7497@end table
7498
7499
26b9f88d
MB
7500The following commands aren't limiting commands, but use the @kbd{/}
7501prefix as well.
7502
7503@table @kbd
7504@item / N
7505@kindex / N (Summary)
7506@findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
7507Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
7508if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
7509
7510@item / o
7511@kindex / o (Summary)
7512@findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
7513Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
7514prefix, fetch this number of articles.
7515
7516@end table
7517
7518
4009494e
GM
7519@node Threading
7520@section Threading
7521@cindex threading
7522@cindex article threading
7523
7524Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
7525to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
7526hierarchical fashion.
7527
7528Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
7529articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
7530trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
7531or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
7532so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
7533plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
7534@ref{Customizing Threading}.
7535
7536First, a quick overview of the concepts:
7537
7538@table @dfn
7539@item root
7540The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
7541
7542@item thread
7543A tree-like article structure.
7544
7545@item sub-thread
7546A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
7547
7548@item loose threads
7549Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
7550already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
7551summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
7552belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
7553called loose threads.
7554
7555@item thread gathering
7556An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
7557
7558@item sparse threads
7559A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
7560displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
7561
7562@end table
7563
7564
7565@menu
7566* Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
7567* Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
7568@end menu
7569
7570
7571@node Customizing Threading
7572@subsection Customizing Threading
7573@cindex customizing threading
7574
7575@menu
7576* Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
7577* Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
7578* More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
7579* Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
7580@end menu
7581
7582
7583@node Loose Threads
7584@subsubsection Loose Threads
7585@cindex <
7586@cindex >
7587@cindex loose threads
7588
7589@table @code
7590@item gnus-summary-make-false-root
7591@vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
7592If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
7593and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
7594Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
7595read or killed the root in a previous session.
7596
7597When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
7598something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
7599There are four possible values:
7600
7601@iftex
7602@iflatex
7603\gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
7604\put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
7605\put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
7606\put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
7607\put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
7608}
7609@end iflatex
7610@end iftex
7611
7612@cindex adopting articles
7613
7614@table @code
7615
7616@item adopt
7617Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
7618parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
7619marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
7620square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
7621
7622@item dummy
7623@vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
7624@vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
7625Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
7626parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
7627selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
7628article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
7629format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
7630which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
7631If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
7632ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
7633
7634@item empty
7635Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
7636subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
7637use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
7638Buffer Format}).)
7639
7640@item none
7641Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
7642display them after one another.
7643
7644@item nil
7645Don't gather loose threads.
7646@end table
7647
7648@item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
7649@vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
7650Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
7651variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
7652subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
7653super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
7654presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
7655you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
7656first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
7657variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
7658everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
7659
7660@cindex fuzzy article gathering
7661If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
7662use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
7663Matching}).
7664
7665@item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
7666@vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
7667This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
7668that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
7669simplification is used.
7670
7671@item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
7672@vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
7673If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
7674as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
7675
7676@c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
7677@lisp
7678(setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
7679 (concat
7680 "\\`\\[?\\("
7681 (mapconcat
7682 'identity
7683 '("looking"
7684 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
7685 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
7686 "answer" "reference" "announce"
7687 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
7688 ;; ...
7689 )
7690 "\\|")
7691 "\\)\\s *\\("
7692 (mapconcat 'identity
7693 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
7694 "\\|")
7695 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
7696@end lisp
7697
7698All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
7699subjects.
7700
7701@item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
7702@vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
7703If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
7704@code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
7705list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
7706arrive at the simplified version of the string.
7707
7708Useful functions to put in this list include:
7709
7710@table @code
7711@item gnus-simplify-subject-re
7712@findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
7713Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
7714
7715@item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
7716@findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
7717Simplify fuzzily.
7718
7719@item gnus-simplify-whitespace
7720@findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
7721Remove excessive whitespace.
7722
7723@item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
7724@findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
7725Remove all whitespace.
7726@end table
7727
7728You may also write your own functions, of course.
7729
7730
7731@item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
7732@vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
7733Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
7734to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
7735@samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
7736you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
7737what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
7738The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
7739
7740@item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
7741@vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
7742Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
7743that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
7744is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
7745@code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
7746This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
7747articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
7748newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
7749cholera:
7750
7751@table @code
7752@item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
7753@findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
7754This function is the default gathering function and looks at
7755@code{Subject}s exclusively.
7756
7757@item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
7758@findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
7759This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
7760@end table
7761
7762If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
7763something like:
7764
7765@lisp
7766(setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
7767 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
7768@end lisp
7769
7770@end table
7771
7772
7773@node Filling In Threads
7774@subsubsection Filling In Threads
7775
7776@table @code
7777@item gnus-fetch-old-headers
7778@vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
7779If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
7780more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
7781like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
7782many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
7783@code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
7784number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
7785old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
7786files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
7787@code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
7788the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
7789do about that.
7790
7791This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
7792visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
7793(@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
7794
f394fa25
MB
7795The server has to support @acronym{NOV} for any of this to work.
7796
7797@cindex Gmane, gnus-fetch-old-headers
7798This feature can seriously impact performance it ignores all locally
7799cached header entries. Setting it to @code{t} for groups for a server
7800that doesn't expire articles (such as news.gmane.org), leads to very
7801slow summary generation.
7802
4009494e
GM
7803@item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7804@vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7805Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
7806newsgroups.
7807
7808@item gnus-build-sparse-threads
7809@vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
7810Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
7811gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
7812the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
7813together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
7814@dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
7815is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
7816lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
7817question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
7818``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
7819thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
7820off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
7821@code{nil} by default.
7822
7823@item gnus-read-all-available-headers
7824@vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
7825This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
7826intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
7827quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
7828go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
7829web-based groups, like the @code{nnultimate} groups.
7830
7831If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
7832@code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
7833that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
7834
7835@end table
7836
7837
7838@node More Threading
7839@subsubsection More Threading
7840
7841@table @code
7842@item gnus-show-threads
7843@vindex gnus-show-threads
7844If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
7845the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
7846off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
7847slower and more awkward.
7848
7849@item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7850@vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7851If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
7852generated.
7853
7854This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
7855Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
7856@code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
7857
7858Here's an example:
7859
7860@lisp
7861(setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7862 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
7863 gnus-article-unseen-p))
7864@end lisp
7865
7866(It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
7867unread, but you get my drift.)
7868
7869
7870@item gnus-thread-expunge-below
7871@vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
7872All threads that have a total score (as defined by
7873@code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
7874expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
7875threads are expunged.
7876
7877@item gnus-thread-hide-killed
7878@vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
7879if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
7880will be hidden.
7881
7882@item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7883@vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7884Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
7885this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
7886change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
7887result in a new thread.
7888
7889@item gnus-thread-indent-level
7890@vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
7891This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
7892The default is 4.
7893
7894@item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7895@vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7896Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
7897arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
7898arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
7899using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
7900up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
7901Setting this variable to an alternate value
7902(e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
7903appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
7904more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
7905
7906@end table
7907
7908
7909@node Low-Level Threading
7910@subsubsection Low-Level Threading
7911
7912@table @code
7913
7914@item gnus-parse-headers-hook
7915@vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
7916Hook run before parsing any headers.
7917
7918@item gnus-alter-header-function
7919@vindex gnus-alter-header-function
7920If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
7921article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
7922the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
7923if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
7924in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
7925variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
7926meaningful. Here's one example:
7927
7928@lisp
7929(setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
7930
7931(defun my-alter-message-id (header)
7932 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
7933 (when (string-match
7934 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
7935 (mail-header-set-id
7936 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
7937 header))))
7938@end lisp
7939
7940@end table
7941
7942
7943@node Thread Commands
7944@subsection Thread Commands
7945@cindex thread commands
7946
7947@table @kbd
7948
7949@item T k
7950@itemx C-M-k
7951@kindex T k (Summary)
7952@kindex C-M-k (Summary)
7953@findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
7954Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
7955(@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
7956remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
7957articles instead.
7958
7959@item T l
7960@itemx C-M-l
7961@kindex T l (Summary)
7962@kindex C-M-l (Summary)
7963@findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
7964Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
7965(@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
7966
7967@item T i
7968@kindex T i (Summary)
7969@findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
7970Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
7971(@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
7972
7973@item T #
7974@kindex T # (Summary)
7975@findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
7976Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
7977(@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
7978
7979@item T M-#
7980@kindex T M-# (Summary)
7981@findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
7982Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
7983(@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
7984
7985@item T T
7986@kindex T T (Summary)
7987@findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
7988Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
7989
7990@item T s
7991@kindex T s (Summary)
7992@findex gnus-summary-show-thread
7993Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
7994(@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
7995
7996@item T h
7997@kindex T h (Summary)
7998@findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
7999Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
8000
8001@item T S
8002@kindex T S (Summary)
8003@findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
8004Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
8005
8006@item T H
8007@kindex T H (Summary)
8008@findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
8009Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
8010
8011@item T t
8012@kindex T t (Summary)
8013@findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
8014Re-thread the current article's thread
8015(@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
8016summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
8017
8018@item T ^
8019@kindex T ^ (Summary)
8020@findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
8021Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
8022(@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
8023
01c52d31
MB
8024@item T M-^
8025@kindex T M-^ (Summary)
8026@findex gnus-summary-reparent-children
8027Make the current article the parent of the marked articles
8028(@code{gnus-summary-reparent-children}).
8029
4009494e
GM
8030@end table
8031
8032The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
8033understand the numeric prefix.
8034
8035@table @kbd
8036
8037@item T n
8038@kindex T n (Summary)
8039@itemx C-M-f
8040@kindex C-M-n (Summary)
8041@itemx M-down
8042@kindex M-down (Summary)
8043@findex gnus-summary-next-thread
8044Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
8045
8046@item T p
8047@kindex T p (Summary)
8048@itemx C-M-b
8049@kindex C-M-p (Summary)
8050@itemx M-up
8051@kindex M-up (Summary)
8052@findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
8053Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
8054
8055@item T d
8056@kindex T d (Summary)
8057@findex gnus-summary-down-thread
8058Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
8059
8060@item T u
8061@kindex T u (Summary)
8062@findex gnus-summary-up-thread
8063Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
8064
8065@item T o
8066@kindex T o (Summary)
8067@findex gnus-summary-top-thread
8068Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
8069@end table
8070
8071@vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
8072If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
8073threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
8074a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
8075wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
8076have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
8077you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
8078is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
8079when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
8080the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
8081operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
8082that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
8083Matching}).
8084
8085
8086@node Sorting the Summary Buffer
8087@section Sorting the Summary Buffer
8088
8089@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
8090@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
8091@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
8092@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
8093@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
01c52d31 8094@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient
4009494e
GM
8095@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
8096@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
8097@vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
8098@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
8099@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
8100If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
8101setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
8102function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
8103@code{(not some-function)} elements.
8104
8105By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
8106predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
01c52d31
MB
8107@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient},
8108@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
8109@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date},
8110@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
4009494e
GM
8111@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
8112@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
8113@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
8114@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
8115
8116Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
8117thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
8118normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
8119
8120If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
8121last function in the list. You should probably always include
8122@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
8123functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
8124equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
8125ascending article order.
8126
8127If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
8128by number, you could do something like:
8129
8130@lisp
8131(setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
8132 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
8133 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
8134 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
8135@end lisp
8136
8137The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
8138summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
8139alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
8140subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
8141which the articles arrived.
8142
8143If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
8144say something like:
8145
8146@lisp
8147(setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
01c52d31 8148 '((not gnus-thread-sort-by-number)
4009494e
GM
8149 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
8150@end lisp
8151
8152@vindex gnus-thread-score-function
8153The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
8154@code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
8155functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
8156tickles your fancy.
8157
8158@findex gnus-article-sort-functions
8159@findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
6ecfe5c2 8160@findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-date
4009494e
GM
8161@findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
8162@findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
8163@findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
8164@findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
8165@findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
6ecfe5c2 8166@findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-number
4009494e
GM
8167If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
8168other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
8169variable. It is very similar to the
8170@code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
8171different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
8172predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
8173@code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
8174@code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
8175@code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
8176@code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
8177
8178If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
8179say something like:
8180
8181@lisp
8182(setq gnus-article-sort-functions
8183 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
8184 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
8185@end lisp
8186
01c52d31
MB
8187You can define group specific sorting via @code{gnus-parameters},
8188@xref{Group Parameters}.
4009494e
GM
8189
8190
8191@node Asynchronous Fetching
8192@section Asynchronous Article Fetching
8193@cindex asynchronous article fetching
8194@cindex article pre-fetch
8195@cindex pre-fetch
8196
8197If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
8198network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
8199for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
8200article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
8201while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
8202
8203First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
8204article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
8205
8206Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
8207quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
8208know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
8209article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
8210connection is blocked.
8211
8212To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
8213connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
8214thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
8215extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
8216
8217Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
8218the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
8219loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
8220also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
8221extra connection.
8222
8223Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
8224you really want to.
8225
8226@vindex gnus-asynchronous
8227Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
8228happen automatically.
8229
8230@vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
8231You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
8232@code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
8233that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
8234the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
8235pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
8236@code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
8237
8238@vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
8239@findex gnus-async-unread-p
8240There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
8241articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
8242variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
8243function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
8244to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-unread-p}, which
8245returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
8246article data structure as the only parameter.
8247
8248If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
8249than 100 lines, you could say something like:
8250
8251@lisp
8252(defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
8253 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
8254 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
8255 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
8256 100)))
8257
8258(setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
8259@end lisp
8260
8261These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
8262preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
8263It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
8264
8265@vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
8266Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
8267@code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
8268articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
8269
8270@table @code
8271@item read
8272Remove articles when they are read.
8273
8274@item exit
8275Remove articles when exiting the group.
8276@end table
8277
8278The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
8279
8280@c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
8281@c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
8282@c from the next group.
8283
8284
8285@node Article Caching
8286@section Article Caching
8287@cindex article caching
8288@cindex caching
8289
8290If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
8291consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
8292locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
8293potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
8294your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
8295
8296Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
8297
8298@vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
8299@vindex gnus-cache-directory
8300@vindex gnus-use-cache
8301To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
8302all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
8303over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
8304cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
8305@code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
8306
8307When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
8308cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
8309expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
8310keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
8311as dormant, and don't worry.
8312
8313When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
8314
8315@vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
8316@vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
8317The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
8318@code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
8319variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
8320dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
8321put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
8322articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
8323symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
8324@code{unread} and @code{read}.
8325
8326@findex gnus-jog-cache
8327So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
8328picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
8329subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
8330store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
8331command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
8332really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
8333Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
8334to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
8335not then be downloaded by this command.
8336
8337@vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
8338@vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
8339It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
8340if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
8341sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
8342feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
8343
8344To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
8345regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
8346@code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
8347Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
8348variables, the group is not cached.
8349
8350@findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
8351@findex gnus-cache-generate-active
8352@vindex gnus-cache-active-file
8353The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
8354file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
8355of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
8356offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
8357gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
8358files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
8359file.
8360
8361@findex gnus-cache-move-cache
8362@code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
8363@code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
8364where, isn't that cool?
8365
8366@node Persistent Articles
8367@section Persistent Articles
8368@cindex persistent articles
8369
8370Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
8371In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
8372useful in my opinion.
8373
8374Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
8375that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
8376(using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
8377that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
8378the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
8379the expiry going on at the news server.
8380
8381This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
8382be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
8383you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
8384
8385@table @kbd
8386
8387@item *
8388@kindex * (Summary)
8389@findex gnus-cache-enter-article
8390Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
8391
8392@item M-*
8393@kindex M-* (Summary)
8394@findex gnus-cache-remove-article
8395Remove the current article from the persistent articles
8396(@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
8397article.
8398@end table
8399
8400Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
8401
8402To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
8403you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
8404interested in persistent articles:
8405
8406@lisp
8407(setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
8408@end lisp
8409
01c52d31
MB
8410@node Sticky Articles
8411@section Sticky Articles
8412@cindex sticky articles
8413
8414When you select an article the current article buffer will be reused
8415according to the value of the variable
8416@code{gnus-single-article-buffer}. If its value is non-@code{nil} (the
8417default) all articles reuse the same article buffer. Else each group
8418has its own article buffer.
8419
8420This implies that it's not possible to have more than one article buffer
8421in a group at a time. But sometimes you might want to display all the
8422latest emails from your mother, your father, your aunt, your uncle and
8423your 17 cousins to coordinate the next christmas party.
8424
8425That's where sticky articles come in handy. A sticky article buffer
8426basically is a normal article buffer, but it won't be reused when you
8427select another article. You can make an article sticky with:
8428
8429@table @kbd
8430@item A S
8431@kindex A S (Summary)
8432@findex gnus-sticky-article
8433Make the current article sticky. If a prefix arg is given, ask for a
8434name for this sticky article buffer.
8435@end table
8436
8437To close a sticky article buffer you can use these commands:
8438
8439@table @kbd
8440@item q
8441@kindex q (Article)
8442@findex bury-buffer
8443Puts this sticky article buffer at the end of the list of all buffers.
8444
8445@item k
8446@kindex k (Article)
8447@findex gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffer
8448Kills this sticky article buffer.
8449@end table
8450
8451To kill all sticky article buffers you can use:
8452
8453@defun gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffers ARG
8454Kill all sticky article buffers.
8455If a prefix ARG is given, ask for confirmation.
8456@end defun
4009494e
GM
8457
8458@node Article Backlog
8459@section Article Backlog
8460@cindex backlog
8461@cindex article backlog
8462
8463If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
8464unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
8465by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
8466already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
8467you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
8468re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
8469that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
8470increase memory usage some.
8471
8472@vindex gnus-keep-backlog
8473If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
8474at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
8475variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
8476@emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
8477bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
8478that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
8479
8480The default value is 20.
8481
8482
8483@node Saving Articles
8484@section Saving Articles
8485@cindex saving articles
8486
8487Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
8488for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
8489processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
8490approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
8491(@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
8492
8493For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
8494save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
8495command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
8496
8497@vindex gnus-save-all-headers
8498If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
8499unwanted headers before saving the article.
8500
8501@vindex gnus-saved-headers
8502If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
8503@code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
8504deleted before saving.
8505
8506@table @kbd
8507
8508@item O o
8509@itemx o
8510@kindex O o (Summary)
8511@kindex o (Summary)
8512@findex gnus-summary-save-article
8513@c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
8514Save the current article using the default article saver
8515(@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
8516
8517@item O m
8518@kindex O m (Summary)
8519@findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
8520Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
8521(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
8522
8523@item O r
8524@kindex O r (Summary)
8525@findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
8526Save the current article in Rmail format
bc79f9ab
GM
8527(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}). This is mbox since Emacs 23,
8528Babyl in older versions.
4009494e
GM
8529
8530@item O f
8531@kindex O f (Summary)
8532@findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
8533@c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
8534Save the current article in plain file format
8535(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
8536
8537@item O F
8538@kindex O F (Summary)
8539@findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
8540Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
8541file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
8542
8543@item O b
8544@kindex O b (Summary)
8545@findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
8546Save the current article body in plain file format
8547(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
8548
8549@item O h
8550@kindex O h (Summary)
8551@findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
8552Save the current article in mh folder format
8553(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
8554
8555@item O v
8556@kindex O v (Summary)
8557@findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
8558Save the current article in a VM folder
8559(@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
8560
8561@item O p
8562@itemx |
8563@kindex O p (Summary)
8564@kindex | (Summary)
8565@findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
89167438 8566@vindex gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command
4009494e
GM
8567Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
8568the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
8569If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
6ecfe5c2
MB
8570complete headers in the piped output. The symbolic prefix @code{r} is
8571special; it lets this command pipe a raw article including all headers.
8572The @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} variable can be set
8573to a string containing the default command and options (default
8574@code{nil}).
4009494e
GM
8575
8576@item O P
8577@kindex O P (Summary)
8578@findex gnus-summary-muttprint
8579@vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
8580Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
8581external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
8582Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
8583variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
8584(@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
8585
8586@end table
8587
8588@vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
8589All these commands use the process/prefix convention
8590(@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
8591functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
8592and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
8593the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
8594default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
8595loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
8596just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
8597have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
8598to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
8599save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
8600files.
8601
8602
8603@vindex gnus-default-article-saver
8604You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
8605Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
8606functions below, or you can create your own.
8607
8608@table @code
8609
8610@item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
8611@findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
8612@vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
8613@findex gnus-plain-save-name
bc79f9ab
GM
8614This is the default format, that used by the Rmail package. Since Emacs
861523, Rmail uses standard mbox format. Before this, it used the
8616@dfn{Babyl} format. Accordingly, this command writes mbox format since
8617Emacs 23, unless appending to an existing Babyl file. In older versions
8618of Emacs, it always uses Babyl format. Uses the function in the
4009494e
GM
8619@code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
8620article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
8621
8622@item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
8623@findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
8624@vindex gnus-mail-save-name
8625Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
8626@code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
8627article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
8628
8629@item gnus-summary-save-in-file
8630@findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
8631@vindex gnus-file-save-name
8632@findex gnus-numeric-save-name
8633Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
8634the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
8635article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
8636
8637@item gnus-summary-write-to-file
8638@findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
8639Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
8640overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
8641@code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
8642article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
8643
8644@item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
8645@findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
8646Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
8647@code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
8648article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
8649
8650@item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
8651@findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
8652Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
8653overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
8654@code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
8655article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
8656
8657@item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
8658@findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
8659@findex gnus-folder-save-name
8660@findex gnus-Folder-save-name
8661@vindex gnus-folder-save-name
8662@cindex rcvstore
8663@cindex MH folders
8664Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
8665library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
8666to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
8667@code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
8668@code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
8669
8670@item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
8671@findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
8672Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
8673reader to use this setting.
89167438
MB
8674
8675@item gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
8676@findex gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
d62672f3
MB
8677Pipe the article to a shell command. This function takes optional two
8678arguments COMMAND and RAW. Valid values for COMMAND include:
8679
8680@itemize @bullet
8681@item a string@*
8682The executable command name and possibly arguments.
8683@item @code{nil}@*
8684You will be prompted for the command in the minibuffer.
8685@item the symbol @code{default}@*
8686It will be replaced with the command which the variable
8687@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} holds or the command
8688last used for saving.
8689@end itemize
8690
8691Non-@code{nil} value for RAW overrides @code{:decode} and
8692@code{:headers} properties (see below) and the raw article including all
8693headers will be piped.
4009494e
GM
8694@end table
8695
8696The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
8697
8698@table @code
8699@item :decode
8700The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
8701meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
8702@code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
89167438
MB
8703@code{gnus-summary-write-to-file},
8704@code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}, and
8705@code{gnus-summary-save-in-pipe}.
4009494e
GM
8706
8707@item :function
8708The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
8709overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
8710articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
8711@code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
8712meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
8713@code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
8714
8715@item :headers
8716The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
8717specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
8718@code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
8719headers should be saved.
8720@end table
8721
8722@vindex gnus-article-save-directory
8723All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
8724in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
8725@env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
8726default.
8727
8728As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
8729suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
8730available functions that generate names:
8731
8732@table @code
8733
8734@item gnus-Numeric-save-name
8735@findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
8736File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
8737
8738@item gnus-numeric-save-name
8739@findex gnus-numeric-save-name
8740File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
8741
8742@item gnus-Plain-save-name
8743@findex gnus-Plain-save-name
8744File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
8745
8746@item gnus-plain-save-name
8747@findex gnus-plain-save-name
8748File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
8749
8750@item gnus-sender-save-name
8751@findex gnus-sender-save-name
8752File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
8753@end table
8754
8755@vindex gnus-split-methods
8756You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
8757the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
8758save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
8759related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
8760like:
8761
8762@lisp
8763(("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
8764 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
8765 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
8766 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
8767@end lisp
8768
8769We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
8770elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
8771a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
8772head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
8773group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
8774@code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
8775the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
8776result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
8777called returns a string or a list of strings.
8778
8779You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
8780saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
8781then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
8782name completion over the results from applying this variable.
8783
8784This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
8785means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
8786@code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
8787name.
8788
8789Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
8790lots of mail groups called things like
8791@samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
8792these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
8793following will do just that:
8794
8795@lisp
8796(defun my-save-name (group)
8797 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
8798 (substring group (match-end 0))))
8799
8800(setq gnus-split-methods
8801 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
8802 (my-save-name)))
8803@end lisp
8804
8805
8806@vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
8807Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
8808@code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
8809(@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
8810the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
8811all the files in the top level directory
8812(@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
8813@file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
8814on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
8815Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
8816
8817This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
8818is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
8819names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
8820@code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
8821contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
8822for kill files.
8823
8824If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
8825a spool, you could
8826
8827@lisp
8828(setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
8829(setq gnus-default-article-saver
8830 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
8831@end lisp
8832
8833Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
8834ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
8835the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
8836around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
8837
8838
8839@node Decoding Articles
8840@section Decoding Articles
8841@cindex decoding articles
8842
8843Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
8844encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
8845
8846@menu
8847* Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
8848* Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
8849* PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
8850* Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
8851* Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
8852* Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
8853@end menu
8854
8855@cindex series
8856@cindex article series
8857All these functions use the process/prefix convention
8858(@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
8859the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
8860can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
8861articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
8862
8863Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
8864simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
8865last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
8866
8867For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
8868will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
8869([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
8870
8871Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
8872series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
8873commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
8874
8875
8876@node Uuencoded Articles
8877@subsection Uuencoded Articles
8878@cindex uudecode
8879@cindex uuencoded articles
8880
8881@table @kbd
8882
8883@item X u
8884@kindex X u (Summary)
8885@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
8886@c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
8887Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
8888
8889@item X U
8890@kindex X U (Summary)
8891@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
8892Uudecodes and saves the current series
8893(@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8894
8895@item X v u
8896@kindex X v u (Summary)
8897@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
8898Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
8899
8900@item X v U
8901@kindex X v U (Summary)
8902@findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
8903Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
8904(@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
8905
8906@end table
8907
8908Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
8909the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
8910entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
8911(@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
8912(@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8913
8914All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
8915@sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
8916the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
8917articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
8918@kbd{X u}.
8919
8920@vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
8921Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
8922@code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
8923@samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
8924automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
8925you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
8926off.
8927
8928
8929@node Shell Archives
8930@subsection Shell Archives
8931@cindex unshar
8932@cindex shell archives
8933@cindex shared articles
8934
8935Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
8936sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
8937some commands to deal with these:
8938
8939@table @kbd
8940
8941@item X s
8942@kindex X s (Summary)
8943@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
8944Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
8945
8946@item X S
8947@kindex X S (Summary)
8948@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
8949Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
8950
8951@item X v s
8952@kindex X v s (Summary)
8953@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
8954Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
8955
8956@item X v S
8957@kindex X v S (Summary)
8958@findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
8959Unshars, views and saves the current series
8960(@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
8961@end table
8962
8963
8964@node PostScript Files
8965@subsection PostScript Files
8966@cindex PostScript
8967
8968@table @kbd
8969
8970@item X p
8971@kindex X p (Summary)
8972@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
8973Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
8974
8975@item X P
8976@kindex X P (Summary)
8977@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
8978Unpack and save the current PostScript series
8979(@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
8980
8981@item X v p
8982@kindex X v p (Summary)
8983@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
8984View the current PostScript series
8985(@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
8986
8987@item X v P
8988@kindex X v P (Summary)
8989@findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
8990View and save the current PostScript series
8991(@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
8992@end table
8993
8994
8995@node Other Files
8996@subsection Other Files
8997
8998@table @kbd
8999@item X o
9000@kindex X o (Summary)
9001@findex gnus-uu-decode-save
9002Save the current series
9003(@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
9004
9005@item X b
9006@kindex X b (Summary)
9007@findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
9008Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
9009doesn't really work yet.
b890d447
MB
9010
9011@item X Y
9012@kindex X Y (Summary)
9013@findex gnus-uu-decode-yenc
9014yEnc-decode the current series and save it (@code{gnus-uu-decode-yenc}).
4009494e
GM
9015@end table
9016
9017
9018@node Decoding Variables
9019@subsection Decoding Variables
9020
9021Adjective, not verb.
9022
9023@menu
9024* Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
9025* Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
9026* Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
9027@end menu
9028
9029
9030@node Rule Variables
9031@subsubsection Rule Variables
9032@cindex rule variables
9033
9034Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
9035variables are of the form
9036
9037@lisp
9038 (list '(regexp1 command2)
9039 '(regexp2 command2)
9040 ...)
9041@end lisp
9042
9043@table @code
9044
9045@item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
9046@vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
9047@cindex sox
9048This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
9049for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
9050say something like:
9051@lisp
9052(setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
9053 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
9054@end lisp
9055
9056@item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
9057@vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
9058This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
9059user and default view rules.
9060
9061@item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
9062@vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
9063This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
9064archives.
9065@end table
9066
9067
9068@node Other Decode Variables
9069@subsubsection Other Decode Variables
9070
9071@table @code
9072@vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
9073
9074@item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
9075All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
9076successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
9077and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
9078anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
9079
9080@table @code
9081
9082@item gnus-uu-grab-view
9083@findex gnus-uu-grab-view
9084View the file.
9085
9086@item gnus-uu-grab-move
9087@findex gnus-uu-grab-move
9088Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
9089@end table
9090
9091@item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
9092@vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
9093Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
9094@code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
9095that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
9096time.
9097
9098@item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
9099@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
9100Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
9101
9102@item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
9103@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
9104Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
9105Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
9106@code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
9107kludgey.
9108
9109@item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
9110@vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
9111Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
9112
9113@item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
9114@vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
9115Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
9116looking for files to display.
9117
9118@item gnus-uu-view-and-save
9119@vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
9120Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
9121after viewing it.
9122
9123@item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
9124@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
9125Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
9126rules.
9127
9128@item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
9129@vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
9130Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
9131unpacking commands.
9132
9133@item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
9134@vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
9135Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
9136from articles.
9137
9138@item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
9139@vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
9140Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
9141decoded articles as unread.
9142
9143@item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
9144@vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
9145Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
9146uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
9147
9148@item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
9149@vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
9150Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
9151
9152@item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
9153@vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
9154@cindex metamail
9155Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
9156commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
9157content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
9158@code{metamail} for viewing.
9159
9160@item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
9161@vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
9162Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
9163decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
9164@code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
9165embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
9166to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
9167simply dropped them.
9168
9169@end table
9170
9171
9172@node Uuencoding and Posting
9173@subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
9174
9175@table @code
9176
9177@item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
9178@vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
9179Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
9180before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
9181either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
9182for you when you post the article.
9183
9184@item gnus-uu-post-length
9185@vindex gnus-uu-post-length
9186Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
9187many articles it takes to post the entire file.
9188
9189@item gnus-uu-post-threaded
9190@vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
9191Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
9192thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
9193to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
9194seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
9195think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
9196
9197@item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
9198@vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
9199Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
9200article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
9201variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
9202at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
9203Default is @code{t}.
9204
9205@end table
9206
9207
9208@node Viewing Files
9209@subsection Viewing Files
9210@cindex viewing files
9211@cindex pseudo-articles
9212
9213After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
9214to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
9215viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
9216containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
9217uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
9218This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
9219of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
9220
9221Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
9222extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
9223``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
9224will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
9225
9226@vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
9227If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
9228until the viewing is done before proceeding.
9229
9230@vindex gnus-view-pseudos
9231If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
9232the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
9233immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
9234be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
9235
9236@vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
9237If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
9238pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
9239@code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
9240a list of parameters to that command.
9241
9242@vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
9243If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
9244pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
9245
9246So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
9247@emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
9248Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
9249
9250
9251@node Article Treatment
9252@section Article Treatment
9253
9254Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
9255object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
9256written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
9257writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
9258these articles easier.
9259
9260@menu
9261* Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
9262* Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
9263* Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
9264* Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
9265* Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
9266* Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
9267* Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
9268* Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
9269* Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
9270* Article Signature:: What is a signature?
9271* Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
9272@end menu
9273
9274
9275@node Article Highlighting
9276@subsection Article Highlighting
9277@cindex highlighting
9278
9279Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
9280you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
9281
9282@table @kbd
9283
9284@item W H a
9285@kindex W H a (Summary)
9286@findex gnus-article-highlight
9287@findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
9288Do much highlighting of the current article
9289(@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
9290text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
9291
9292@item W H h
9293@kindex W H h (Summary)
9294@findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
9295@vindex gnus-header-face-alist
9296Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
9297highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
9298variable, which is a list where each element has the form
9299@code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
9300@var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
9301header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
9302(@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
9303the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
9304@var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
9305
9306@item W H c
9307@kindex W H c (Summary)
9308@findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
9309Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
9310
9311Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
9312
9313@table @code
9314@vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
9315
9316@item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
9317If the article size in bytes is bigger than this variable (which is
931825000 by default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
9319
9320@item gnus-cite-max-prefix
9321@vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
9322Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
9323
9324@item gnus-cite-face-list
9325@vindex gnus-cite-face-list
9326List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
9327When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
9328Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
9329This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
9330
9331@item gnus-supercite-regexp
9332@vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
9333Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
9334
9335@item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
9336@vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
9337Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
9338
9339@item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
9340@vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
9341Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
9342that it's a citation.
9343
9344@item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
9345@vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
9346Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
9347
9348@item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
9349@vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
9350Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
9351
9352@item gnus-cite-attribution-face
9353@vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
9354Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
9355cited text belonging to the attribution.
9356
9357@item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
9358@vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
9359If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
9360beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
9361in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
9362is @code{t}.
9363
9364@end table
9365
9366
9367@item W H s
9368@kindex W H s (Summary)
9369@vindex gnus-signature-separator
9370@vindex gnus-signature-face
9371@findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
9372Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
9373Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
9374Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
9375highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
9376default.
9377
9378@end table
9379
9380@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
9381
9382
9383@node Article Fontisizing
9384@subsection Article Fontisizing
9385@cindex emphasis
9386@cindex article emphasis
9387
9388@findex gnus-article-emphasize
9389@kindex W e (Summary)
9390People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
9391like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
9392this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
9393(@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
9394
9395@vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
9396How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
9397@code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
9398element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
9399that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
9400emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
9401should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
9402groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
9403highlighting.
9404
9405@lisp
9406(setq gnus-emphasis-alist
9407 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
9408 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
9409@end lisp
9410
9411@cindex slash
9412@cindex asterisk
9413@cindex underline
9414@cindex /
9415@cindex *
9416
9417@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
9418@vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
9419@vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
9420@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
9421@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
9422@vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
9423@vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
9424By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
9425@code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
9426@code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
9427@code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
9428@code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
9429@code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
9430
9431If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
9432customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
9433to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
9434say something like:
9435
9436@lisp
9437(copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
9438@end lisp
9439
9440@vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
9441
9442If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
9443@code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
9444syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
9445parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
9446
9447@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
9448
9449
9450@node Article Hiding
9451@subsection Article Hiding
9452@cindex article hiding
9453
9454Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
9455too much cruft in most articles.
9456
9457@table @kbd
9458
9459@item W W a
9460@kindex W W a (Summary)
9461@findex gnus-article-hide
9462Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
9463(@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
9464headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
9465
9466@item W W h
9467@kindex W W h (Summary)
9468@findex gnus-article-hide-headers
9469Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
9470Headers}.
9471
9472@item W W b
9473@kindex W W b (Summary)
9474@findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
9475Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
9476(@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
9477
9478@item W W s
9479@kindex W W s (Summary)
9480@findex gnus-article-hide-signature
9481Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
9482Signature}.
9483
9484@item W W l
9485@kindex W W l (Summary)
9486@findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
9487@vindex gnus-list-identifiers
9488Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
9489are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
9490@code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
9491@samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
9492may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
9493
9494@table @code
9495
9496@item gnus-list-identifiers
9497@vindex gnus-list-identifiers
9498A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
9499subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
9500
9501@end table
9502
9503@item W W P
9504@kindex W W P (Summary)
9505@findex gnus-article-hide-pem
9506Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
9507(@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
9508
9509@item W W B
9510@kindex W W B (Summary)
9511@findex gnus-article-strip-banner
9512@vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
9513@vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
9514@cindex banner
9515@cindex OneList
9516@cindex stripping advertisements
9517@cindex advertisements
9518Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
9519(@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
9520annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
9521groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
9522the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
9523group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
9524which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
9525removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
9526signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
9527corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
9528used.
9529
9530Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
9531the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
9532@code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
9533
9534@table @code
9535
9536@item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
9537@vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
9538Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
9539@code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
9540matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
9541symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
9542a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
9543address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
9544sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
9545banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
9546sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
9547
9548@lisp
9549("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
9550 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
9551@end lisp
9552
9553@end table
9554
9555@item W W c
9556@kindex W W c (Summary)
9557@findex gnus-article-hide-citation
9558Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
9559customizing the hiding:
9560
9561@table @code
9562
9563@item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
9564@itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
9565@vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
9566@vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
9567Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
9568allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
9569by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
9570specs are valid:
9571
9572@table @samp
9573@item b
9574Starting point of the hidden text.
9575@item e
9576Ending point of the hidden text.
9577@item l
9578Number of characters in the hidden region.
9579@item n
9580Number of lines of hidden text.
9581@end table
9582
9583@item gnus-cited-lines-visible
9584@vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
9585The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
9586shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
9587and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
9588
9589@end table
9590
9591@item W W C-c
9592@kindex W W C-c (Summary)
9593@findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
9594
9595Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
9596following two variables:
9597
9598@table @code
9599@item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
9600@vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
9601If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
960250), hide the cited text.
9603
9604@item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
9605@vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
9606The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
9607is hidden.
9608@end table
9609
9610@item W W C
9611@kindex W W C (Summary)
9612@findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
9613Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
9614(@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
9615useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
9616have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
9617
9618@end table
9619
9620All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
9621prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
9622hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
9623
9624Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
9625citation customization.
9626
9627@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
9628automatically.
9629
9630
9631@node Article Washing
9632@subsection Article Washing
9633@cindex washing
9634@cindex article washing
9635
9636We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
9637@kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
9638
9639@dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
9640something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
9641Cleaner, perhaps.
9642
9643@xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
9644articles by default.
9645
9646@table @kbd
9647
9648@item C-u g
9649This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
9650you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
9651the server.
9652
9653@item g
9654Force redisplaying of the current article
9655(@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
9656If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
9657interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
9658(@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
9659
9660@item W l
9661@kindex W l (Summary)
9662@findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
9663Remove page breaks from the current article
9664(@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
9665delimiters.
9666
9667@item W r
9668@kindex W r (Summary)
9669@findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
9670@c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
9671Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
9672(@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
9673Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
9674(Typically offensive jokes and such.)
9675
9676It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
9677positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
9678#15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
9679is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
9680
9681@item W m
9682@kindex W m (Summary)
9683@findex gnus-summary-morse-message
9684Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
9685
01c52d31
MB
9686@item W i
9687@kindex W i (Summary)
9688@findex gnus-summary-idna-message
9689Decode IDNA encoded domain names in the current articles. IDNA
9690encoded domain names looks like @samp{xn--bar}. If a string remain
9691unencoded after running invoking this, it is likely an invalid IDNA
9692string (@samp{xn--bar} is invalid). You must have GNU Libidn
9693(@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/}) installed for this command
9694to work.
9695
4009494e
GM
9696@item W t
9697@item t
9698@kindex W t (Summary)
9699@kindex t (Summary)
9700@findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
9701Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
9702(@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
9703
9704@item W v
9705@kindex W v (Summary)
9706@findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
9707Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
9708(@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
9709
9710@item W o
9711@kindex W o (Summary)
9712@findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
9713Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
9714
9715@item W d
9716@kindex W d (Summary)
9717@findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
9718@vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
9719@cindex Smartquotes
9720@cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
9721@cindex Latin 1
9722Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
9723@code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
9724(@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
9725whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
9726interactively.
9727
9728Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
9729an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
9730like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
9731apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
9732
9733@item W Y f
9734@kindex W Y f (Summary)
9735@findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
9736@cindex Outlook Express
9737Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
9738unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
9739(@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
9740
9741@item W Y u
9742@kindex W Y u (Summary)
9743@findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
9744@vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
9745@vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
9746Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
9747what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
9748@code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
9749@code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
9750maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
9751(@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
9752
9753@item W Y a
9754@kindex W Y a (Summary)
9755@findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
9756Repair a broken attribution line.@*
9757(@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
9758
9759@item W Y c
9760@kindex W Y c (Summary)
9761@findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
9762Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
9763(@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
9764
9765@item W w
9766@kindex W w (Summary)
9767@findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
9768Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
9769
9770You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
9771when filling.
9772
9773@item W Q
9774@kindex W Q (Summary)
9775@findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
9776Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
9777
9778@item W C
9779@kindex W C (Summary)
9780@findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
9781Capitalize the first word in each sentence
9782(@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
9783
9784@item W c
9785@kindex W c (Summary)
9786@findex gnus-article-remove-cr
9787Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
9788(this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
9789CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
9790(@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
9791
9792@item W q
9793@kindex W q (Summary)
9794@findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
9795Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
9796Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
9797sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
01c52d31
MB
9798makes strings like @samp{d@'ej@`a vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu},
9799which doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually
9800done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
4009494e
GM
9801@code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9802has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9803
9804@item W 6
9805@kindex W 6 (Summary)
9806@findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
9807Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
9808one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
9809non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
9810usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9811@code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9812has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9813
9814@item W Z
9815@kindex W Z (Summary)
9816@findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
9817Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
9818common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
9819makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
9820
01c52d31
MB
9821@item W A
9822@kindex W A (Summary)
9823@findex gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences
9824@cindex @acronym{ANSI} control sequences
9825Translate @acronym{ANSI} SGR control sequences into overlays or
9826extents (@code{gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences}). @acronym{ANSI}
9827sequences are used in some Chinese hierarchies for highlighting.
9828
4009494e
GM
9829@item W u
9830@kindex W u (Summary)
9831@findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
9832Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
9833outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
9834split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
9835the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
9836
9837@item W h
9838@kindex W h (Summary)
9839@findex gnus-article-wash-html
9840Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
9841usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9842@code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
9843
9844If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
9845the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
9846(@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
9847
9848@vindex gnus-article-wash-function
9849The default is to use the function specified by
9850@code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
9851Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
9852@acronym{HTML}, but this is controlled by the
9853@code{gnus-article-wash-function} variable. Pre-defined functions you
9854can use include:
9855
9856@table @code
9857@item w3
9858Use Emacs/W3.
9859
9860@item w3m
9861Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
9862
9863@item w3m-standalone
9864Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
9865
9866@item links
9867Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
9868
9869@item lynx
9870Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
9871
9872@item html2text
9873Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
9874
9875@end table
9876
9877@item W b
9878@kindex W b (Summary)
9879@findex gnus-article-add-buttons
9880Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
9881@xref{Article Buttons}.
9882
9883@item W B
9884@kindex W B (Summary)
9885@findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
9886Add clickable buttons to the article headers
9887(@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
9888
9889@item W p
9890@kindex W p (Summary)
9891@findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
9892Verify a signed control message
9893(@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
9894@code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
9895hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
9896the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
9897message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
9898available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
9899
9900@item W s
9901@kindex W s (Summary)
9902@findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
9903Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
9904@acronym{S/MIME}) message
9905(@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
9906
9907@item W a
9908@kindex W a (Summary)
9909@findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
9910Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
9911article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
9912
9913@item W E l
9914@kindex W E l (Summary)
9915@findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
9916Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
9917(@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
9918
9919@item W E m
9920@kindex W E m (Summary)
9921@findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
9922Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
9923lines with a single empty line.
9924(@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
9925
9926@item W E t
9927@kindex W E t (Summary)
9928@findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
9929Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
9930(@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
9931
9932@item W E a
9933@kindex W E a (Summary)
9934@findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
9935Do all the three commands above
9936(@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
9937
9938@item W E A
9939@kindex W E A (Summary)
9940@findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
9941Remove all blank lines
9942(@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
9943
9944@item W E s
9945@kindex W E s (Summary)
9946@findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
9947Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
9948body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
9949
9950@item W E e
9951@kindex W E e (Summary)
9952@findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
9953Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
9954body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
9955
9956@end table
9957
9958@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
9959
9960
9961@node Article Header
9962@subsection Article Header
9963
9964These commands perform various transformations of article header.
9965
9966@table @kbd
9967
9968@item W G u
9969@kindex W G u (Summary)
9970@findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
9971Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
9972
9973@item W G n
9974@kindex W G n (Summary)
9975@findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
9976Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
9977(@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
9978
9979@item W G f
9980@kindex W G f (Summary)
9981@findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
9982Fold all the message headers
9983(@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
9984
9985@item W E w
9986@kindex W E w (Summary)
9987@findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
9988Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
9989(@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
9990
9991@end table
9992
9993
9994@node Article Buttons
9995@subsection Article Buttons
9996@cindex buttons
9997
9998People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
9999be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
10000with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
10001button on these references.
10002
10003@vindex gnus-button-man-handler
10004Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
10005Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
10006Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
10007one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
10008
10009@table @code
10010
10011@item gnus-button-alist
10012@vindex gnus-button-alist
10013This is an alist where each entry has this form:
10014
10015@lisp
10016(@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
10017@end lisp
10018
10019@table @var
10020
10021@item regexp
10022All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
10023considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
10024embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
10025variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
10026@code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
10027
10028@item button-par
10029Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
10030is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
10031highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
10032
10033@item use-p
10034This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
10035this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
10036avoid false matches. Often variables named
10037@code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
10038Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
10039
10040@c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
10041
10042@item function
10043This function will be called when you click on this button.
10044
10045@item data-par
10046As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
10047says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
10048
10049@end table
10050
10051So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
10052
10053@lisp
10054("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
10055@end lisp
10056
10057@item gnus-header-button-alist
10058@vindex gnus-header-button-alist
10059This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
10060article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
10061used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
10062
10063@lisp
10064(@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
10065@end lisp
10066
10067@var{header} is a regular expression.
10068@end table
10069
10070@subsubsection Related variables and functions
10071
10072@table @code
10073@item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
10074@xref{Article Button Levels}.
10075
10076@c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
10077
10078@item gnus-button-url-regexp
10079@vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
10080A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
10081default values of the variables above.
10082
10083@c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
10084
10085@item gnus-button-man-handler
10086@vindex gnus-button-man-handler
10087The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
10088argument with a string naming the man page.
10089
10090@c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
10091
10092@item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
10093@vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
10094Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
10095
10096@item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
10097@vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
10098This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
10099@samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
10100message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
10101@code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
10102a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
10103@code{ask}, always query the user what to do. If it is a function, this
10104function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
10105function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
10106@code{ask}. The default value is the function
10107@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
10108
10109@item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
10110@findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
10111Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
10112address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
10113it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
10114string is invalid.
10115
10116@item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
10117@vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
10118An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
10119@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
10120
10121@c Stuff related to gnus-button-tex-level
10122
10123@item gnus-button-ctan-handler
10124@findex gnus-button-ctan-handler
10125The function to use for displaying CTAN links. It must take one
10126argument, the string naming the URL.
10127
10128@item gnus-ctan-url
10129@vindex gnus-ctan-url
10130Top directory of a CTAN (Comprehensive TeX Archive Network) archive used
10131by @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler}.
10132
10133@c Misc stuff
10134
10135@item gnus-article-button-face
10136@vindex gnus-article-button-face
10137Face used on buttons.
10138
10139@item gnus-article-mouse-face
10140@vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
10141Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
10142
10143@end table
10144
10145@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
10146
10147
10148@node Article Button Levels
10149@subsection Article button levels
10150@cindex button levels
10151The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
10152the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
10153buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
10154already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
10155more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
10156you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
10157specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
10158variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
10159
10160@lisp
10161;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
10162(setq gnus-parameters
10163 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
10164 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
10165 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
10166@end lisp
10167
10168@table @code
10169
10170@item gnus-button-browse-level
10171@vindex gnus-button-browse-level
10172Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
10173news URLs. Related variables and functions include
10174@code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
10175@code{browse-url-browser-function}.
10176
10177@item gnus-button-emacs-level
10178@vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
10179Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
10180@code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
10181@code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
10182@code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
10183@code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
10184@code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
10185@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
10186@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
10187@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
10188@code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
10189@code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
10190
10191@item gnus-button-man-level
10192@vindex gnus-button-man-level
10193Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
10194See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
10195
10196@item gnus-button-message-level
10197@vindex gnus-button-message-level
10198Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
10199Related variables and functions include
10200@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
10201@code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
10202@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
10203@code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
10204
10205@item gnus-button-tex-level
10206@vindex gnus-button-tex-level
10207Controls the display of references to @TeX{} or LaTeX stuff, e.g. for CTAN
10208URLs. See the variables @code{gnus-ctan-url},
10209@code{gnus-button-ctan-handler},
10210@code{gnus-button-ctan-directory-regexp}, and
10211@code{gnus-button-handle-ctan-bogus-regexp}.
10212
10213@end table
10214
10215
10216@node Article Date
10217@subsection Article Date
10218
10219The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
10220heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
10221when the article was sent.
10222
10223@table @kbd
10224
10225@item W T u
10226@kindex W T u (Summary)
10227@findex gnus-article-date-ut
10228Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
10229(@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
10230
10231@item W T i
10232@kindex W T i (Summary)
10233@findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
10234@cindex ISO 8601
10235Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
10236(@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
10237
10238@item W T l
10239@kindex W T l (Summary)
10240@findex gnus-article-date-local
10241Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
10242
10243@item W T p
10244@kindex W T p (Summary)
10245@findex gnus-article-date-english
10246Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
10247(@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
10248
10249@item W T s
10250@kindex W T s (Summary)
10251@vindex gnus-article-time-format
10252@findex gnus-article-date-user
10253@findex format-time-string
10254Display the date using a user-defined format
10255(@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
10256@code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
10257to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
10258for a list of possible format specs.
10259
10260@item W T e
10261@kindex W T e (Summary)
10262@findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
10263@findex gnus-start-date-timer
10264@findex gnus-stop-date-timer
10265Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
10266(@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
10267
10268@example
10269X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
10270@end example
10271
10272@vindex gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header
10273The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
10274whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
10275replace it.
10276
10277An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
10278into wonderful absurdities.
10279
10280If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
10281
10282@lisp
10283(gnus-start-date-timer)
10284@end lisp
10285
10286in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
10287you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
10288command.
10289
10290@item W T o
10291@kindex W T o (Summary)
10292@findex gnus-article-date-original
10293Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
10294be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
10295worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
10296that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
10297@emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
10298
10299@end table
10300
10301@xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
10302preferred format automatically.
10303
10304
10305@node Article Display
10306@subsection Article Display
10307@cindex picons
10308@cindex x-face
10309@cindex smileys
10310
10311These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
10312buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
10313
10314@code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
10315message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
10316
10317@code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
10318headers (@pxref{Face}).
10319
10320Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
10321their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
10322
10323Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
10324try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
10325
10326All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
10327they'll be removed.
10328
10329@table @kbd
10330@item W D x
10331@kindex W D x (Summary)
10332@findex gnus-article-display-x-face
10333Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
10334(@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
10335
10336@item W D d
10337@kindex W D d (Summary)
10338@findex gnus-article-display-face
10339Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
10340(@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
10341
10342@item W D s
10343@kindex W D s (Summary)
10344@findex gnus-treat-smiley
10345Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
10346
10347@item W D f
10348@kindex W D f (Summary)
10349@findex gnus-treat-from-picon
10350Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
10351
10352@item W D m
10353@kindex W D m (Summary)
10354@findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
10355Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
10356(@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
10357
10358@item W D n
10359@kindex W D n (Summary)
10360@findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
10361Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
10362@code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
10363
10364@item W D D
10365@kindex W D D (Summary)
10366@findex gnus-article-remove-images
10367Remove all images from the article buffer
10368(@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
10369
10370@end table
10371
10372
10373
10374@node Article Signature
10375@subsection Article Signature
10376@cindex signatures
10377@cindex article signature
10378
10379@vindex gnus-signature-separator
10380Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
10381body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
10382that says what is to be considered a signature is
10383@code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
10384@samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
10385non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
10386of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
10387from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
10388
10389@lisp
10390(setq gnus-signature-separator
10391 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
10392 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
10393 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
10394 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
10395 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
10396 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
10397 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
10398@end lisp
10399
10400The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
10401positives.
10402
10403@vindex gnus-signature-limit
10404@code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
10405signature when displaying articles.
10406
10407@enumerate
10408@item
10409If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
10410that integer.
10411@item
10412If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
10413than that number.
10414@item
10415If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
10416and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
10417@item
10418If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
10419in question is not a signature.
10420@end enumerate
10421
10422This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
10423listed above. Here's an example:
10424
10425@lisp
10426(setq gnus-signature-limit
10427 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
10428@end lisp
10429
10430This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
10431separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
10432the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
10433signature after all.
10434
10435
10436@node Article Miscellanea
10437@subsection Article Miscellanea
10438
10439@table @kbd
10440@item A t
10441@kindex A t (Summary)
10442@findex gnus-article-babel
10443Translate the article from one language to another
10444(@code{gnus-article-babel}).
10445
10446@end table
10447
10448
10449@node MIME Commands
10450@section MIME Commands
10451@cindex MIME decoding
10452@cindex attachments
10453@cindex viewing attachments
10454
10455The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
01c52d31 10456instance, @kbd{3 K v} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
4009494e
GM
10457
10458@table @kbd
10459@item b
10460@itemx K v
10461@kindex b (Summary)
10462@kindex K v (Summary)
10463View the @acronym{MIME} part.
10464
10465@item K o
10466@kindex K o (Summary)
10467Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
10468
01c52d31
MB
10469@item K O
10470@kindex K O (Summary)
10471Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} part and strip it
10472from the article. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred
10473via the message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
10474
10475@item K r
10476@kindex K r (Summary)
10477Replace the @acronym{MIME} part with an external body.
10478
10479@item K d
10480@kindex K d (Summary)
10481Delete the @acronym{MIME} part and add some information about the
10482removed part.
10483
4009494e
GM
10484@item K c
10485@kindex K c (Summary)
10486Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
10487
10488@item K e
10489@kindex K e (Summary)
10490View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
10491
10492@item K i
10493@kindex K i (Summary)
10494View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
10495
10496@item K |
10497@kindex K | (Summary)
10498Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
10499@end table
10500
10501The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
10502the same manner:
10503
10504@table @kbd
9b3ebcb6
MB
10505@item K H
10506@kindex K H (Summary)
10507@findex gnus-article-browse-html-article
10508View @samp{text/html} parts of the current article with a WWW browser.
10509The message header is added to the beginning of every html part unless
10510the prefix argument is given.
10511
10512Warning: Spammers use links to images in HTML articles to verify whether
10513you have read the message. As this command passes the @acronym{HTML}
10514content to the browser without eliminating these ``web bugs'' you should
10515only use it for mails from trusted senders.
10516
10517If you always want to display @acronym{HTML} parts in the browser, set
10518@code{mm-text-html-renderer} to @code{nil}.
10519
4009494e
GM
10520@item K b
10521@kindex K b (Summary)
10522Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
10523mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
10524parts.
10525
10526@item K m
10527@kindex K m (Summary)
10528@findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
10529Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
10530This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
10531be viewed in a more pleasant manner
10532(@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
10533
10534@item X m
10535@kindex X m (Summary)
10536@findex gnus-summary-save-parts
10537Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
10538(@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
10539convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10540
10541@item M-t
10542@kindex M-t (Summary)
10543@findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
10544Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
10545(@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
10546
10547@item W M w
10548@kindex W M w (Summary)
10549@findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
10550Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
10551(@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
10552
10553@item W M c
10554@kindex W M c (Summary)
10555@findex gnus-article-decode-charset
10556Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
10557(@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
10558
10559This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
10560charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
10561prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
10562groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
10563include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
10564parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
10565
10566@item W M v
10567@kindex W M v (Summary)
10568@findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
10569View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
10570(@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
10571
10572@end table
10573
10574Relevant variables:
10575
10576@table @code
10577@item gnus-ignored-mime-types
10578@vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
10579This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
10580this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
10581@code{nil}.
10582
10583To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
10584
10585@lisp
10586(setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
10587 '("text/x-vcard"))
10588@end lisp
10589
10590@item gnus-article-loose-mime
10591@vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
10592If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
10593before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
10594when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
b890d447 10595default is @code{t}.
4009494e
GM
10596
10597@item gnus-article-emulate-mime
10598@vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
10599@cindex uuencode
10600@cindex yEnc
10601There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
10602is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
10603this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
10604see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
10605Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
10606single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
10607for encoding in Gnus.
10608
10609@item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
10610@vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
10611This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
10612this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
10613displayed or this variable is overridden by
10614@code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
10615@code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
10616@code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
10617
10618@item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
10619@vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
10620This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
10621this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
10622displayed. This variable overrides
10623@code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
10624This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
10625is @code{nil}.
10626
10627To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
10628variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
10629@code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
10630
10631You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
10632display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
10633those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
10634(@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
10635Emacs MIME Manual}).
10636
10637@item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
10638@vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
10639If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
10640default value is @code{nil}.
10641
10642@item gnus-article-mime-part-function
10643@vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
10644For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
10645handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
10646users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
10647the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
10648save all jpegs into some directory).
10649
10650Here's an example function the does the latter:
10651
10652@lisp
10653(defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
10654 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
10655 (with-temp-buffer
10656 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
10657 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
10658 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
10659(setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
10660 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
10661@end lisp
10662
10663@vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
10664@item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
10665Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
10666
10667@vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
10668@item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
10669Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
10670
10671@vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
10672@item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
10673Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
10674
9b3ebcb6 10675If displaying @samp{text/html} is discouraged, see
4009494e
GM
10676@code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
10677"multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
10678@code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
10679emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
10680
10681@vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
10682@item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
10683Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
10684overrides @code{nil} values of
10685@code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
10686@code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
10687
10688@vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
10689@item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
10690List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
10691Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
10692
10693Ready-made functions include@*
10694@code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
10695@code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
10696@code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
10697@code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
10698the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
10699whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
10700is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
10701@findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
10702@findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
10703@findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
10704@findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
10705@vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
10706
10707The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
10708@code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
10709
10710Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
10711except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
10712such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
10713
10714@lisp
10715(setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
10716 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
10717 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
10718 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
10719@end lisp
10720
10721@noindent
10722to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
10723
10724@end table
10725
10726
10727@node Charsets
10728@section Charsets
10729@cindex charsets
10730
10731People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
10732charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
10733newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
10734just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
10735help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
10736what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
10737hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
10738
10739@vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
10740This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
10741variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
10742group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
10743
10744@vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
10745In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
10746aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
10747even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
10748@code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
10749charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
10750set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
10751Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
10752which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
10753
10754@vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
10755When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
10756determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
10757encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
10758quoted-printable header encoding.
10759
10760This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
10761for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
10762header body-list}@code{)}, where:
10763
10764@table @var
10765@item test
10766is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
10767variable to query,
10768@item header
10769is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
10770means encode all charsets),
10771@item body-list
10772is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
10773encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
10774encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
10775@end table
10776
10777@cindex Russian
10778@cindex koi8-r
10779@cindex koi8-u
10780@cindex iso-8859-5
10781@cindex coding system aliases
10782@cindex preferred charset
10783
10784@xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
10785The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
10786MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
10787
10788Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
10789
10790If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
10791charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
10792
10793@lisp
10794(put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
10795 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
10796@end lisp
10797
10798This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
10799the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
10800
10801If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
10802
10803@lisp
10804(define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
10805@end lisp
10806
10807This will almost do the right thing.
10808
10809And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
10810something like
10811
10812@lisp
10813(codepage-setup 1251)
10814(define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
10815@end lisp
10816
10817
10818@node Article Commands
10819@section Article Commands
10820
10821@table @kbd
10822
10823@item A P
10824@cindex PostScript
10825@cindex printing
10826@kindex A P (Summary)
10827@vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
10828@findex gnus-summary-print-article
10829Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
10830(@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
10831be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
10832article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
10833
10834@end table
10835
10836
10837@node Summary Sorting
10838@section Summary Sorting
10839@cindex summary sorting
10840
10841You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
10842can't really see why you'd want that.
10843
10844@table @kbd
10845
10846@item C-c C-s C-n
10847@kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10848@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
10849Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
10850
6ecfe5c2
MB
10851@item C-c C-s C-m C-n
10852@kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10853@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number
10854Sort by most recent article number
10855(@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number}).
10856
4009494e
GM
10857@item C-c C-s C-a
10858@kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
10859@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
10860Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
10861
01c52d31
MB
10862@item C-c C-s C-t
10863@kindex C-c C-s C-t (Summary)
10864@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient
10865Sort by recipient (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient}).
10866
4009494e
GM
10867@item C-c C-s C-s
10868@kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
10869@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
10870Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
10871
10872@item C-c C-s C-d
10873@kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
10874@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
10875Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
10876
6ecfe5c2
MB
10877@item C-c C-s C-m C-d
10878@kindex C-c C-s C-m C-d (Summary)
10879@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date
10880Sort by most recent date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date}).
10881
4009494e
GM
10882@item C-c C-s C-l
10883@kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
10884@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
10885Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
10886
10887@item C-c C-s C-c
10888@kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
10889@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
10890Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
10891
10892@item C-c C-s C-i
10893@kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
10894@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
10895Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
10896
10897@item C-c C-s C-r
10898@kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
10899@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
10900Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
10901
10902@item C-c C-s C-o
10903@kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
10904@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
10905Sort using the default sorting method
10906(@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
10907@end table
10908
10909These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
10910use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
10911line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
10912root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
10913toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
10914Commands}).
10915
6ecfe5c2
MB
10916If a prefix argument if given, the sort order is reversed.
10917
4009494e
GM
10918
10919@node Finding the Parent
10920@section Finding the Parent
10921@cindex parent articles
10922@cindex referring articles
10923
10924@table @kbd
10925@item ^
10926@kindex ^ (Summary)
10927@findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
10928If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
10929displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
10930if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
10931and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
10932can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
10933(@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
10934you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
10935summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
10936
10937If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
10938the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
10939ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
10940grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
10941@kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
10942article.
10943
10944@item A R (Summary)
10945@findex gnus-summary-refer-references
10946@kindex A R (Summary)
10947Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
10948article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
10949
10950@item A T (Summary)
10951@findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
10952@kindex A T (Summary)
10953Display the full thread where the current article appears
10954(@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
10955headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
10956you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
10957to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
10958visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
10959faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
10960
10961@vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
10962The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
10963articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
10964fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
10965the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
10966by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
10967
10968@item M-^ (Summary)
10969@findex gnus-summary-refer-article
10970@kindex M-^ (Summary)
10971@cindex Message-ID
10972@cindex fetching by Message-ID
10973You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
10974belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
10975for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
10976thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
10977You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
10978
10979Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
10980been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
10981@code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
10982@end table
10983
10984@vindex gnus-refer-article-method
10985If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
10986support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
10987you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
10988would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
10989updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
10990necessary.
10991
10992It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
10993@code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
10994is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
10995match.
10996
10997Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
10998then ask Google if that fails:
10999
11000@lisp
11001(setq gnus-refer-article-method
11002 '(current
11003 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
11004@end lisp
11005
11006Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
11007do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
11008@code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
11009articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
11010only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
11011group. (Anything else would be too time consuming.) @code{nnmh} does
11012not support this at all.
11013
11014
11015@node Alternative Approaches
11016@section Alternative Approaches
11017
11018Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
11019Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
11020
11021@menu
11022* Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
11023* Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
11024@end menu
11025
11026
11027@node Pick and Read
11028@subsection Pick and Read
11029@cindex pick and read
11030
11031Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
11032a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
11033buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
11034articles with just an article buffer displayed.
11035
11036@findex gnus-pick-mode
11037@kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
11038Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
11039this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
11040mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
11041it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
11042
11043Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
11044
11045@table @kbd
11046@item .
11047@kindex . (Pick)
11048@findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
11049Pick the article or thread on the current line
11050(@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
11051@code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
11052entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
11053it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
11054thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
11055at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
11056
11057@item SPACE
11058@kindex SPACE (Pick)
11059@findex gnus-pick-next-page
11060Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
11061at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
11062
11063@item u
11064@kindex u (Pick)
11065@findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
11066Unpick the thread or article
11067(@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
11068@code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
11069thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
11070just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
11071the thread or article at that line.
11072
11073@item RET
11074@kindex RET (Pick)
11075@findex gnus-pick-start-reading
11076@vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
11077Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
11078given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
11079@code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
11080will still be visible when you are reading.
11081
11082@end table
11083
11084All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
11085pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
11086which is mapped to the same function
11087@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
11088
11089If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
11090
11091@lisp
11092(add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
11093@end lisp
11094
11095@vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
11096@code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
11097
11098@vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
11099If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
11100all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
11101
11102@vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
11103The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
11104standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
11105displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
11106@code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
11107Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
11108@code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
11109
11110
11111@node Binary Groups
11112@subsection Binary Groups
11113@cindex binary groups
11114
11115@findex gnus-binary-mode
11116@kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
11117If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
11118@kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
11119is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
11120selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
11121instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
11122
11123@kindex g (Binary)
11124@findex gnus-binary-show-article
11125The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
11126command, when you have turned on this mode
11127(@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
11128
11129@vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
11130@code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
11131
11132
11133@node Tree Display
11134@section Tree Display
11135@cindex trees
11136
11137@vindex gnus-use-trees
11138If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
11139@code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
11140additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
11141in the tree buffer.
11142
11143There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
11144
11145@table @code
11146@item gnus-tree-mode-hook
11147@vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
11148A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
11149
11150@item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
11151@vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
11152A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
11153Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
11154of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
11155
11156@item gnus-selected-tree-face
11157@vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
11158Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
11159default is @code{modeline}.
11160
11161@item gnus-tree-line-format
11162@vindex gnus-tree-line-format
11163A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
11164though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
11165is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
11166the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
11167length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
11168
11169Valid specs are:
11170
11171@table @samp
11172@item n
11173The name of the poster.
11174@item f
11175The @code{From} header.
11176@item N
11177The number of the article.
11178@item [
11179The opening bracket.
11180@item ]
11181The closing bracket.
11182@item s
11183The subject.
11184@end table
11185
11186@xref{Formatting Variables}.
11187
11188Variables related to the display are:
11189
11190@table @code
11191@item gnus-tree-brackets
11192@vindex gnus-tree-brackets
11193This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
11194``sparse'' articles. The format is
11195@example
11196((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
11197 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
11198 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
11199@end example
11200and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
11201
11202@item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
11203@vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
11204This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
11205nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
11206
11207@end table
11208
11209@item gnus-tree-minimize-window
11210@vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
11211If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
11212buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
11213windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
11214higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
11215have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
11216buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
11217other windows displayed next to it.
11218
11219You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
11220at all times:
11221
11222@lisp
11223(add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
11224 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
11225@end lisp
11226
11227@item gnus-generate-tree-function
11228@vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
11229@findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
11230@findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
11231The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
11232functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
11233@code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
11234
11235@end table
11236
11237Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
11238
11239@example
11240@{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
11241 | \[Jan]
11242 | \[odd]-[Eri]
11243 | \(***)-[Eri]
11244 | \[odd]-[Paa]
11245 \[Bjo]
11246 \[Gun]
11247 \[Gun]-[Jor]
11248@end example
11249
11250Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
11251
11252@example
11253@group
11254@{***@}
11255 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
11256(***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
11257 |--\-----\-----\ |
11258[odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
11259 | | |--\
11260[Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
11261 |
11262 [Paa]
11263@end group
11264@end example
11265
11266If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
11267side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
11268following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
11269
11270@lisp
11271(setq gnus-use-trees t
11272 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
11273 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
11274(gnus-add-configuration
11275 '(article
11276 (vertical 1.0
11277 (horizontal 0.25
11278 (summary 0.75 point)
11279 (tree 1.0))
11280 (article 1.0))))
11281@end lisp
11282
11283@xref{Window Layout}.
11284
11285
11286@node Mail Group Commands
11287@section Mail Group Commands
11288@cindex mail group commands
11289
11290Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
11291invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
11292
11293All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
11294process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
11295
11296@table @kbd
11297
11298@item B e
11299@kindex B e (Summary)
11300@findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
11301@cindex expiring mail
11302Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
11303process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
11304expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
11305(@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
11306
11307@item B C-M-e
11308@kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
11309@findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
11310@cindex expiring mail
11311Delete all the expirable articles in the group
11312(@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
11313articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
11314disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
11315
11316@item B DEL
11317@kindex B DEL (Summary)
b1519d85 11318@cindex deleting mail
4009494e
GM
11319@findex gnus-summary-delete-article
11320@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
11321Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
11322disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
11323(@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
11324
11325@item B m
11326@kindex B m (Summary)
11327@cindex move mail
11328@findex gnus-summary-move-article
11329@vindex gnus-preserve-marks
11330Move the article from one mail group to another
11331(@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
11332@code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
11333
11334@item B c
11335@kindex B c (Summary)
11336@cindex copy mail
11337@findex gnus-summary-copy-article
11338@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
11339Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
11340(@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
11341@code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
11342
11343@item B B
11344@kindex B B (Summary)
11345@cindex crosspost mail
11346@findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
11347Crosspost the current article to some other group
11348(@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
11349the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
11350be properly updated.
11351
11352@item B i
11353@kindex B i (Summary)
11354@findex gnus-summary-import-article
11355Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
11356(@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
11357name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
11358
11359@item B I
11360@kindex B I (Summary)
11361@findex gnus-summary-create-article
11362Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
11363(@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
11364@code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
11365
11366@item B r
11367@kindex B r (Summary)
11368@findex gnus-summary-respool-article
11369@vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
11370Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
11371@code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
11372select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
11373which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
11374Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
11375(which is the default).
11376
11377@item B w
11378@itemx e
11379@kindex B w (Summary)
11380@kindex e (Summary)
11381@findex gnus-summary-edit-article
11382@kindex C-c C-c (Article)
11383@findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
11384Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
11385editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
11386(@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
11387@kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
11388
11389@item B q
11390@kindex B q (Summary)
11391@findex gnus-summary-respool-query
11392If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
11393the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
11394will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
11395
11396@item B t
11397@kindex B t (Summary)
11398@findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
11399Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
11400when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
11401
11402@item B p
11403@kindex B p (Summary)
11404@findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
11405Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
11406follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
11407@code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
11408(@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
11409article from your news server (or rather, from
11410@code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
11411report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
11412it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
11413propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
11414just not have arrived yet.
11415
11416@item K E
11417@kindex K E (Summary)
11418@findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
11419@vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
11420Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
11421The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
11422variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
11423
11424@end table
11425
11426@vindex gnus-move-split-methods
11427@cindex moving articles
11428If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
11429suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
11430variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
11431(@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
11432suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
11433@code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
11434@code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
11435
11436@lisp
11437(setq gnus-move-split-methods
11438 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
11439 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
11440 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
11441@end lisp
11442
11443
11444@node Various Summary Stuff
11445@section Various Summary Stuff
11446
11447@menu
11448* Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
11449* Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
11450* Summary Generation Commands::
11451* Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
11452@end menu
11453
11454@table @code
11455@vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
11456@item gnus-summary-display-while-building
11457If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
11458built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
11459If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
11460lines. The default is @code{nil}.
11461
11462@vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
11463@item gnus-summary-display-arrow
11464If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
11465current article.
11466
11467@vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
11468@item gnus-summary-mode-hook
11469This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
11470
11471@vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
11472@item gnus-summary-generate-hook
11473This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
11474generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
11475the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
11476is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
11477have been set.
11478
11479@vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
11480@item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
11481It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
11482it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
11483some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
11484
11485@vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
11486@item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
11487A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
11488generated.
11489
11490@vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
11491@item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
11492When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
11493it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
11494same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
11495sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
11496If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
11497@code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
11498any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
11499article---it'll be as if it never existed.
11500
11501@vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
11502@item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
11503This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
11504of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
11505list of articles to be selected.
11506
11507For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
11508the list in one particular group:
11509
11510@lisp
11511(defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
11512 (if (string= group "some.group")
11513 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
11514 articles))
11515@end lisp
11516
11517@vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
11518@item gnus-newsgroup-variables
11519A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
11520variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
11521values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
11522buffer is active.
11523
11524Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
11525@code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
11526assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
11527that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
11528variable will be used instead.
11529
11530These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
11531while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
11532buffers. For example:
11533
11534@lisp
11535(setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
11536 '(message-use-followup-to
11537 (gnus-visible-headers .
11538 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
11539@end lisp
11540
11541Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
3a23a519
MB
11542
11543@vindex gnus-propagate-marks
11544@item gnus-propagate-marks
11545If non-@code{nil}, propagate marks to the backends for possible
11546storing. @xref{NNTP marks}, and friends, for a more fine-grained
11547sieve.
11548
4009494e
GM
11549@end table
11550
11551
11552@node Summary Group Information
11553@subsection Summary Group Information
11554
11555@table @kbd
11556
11557@item H f
11558@kindex H f (Summary)
11559@findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
11560@vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
11561Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} (list of frequently asked questions)
11562for the current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try
11563to get the @acronym{FAQ} from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which
11564is usually a directory on a remote machine. This variable can also be
11565a list of directories. In that case, giving a prefix to this command
11566will allow you to choose between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp}
11567or @code{efs} will probably be used for fetching the file.
11568
11569@item H d
11570@kindex H d (Summary)
11571@findex gnus-summary-describe-group
11572Give a brief description of the current group
11573(@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
11574rereading the description from the server.
11575
11576@item H h
11577@kindex H h (Summary)
11578@findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
11579Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
11580keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
11581
11582@item H i
11583@kindex H i (Summary)
11584@findex gnus-info-find-node
11585Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
11586@end table
11587
11588
11589@node Searching for Articles
11590@subsection Searching for Articles
11591
11592@table @kbd
11593
11594@item M-s
11595@kindex M-s (Summary)
11596@findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
11597Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
11598(@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
11599
11600@item M-r
11601@kindex M-r (Summary)
11602@findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
11603Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
11604(@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
11605
01c52d31
MB
11606@item M-S
11607@kindex M-S (Summary)
11608@findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward
11609Repeat the previous search forwards
11610(@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward}).
11611
11612@item M-R
11613@kindex M-R (Summary)
11614@findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward
11615Repeat the previous search backwards
11616(@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward}).
11617
4009494e
GM
11618@item &
11619@kindex & (Summary)
11620@findex gnus-summary-execute-command
11621This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
11622on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
11623(@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
11624string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
11625search backward instead.
11626
11627For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
11628all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
11629
11630@item M-&
11631@kindex M-& (Summary)
11632@findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
11633Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
11634the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
11635@end table
11636
11637@node Summary Generation Commands
11638@subsection Summary Generation Commands
11639
11640@table @kbd
11641
11642@item Y g
11643@kindex Y g (Summary)
11644@findex gnus-summary-prepare
11645Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
11646
11647@item Y c
11648@kindex Y c (Summary)
11649@findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
11650Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
11651(@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
11652
11653@item Y d
11654@kindex Y d (Summary)
11655@findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
11656Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
11657(@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
11658
01c52d31
MB
11659@item Y t
11660@kindex Y t (Summary)
11661@findex gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles
11662Pull all ticked articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
11663(@code{gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles}).
11664
4009494e
GM
11665@end table
11666
11667
11668@node Really Various Summary Commands
11669@subsection Really Various Summary Commands
11670
11671@table @kbd
11672
11673@item A D
11674@itemx C-d
11675@kindex C-d (Summary)
11676@kindex A D (Summary)
11677@findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
11678If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
11679a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
11680article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
11681guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
11682to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
11683whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
11684some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
11685fashion.
11686
01c52d31
MB
11687@vindex gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit
11688The variable @code{gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit} controls what
11689article should be selected after exiting a digest group. Valid values
11690include:
11691
11692@table @code
11693@item next
11694Select the next article.
11695
11696@item next-unread
11697Select the next unread article.
11698
11699@item next-noselect
11700Move the cursor to the next article. This is the default.
11701
11702@item next-unread-noselect
11703Move the cursor to the next unread article.
11704@end table
11705
11706If it has any other value or there is no next (unread) article, the
11707article selected before entering to the digest group will appear.
11708
4009494e
GM
11709@item C-M-d
11710@kindex C-M-d (Summary)
11711@findex gnus-summary-read-document
11712This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
11713several documents into one biiig group
11714(@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
11715@code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
11716@code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
11717command understands the process/prefix convention
11718(@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
11719
11720@item C-t
11721@kindex C-t (Summary)
11722@findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
11723Toggle truncation of summary lines
11724(@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
11725line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
11726to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
11727
11728@item =
11729@kindex = (Summary)
11730@findex gnus-summary-expand-window
11731Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
11732If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
11733
11734@item C-M-e
11735@kindex C-M-e (Summary)
11736@findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
11737Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11738group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
11739
11740@item C-M-a
11741@kindex C-M-a (Summary)
11742@findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
11743Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11744group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
11745
11746@end table
11747
11748
11749@node Exiting the Summary Buffer
11750@section Exiting the Summary Buffer
11751@cindex summary exit
11752@cindex exiting groups
11753
11754Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
11755group and return you to the group buffer.
11756
11757@table @kbd
11758
11759@item Z Z
11760@itemx Z Q
11761@itemx q
11762@kindex Z Z (Summary)
11763@kindex Z Q (Summary)
11764@kindex q (Summary)
11765@findex gnus-summary-exit
11766@vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
11767@vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
11768@vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
11769@c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
11770Exit the current group and update all information on the group
11771(@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
11772called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
11773@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
11774@code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
11775process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
11776group mode having no more (unread) groups.
11777
11778@item Z E
11779@itemx Q
11780@kindex Z E (Summary)
11781@kindex Q (Summary)
11782@findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
11783Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
11784(@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
11785
11786@item Z c
11787@itemx c
11788@kindex Z c (Summary)
11789@kindex c (Summary)
11790@findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
11791@c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
11792Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
11793(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
11794
11795@item Z C
11796@kindex Z C (Summary)
11797@findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
11798Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
11799(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
11800
11801@item Z n
11802@kindex Z n (Summary)
11803@findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
11804Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
11805(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
11806
01c52d31
MB
11807@item Z p
11808@kindex Z p (Summary)
11809@findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group
11810Mark all articles as read and go to the previous group
11811(@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group}).
11812
4009494e
GM
11813@item Z R
11814@itemx C-x C-s
11815@kindex Z R (Summary)
11816@kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
11817@findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
11818Exit this group, and then enter it again
11819(@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
11820all articles, both read and unread.
11821
11822@item Z G
11823@itemx M-g
11824@kindex Z G (Summary)
11825@kindex M-g (Summary)
11826@findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
11827@c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
11828Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
11829group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
11830articles, both read and unread.
11831
11832@item Z N
11833@kindex Z N (Summary)
11834@findex gnus-summary-next-group
11835Exit the group and go to the next group
11836(@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
11837
11838@item Z P
11839@kindex Z P (Summary)
11840@findex gnus-summary-prev-group
11841Exit the group and go to the previous group
11842(@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
11843
11844@item Z s
11845@kindex Z s (Summary)
11846@findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
11847Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
11848and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
11849given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
11850command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
11851@end table
11852
11853@vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
11854@code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
11855with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
11856(@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
11857
11858@findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
11859@findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
11860@vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
11861If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
11862about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
11863If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
11864(Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
11865something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
11866called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
11867buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
11868@code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
11869summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
11870
11871There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
11872
11873@vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
11874The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
11875read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
11876summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
11877@code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
11878this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
11879other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
11880neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
11881both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
11882
11883
11884@node Crosspost Handling
11885@section Crosspost Handling
11886
11887@cindex velveeta
11888@cindex spamming
11889Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
11890read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
11891posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
11892several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
11893by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
11894heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
11895(@pxref{NoCeM}).
11896
11897Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
11898separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
11899@dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
11900@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
11901excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
11902
11903@cindex cross-posting
11904@cindex Xref
11905@cindex @acronym{NOV}
11906One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
11907correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
11908(which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
11909does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
11910Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
11911even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
11912articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
11913them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
11914the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
11915the cross reference mechanism.
11916
11917@cindex LIST overview.fmt
11918@cindex overview.fmt
11919To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
11920in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
11921@samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
11922overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
11923get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
11924your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
11925overview files.
11926
4009494e 11927If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
4b70e299
MB
11928set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
11929considerably. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
4009494e
GM
11930
11931C'est la vie.
11932
11933For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
11934
11935
11936@node Duplicate Suppression
11937@section Duplicate Suppression
11938
11939By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
11940article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
11941(@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
11942approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
11943reasons.
11944
11945@enumerate
11946@item
11947The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
11948is evil and not very common.
11949
11950@item
11951The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
11952@file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
11953
11954@item
11955You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
11956different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
11957
11958@item
11959You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
11960@end enumerate
11961
11962I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
11963well, but these four are the most common situations.
11964
11965If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
11966consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
11967will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
11968otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
11969all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
11970mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
11971so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
11972once.
11973
11974Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
11975sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
11976fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
11977to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
11978article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
11979saw the article in.
11980
11981@table @code
11982@item gnus-suppress-duplicates
11983@vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
11984If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
11985
11986@item gnus-save-duplicate-list
11987@vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
11988If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
11989make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
11990However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
11991session are suppressed.
11992
11993@item gnus-duplicate-list-length
11994@vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
11995This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
11996suppression list. The default is 10000.
11997
11998@item gnus-duplicate-file
11999@vindex gnus-duplicate-file
12000The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
12001default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
12002@end table
12003
12004If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
12005@code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
12006you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
12007the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
12008so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
12009@code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
12010to you to figure out, I think.
12011
12012@node Security
12013@section Security
12014
12015Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
12016The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
12017and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
12018things to work:
12019
12020@enumerate
12021@item
12022To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
12023install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
8c9bb6f5
DU
12024to GnuPG included with Emacs is called EasyPG (@pxref{Top, ,EasyPG,
12025epa, EasyPG Assistant user's manual}), but PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg,
12026PGG Manual}), Mailcrypt, and gpg.el are also supported.
4009494e
GM
12027
12028@item
12029To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
12030or newer is recommended.
12031
12032@end enumerate
12033
4146636e
KY
12034The variables that control security functionality on reading/composing
12035messages include:
4009494e
GM
12036
12037@table @code
12038@item mm-verify-option
12039@vindex mm-verify-option
12040Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
12041@code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
12042protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
12043
12044@item mm-decrypt-option
12045@vindex mm-decrypt-option
12046Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
12047@code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
12048protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
12049
4146636e
KY
12050@item mm-sign-option
12051@vindex mm-sign-option
12052Option of creating signed parts. @code{nil}, use default signing
12053keys; @code{guided}, ask user to select signing keys from the menu.
12054
12055@item mm-encrypt-option
12056@vindex mm-encrypt-option
12057Option of creating encrypted parts. @code{nil}, use the first
12058public-key matching the @samp{From:} header as the recipient;
12059@code{guided}, ask user to select recipient keys from the menu.
12060
4009494e
GM
12061@item mml1991-use
12062@vindex mml1991-use
12063Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
7f3bc720
DU
12064@acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but @code{pgg},
12065@code{mailcrypt}, and @code{gpg} are also supported although
8c9bb6f5 12066deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available interface in
71fbd643 12067this order.
4009494e
GM
12068
12069@item mml2015-use
12070@vindex mml2015-use
12071Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
7f3bc720
DU
12072@acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but
12073@code{pgg}, @code{mailcrypt}, and @code{gpg} are also supported
71fbd643 12074although deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available
8c9bb6f5 12075interface in this order.
4009494e
GM
12076
12077@end table
12078
12079By default the buttons that display security information are not
12080shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
12081@kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
12082@code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
12083@code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
12084permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
12085how to customize these variables to always display security
12086information.
12087
12088@cindex snarfing keys
12089@cindex importing PGP keys
12090@cindex PGP key ring import
12091Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
12092key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
12093rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
12094allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
12095through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
12096@file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
12097Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
12098Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
12099(@pxref{Using MIME}).
12100
12101@example
12102application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
12103@end example
12104@noindent
12105This happens to also be the default action defined in
12106@code{mailcap-mime-data}.
12107
12108More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
12109encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
12110(@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
12111
12112@node Mailing List
12113@section Mailing List
12114@cindex mailing list
12115@cindex RFC 2396
12116
12117@kindex A M (summary)
12118@findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
12119Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
12120add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
12121possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
12122summary buffer.
12123
12124That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
12125
12126@table @kbd
12127
12128@item C-c C-n h
12129@kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
12130@findex gnus-mailing-list-help
12131Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
12132
12133@item C-c C-n s
12134@kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
12135@findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
12136Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
12137
12138@item C-c C-n u
12139@kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
12140@findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
12141Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
12142field exists.
12143
12144@item C-c C-n p
12145@kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
12146@findex gnus-mailing-list-post
12147Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
12148
12149@item C-c C-n o
12150@kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
12151@findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
12152Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
12153
12154@item C-c C-n a
12155@kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
01c52d31 12156@findex gnus-mailing-list-archive
4009494e
GM
12157Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
12158
12159@end table
12160
12161
12162@node Article Buffer
12163@chapter Article Buffer
12164@cindex article buffer
12165
12166The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
12167one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
12168tell Gnus otherwise.
12169
12170@menu
12171* Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
12172* Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
12173* Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
12174* Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
12175* Misc Article:: Other stuff.
12176@end menu
12177
12178
12179@node Hiding Headers
12180@section Hiding Headers
12181@cindex hiding headers
12182@cindex deleting headers
12183
12184The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
12185@dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
12186
12187@vindex gnus-show-all-headers
12188There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
12189who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
12190article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
12191most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
12192through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
12193@code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
12194of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
12195article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
12196
12197Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
12198
12199@table @code
12200
12201@item gnus-visible-headers
12202@vindex gnus-visible-headers
12203If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
12204that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
12205headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
12206
12207For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
12208the article and the subject, you'd say:
12209
12210@lisp
12211(setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
12212@end lisp
12213
12214This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
12215remain visible.
12216
12217@item gnus-ignored-headers
12218@vindex gnus-ignored-headers
12219This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
12220variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
12221should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
12222hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
12223
12224For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
12225and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
12226
12227@lisp
12228(setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
12229@end lisp
12230
12231This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
12232be removed.
12233
12234Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
12235variable will have no effect.
12236
12237@end table
12238
12239@vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
12240Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
12241can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
12242variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
12243the headers are to be displayed.
12244
12245For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
12246and then the subject, you might say something like:
12247
12248@lisp
12249(setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
12250@end lisp
12251
12252Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
12253variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
12254
12255@findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
12256@vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
12257You can hide further boring headers by setting
12258@code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
12259does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
12260list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
12261lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
12262from sight.
12263
12264These conditions are:
12265@table @code
12266@item empty
12267Remove all empty headers.
12268@item followup-to
12269Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
12270@code{Newsgroups} header.
12271@item reply-to
12272Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
12273the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
12274parameter is set.
12275@item newsgroups
12276Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
12277name.
12278@item to-address
12279Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
12280the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
12281@item to-list
12282Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
12283the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
12284@item cc-list
12285Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
12286the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
12287@item date
12288Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
12289old.
12290@item long-to
12291Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
12292@item many-to
12293Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
12294@end table
12295
12296To include these three elements, you could say something like:
12297
12298@lisp
12299(setq gnus-boring-article-headers
12300 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
12301@end lisp
12302
12303This is also the default value for this variable.
12304
12305
12306@node Using MIME
12307@section Using MIME
12308@cindex @acronym{MIME}
12309
12310Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
12311while people stand around yawning.
12312
12313@acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
12314while all newsreaders die of fear.
12315
12316@acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
12317of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
12318other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
12319
12320@vindex gnus-display-mime-function
12321@findex gnus-display-mime
12322Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
12323to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
12324default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
12325display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
12326
12327The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
12328@acronym{MIME} button:
12329
12330@table @kbd
12331@findex gnus-article-press-button
12332@item RET (Article)
12333@kindex RET (Article)
12334@itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
12335Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
12336(@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
12337the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
12338files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
12339object is displayed inline.
12340
12341@findex gnus-mime-view-part
12342@item M-RET (Article)
12343@kindex M-RET (Article)
12344@itemx v (Article)
12345Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
12346method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
12347
12348@findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
12349@item t (Article)
12350@kindex t (Article)
12351View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
12352(@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
12353
12354@findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
12355@item C (Article)
12356@kindex C (Article)
12357Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
12358charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
12359
12360@findex gnus-mime-save-part
12361@item o (Article)
12362@kindex o (Article)
12363Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
12364(@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
12365
12366@findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
12367@item C-o (Article)
12368@kindex C-o (Article)
12369Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
12370the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
12371suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
12372like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
12373message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
12374(@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
12375
01c52d31
MB
12376@findex gnus-mime-replace-part
12377@item r (Article)
12378@kindex r (Article)
12379Prompt for a file name, replace the @acronym{MIME} object with an
12380external body refering to the file via the message/external-body
12381@acronym{MIME} type. (@code{gnus-mime-replace-part}).
12382
4009494e
GM
12383@findex gnus-mime-delete-part
12384@item d (Article)
12385@kindex d (Article)
12386Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
12387information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
12388(@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
12389
01c52d31
MB
12390@c FIXME: gnus-auto-select-part should be documented here
12391
4009494e
GM
12392@findex gnus-mime-copy-part
12393@item c (Article)
12394@kindex c (Article)
12395Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
01c52d31
MB
12396(@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). If given a prefix, copy the raw contents
12397without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual
12398charset stuff (see @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in
12399@ref{Paging the Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
4009494e
GM
12400@file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
12401@code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
12402Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
12403
12404@findex gnus-mime-print-part
12405@item p (Article)
12406@kindex p (Article)
12407Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
12408command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
12409@file{.mailcap} file.
12410
12411@findex gnus-mime-inline-part
12412@item i (Article)
12413@kindex i (Article)
12414Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
9b3ebcb6 12415(@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as @samp{text/plain}. If given a prefix, insert
4009494e
GM
12416the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
12417do semi-manual charset stuff (see
12418@code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
01c52d31
MB
12419Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and @file{.bz2} are
12420automatically decompressed depending on @code{jka-compr} regardless of
12421@code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed Files,, Accessing
12422Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
4009494e
GM
12423
12424@findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
12425@item E (Article)
12426@kindex E (Article)
12427View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
12428viewer is available, use an external viewer
12429(@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
12430
12431@findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
12432@item e (Article)
12433@kindex e (Article)
12434View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
12435(@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
12436
12437@findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
12438@item | (Article)
12439@kindex | (Article)
12440Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
12441
12442@findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
12443@item . (Article)
12444@kindex . (Article)
12445Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
12446(@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
12447
12448@end table
12449
12450Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
12451determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
12452@acronym{MIME} manual.
12453
12454It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
12455buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
12456group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
12457decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
12458comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
12459because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
12460try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
12461to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
12462to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
12463
12464Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
12465
12466Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
12467
12468
12469@node Customizing Articles
12470@section Customizing Articles
12471@cindex article customization
12472
12473A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
12474exist. You can call these functions interactively
12475(@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
12476called automatically when you select the articles.
12477
12478To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
12479``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
12480@code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
12481be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
12482
12483Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
12484for sensible values.
12485
12486@enumerate
12487@item
12488@code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
12489
12490@item
12491@code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
12492
12493@item
12494@code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
12495
12496@item
01c52d31
MB
12497@code{first}: Do this treatment on the first body part.
12498
12499@item
12500@code{last}: Do this treatment on the last body part.
4009494e
GM
12501
12502@item
12503An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
12504than this number.
12505
12506@item
12507A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
12508articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
12509regexps in the list.
12510
12511@item
12512A list where the first element is not a string:
12513
12514The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
12515predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
12516@code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
12517
12518@lisp
12519(or last
12520 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
12521@end lisp
12522
12523@end enumerate
12524
12525You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
12526to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
12527be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
12528considered to contain just a single part.
12529
12530@vindex gnus-article-treat-types
12531Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
12532want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
12533treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
12534variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
12535type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
12536controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
12537
12538@ifinfo
12539@c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
12540@c manual, but add them in info to allow `i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
12541@c `i foo-bar'.
12542@vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
12543@vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
12544@vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
12545@vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
12546@vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
12547@vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
12548@vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
12549@vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
12550@vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
12551@vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
12552@vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
12553@vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
12554@vindex gnus-treat-date-english
12555@vindex gnus-treat-date-iso8601
12556@vindex gnus-treat-date-lapsed
12557@vindex gnus-treat-date-local
12558@vindex gnus-treat-date-original
12559@vindex gnus-treat-date-user-defined
12560@vindex gnus-treat-date-ut
12561@vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
12562@vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
12563@vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
12564@vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
12565@vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
12566@vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
12567@vindex gnus-treat-display-face
12568@vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
12569@vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
12570@vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
12571@vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
12572@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
12573@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
12574@vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
12575@vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
12576@vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
12577@vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
12578@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
12579@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
12580@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
12581@vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
12582@vindex gnus-treat-translate
12583@vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
12584@vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
12585@vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
12586@vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
12587@vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
12588@end ifinfo
12589
12590The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
12591customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
12592group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
12593possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
12594
12595@table @code
12596@item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
12597@item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
12598
12599@xref{Article Buttons}.
12600
12601@item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
12602@item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
12603@item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
12604@item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
01c52d31 12605@item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, first, integer)
4009494e
GM
12606@item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
12607@item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
12608@item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
12609@item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
12610@item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
12611
12612@xref{Article Washing}.
12613
12614@item gnus-treat-date-english (head)
12615@item gnus-treat-date-iso8601 (head)
12616@item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
12617@item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
12618@item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
12619@item gnus-treat-date-user-defined (head)
12620@item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
12621
12622@xref{Article Date}.
12623
12624@item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
12625@item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
12626@item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
12627
12628@xref{Picons}.
12629
12630@item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
12631
12632@item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
12633
12634@vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
12635Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
12636is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
12637
12638@xref{Smileys}.
12639
12640@vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
12641@item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
12642
12643@xref{X-Face}.
12644
12645@vindex gnus-treat-display-face
12646@item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
12647
12648@xref{Face}.
12649
12650@vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
12651@item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
12652@vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
12653@item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
12654@vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
12655@item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
12656@vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
12657@item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
12658@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
12659@item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
12660@vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
12661@item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
12662@vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
12663@item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
12664@vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
12665@item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
12666@vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
12667@item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
12668@vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
12669@item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
12670
12671@xref{Article Hiding}.
12672
12673@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
12674@item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
12675@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
12676@item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
12677@vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
12678@item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
12679
12680@xref{Article Highlighting}.
12681
12682@vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
12683@item gnus-treat-play-sounds
12684@vindex gnus-treat-translate
12685@item gnus-treat-translate
01c52d31 12686@item gnus-treat-ansi-sequences (t)
4009494e
GM
12687@vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
12688@item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
12689
12690@vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
12691@item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
12692@vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
12693@item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
12694@vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
12695@item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
12696@vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
12697@item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
12698
12699@xref{Article Header}.
12700
12701
12702@end table
12703
12704@vindex gnus-part-display-hook
12705You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
12706@code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
12707part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
12708information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
12709everything.
12710
12711
12712@node Article Keymap
12713@section Article Keymap
12714
12715Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
12716article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
12717buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
12718buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
12719buffer.
12720
12721@kindex v (Article)
12722@cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
12723The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
12724command or better use it as a prefix key.
12725
12726A few additional keystrokes are available:
12727
12728@table @kbd
12729
12730@item SPACE
12731@kindex SPACE (Article)
12732@findex gnus-article-next-page
12733Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
12734This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
12735
12736@item DEL
12737@kindex DEL (Article)
12738@findex gnus-article-prev-page
12739Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
12740This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
12741
12742@item C-c ^
12743@kindex C-c ^ (Article)
12744@findex gnus-article-refer-article
12745If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
12746@kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
12747(@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
12748
12749@item C-c C-m
12750@kindex C-c C-m (Article)
12751@findex gnus-article-mail
12752Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
12753given a prefix, include the mail.
12754
12755@item s
12756@kindex s (Article)
12757@findex gnus-article-show-summary
12758Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
12759(@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
12760
12761@item ?
12762@kindex ? (Article)
12763@findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
12764Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
12765(@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
12766
12767@item TAB
12768@kindex TAB (Article)
12769@findex gnus-article-next-button
12770Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
12771only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
12772
12773@item M-TAB
12774@kindex M-TAB (Article)
12775@findex gnus-article-prev-button
12776Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
12777
12778@item R
12779@kindex R (Article)
12780@findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
12781Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
95838435
MB
12782(@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If the region is active,
12783only yank the text in the region.
12784
12785@item S W
12786@kindex S W (Article)
12787@findex gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original
12788Send a wide reply to the current article and yank the current article
12789(@code{gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original}). If the region is
12790active, only yank the text in the region.
4009494e
GM
12791
12792@item F
12793@kindex F (Article)
12794@findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
12795Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
95838435
MB
12796(@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If the region is active,
12797only yank the text in the region.
4009494e
GM
12798
12799
12800@end table
12801
12802
12803@node Misc Article
12804@section Misc Article
12805
12806@table @code
12807
12808@item gnus-single-article-buffer
12809@vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
12810@cindex article buffers, several
12811If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
12812(This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
12813article buffer.
12814
12815@vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
12816@item gnus-article-decode-hook
12817@cindex @acronym{MIME}
12818Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
12819@code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
12820
12821@vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
12822@item gnus-article-prepare-hook
12823This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
12824article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
12825depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
12826the contents of the article buffer.
12827
12828@item gnus-article-mode-hook
12829@vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
12830Hook called in article mode buffers.
12831
12832@item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12833@vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12834Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
12835@code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
12836
12837@vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
12838@item gnus-article-over-scroll
12839If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
12840no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
12841
12842@vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
12843@item gnus-article-mode-line-format
12844This variable is a format string along the same lines as
12845@code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
12846Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
12847with two extensions:
12848
12849@table @samp
12850
12851@item w
12852The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
12853character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
12854performed. The characters and their meaning:
12855
12856@table @samp
12857
12858@item c
12859Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
12860
12861@item h
12862Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
12863
12864@item p
12865Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
12866hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
12867security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
12868
12869@item s
12870Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
12871
12872@item o
12873Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
12874
12875@item e
6772c8e1 12876Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasized strings in the article buffer.
4009494e
GM
12877
12878@end table
12879
12880@item m
12881The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
12882
12883@end table
12884
12885@vindex gnus-break-pages
12886
12887@item gnus-break-pages
12888Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
12889is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
12890page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
12891paging will not be done.
12892
12893@item gnus-page-delimiter
12894@vindex gnus-page-delimiter
12895This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
12896(formfeed).
12897
12898@cindex IDNA
12899@cindex internationalized domain names
12900@vindex gnus-use-idna
12901@item gnus-use-idna
12902This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
12903internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
01c52d31
MB
12904@samp{Cc} headers. @xref{IDNA, ,IDNA,message, The Message Manual},
12905for how to compose such messages. This requires
4009494e
GM
12906@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
12907variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
12908
12909@end table
12910
12911
12912@node Composing Messages
12913@chapter Composing Messages
12914@cindex composing messages
12915@cindex messages
12916@cindex mail
12917@cindex sending mail
12918@cindex reply
12919@cindex followup
12920@cindex post
12921@cindex using gpg
12922@cindex using s/mime
12923@cindex using smime
12924
12925@kindex C-c C-c (Post)
12926All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
12927where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
12928article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
12929Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
12930on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
12931
12932@menu
12933* Mail:: Mailing and replying.
12934* Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
12935* POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
12936* Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
12937* Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
12938* Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
12939* Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
12940* Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
12941* Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
12942@end menu
12943
12944Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
12945remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
12946
12947
12948@node Mail
12949@section Mail
12950
12951Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
12952
12953@table @code
12954@item gnus-uu-digest-headers
12955@vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
12956List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
12957headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
12958@code{nil} include all headers.
12959
12960@item gnus-add-to-list
12961@vindex gnus-add-to-list
12962If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
12963that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
12964
12965@item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12966@vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12967If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
12968about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
12969interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
12970receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
12971non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
12972matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
12973
12974If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
12975press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
12976
12977@item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12978@vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12979If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
12980@code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
12981useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
12982
12983@end table
12984
12985
12986@node Posting Server
12987@section Posting Server
12988
12989When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
12990(extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
12991
12992Thank you for asking. I hate you.
12993
12994It can be quite complicated.
12995
12996@vindex gnus-post-method
12997When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
12998(@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
12999Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
13000reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
13001groups from different private servers). However. If the server
13002you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
13003want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
13004fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
13005@code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
13006
13007@lisp
13008(setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
13009@end lisp
13010
13011Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
13012this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
13013can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
13014the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
13015
13016If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
13017Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
13018
13019You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
13020If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
13021for posting.
13022
13023Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
13024you can set this variable to @code{native}.
13025
d82cf70b
MB
13026@vindex message-send-mail-function
13027When sending mail, Message invokes the function specified by the
13028variable @code{message-send-mail-function}. Gnus tries to set it to a
13029value suitable for your system.
13030@xref{Mail Variables, ,Mail Variables,message,Message manual}, for more
13031information.
4009494e
GM
13032
13033@node POP before SMTP
13034@section POP before SMTP
13035@cindex pop before smtp
13036@findex message-smtpmail-send-it
13037@findex mail-source-touch-pop
13038
13039Does your @acronym{ISP} require the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
13040authentication? It is whether you need to connect to the @acronym{POP}
13041mail server within a certain time before sending mails. If so, there is
13042a convenient way. To do that, put the following lines in your
13043@file{~/.gnus.el} file:
13044
13045@lisp
13046(setq message-send-mail-function 'message-smtpmail-send-it)
13047(add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
13048@end lisp
13049
13050@noindent
13051It means to let Gnus connect to the @acronym{POP} mail server in advance
13052whenever you send a mail. The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function
13053does only a @acronym{POP} authentication according to the value of
13054@code{mail-sources} without fetching mails, just before sending a mail.
13055Note that you have to use @code{message-smtpmail-send-it} which runs
13056@code{message-send-mail-hook} rather than @code{smtpmail-send-it} and
13057set the value of @code{mail-sources} for a @acronym{POP} connection
13058correctly. @xref{Mail Sources}.
13059
13060If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
13061@code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
13062@code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
13063used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
13064is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
13065mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
13066
13067@lisp
13068(setq mail-source-primary-source
13069 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13070 :password "secret"))
13071@end lisp
13072
13073@noindent
13074Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
13075@acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
13076
13077@lisp
13078(add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
13079 (lambda ()
13080 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
13081 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
13082 :password "secret")))
13083 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
13084@end lisp
13085
13086@node Mail and Post
13087@section Mail and Post
13088
13089Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
13090posting:
13091
13092@table @code
13093@item gnus-mailing-list-groups
13094@findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
13095@cindex mailing lists
13096
13097If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
13098gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
13099problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
13100One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
13101(@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
13102@code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
13103really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
13104lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
13105still a pain, though.
13106
13107@item gnus-user-agent
13108@vindex gnus-user-agent
13109@cindex User-Agent
13110
13111This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
13112User-Agent header. It can be a list of symbols or a string. Valid
13113symbols are @code{gnus} (show Gnus version) and @code{emacs} (show Emacs
13114version). In addition to the Emacs version, you can add @code{codename}
13115(show (S)XEmacs codename) or either @code{config} (show system
13116configuration) or @code{type} (show system type). If you set it to a
13117string, be sure to use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
13118
13119@end table
13120
13121You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
13122you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
13123spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
13124
13125@cindex ispell
13126@findex ispell-message
13127@lisp
13128(add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
13129@end lisp
13130
13131If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
13132you're in, you could say something like the following:
13133
13134@lisp
13135(add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
13136 (lambda ()
13137 (cond
13138 ((string-match
13139 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
13140 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
13141 (t
13142 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
13143@end lisp
13144
13145Modify to suit your needs.
13146
01c52d31
MB
13147@vindex gnus-message-highlight-citation
13148If @code{gnus-message-highlight-citation} is t, different levels of
13149citations are highlighted like in Gnus article buffers also in message
13150mode buffers.
4009494e
GM
13151
13152@node Archived Messages
13153@section Archived Messages
13154@cindex archived messages
13155@cindex sent messages
13156
13157Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
13158send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
13159store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
13160@code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
13161is the default.
13162
13163For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
13164@kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
13165Group Commands}).
13166
13167@vindex gnus-message-archive-method
13168@code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
01c52d31
MB
13169use to store sent messages. The default is @code{"archive"}, and when
13170actually being used it is expanded into:
4009494e
GM
13171
13172@lisp
13173(nnfolder "archive"
13174 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
13175 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
13176 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
13177 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
13178@end lisp
13179
01c52d31
MB
13180@quotation
13181@vindex gnus-update-message-archive-method
13182Note: a server like this is saved in the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file first
13183so that it may be used as a real method of the server which is named
13184@code{"archive"} (that is, for the case where
13185@code{gnus-message-archive-method} is set to @code{"archive"}) ever
13186since. If it once has been saved, it will never be updated by default
13187even if you change the value of @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
13188afterward. Therefore, the server @code{"archive"} doesn't necessarily
13189mean the @code{nnfolder} server like this at all times. If you want the
13190saved method to reflect always the value of
13191@code{gnus-message-archive-method}, set the
13192@code{gnus-update-message-archive-method} variable to a non-@code{nil}
13193value. The default value of this variable is @code{nil}.
13194@end quotation
13195
4009494e
GM
13196You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
13197@code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
13198for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
13199directory chosen, you could say something like:
13200
13201@lisp
13202(setq gnus-message-archive-method
13203 '(nnfolder "archive"
13204 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
13205 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
13206 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
13207@end lisp
13208
13209@vindex gnus-message-archive-group
13210@cindex Gcc
13211Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
13212to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
13213determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
13214
13215This variable can be used to do the following:
13216
13217@table @asis
13218@item a string
13219Messages will be saved in that group.
13220
13221Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
13222message will not be stored in the select method given by
13223@code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
13224by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
13225has the default value shown above. Then setting
13226@code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
13227messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
13228value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
13229@samp{nnml:foo}.
13230
13231@item a list of strings
13232Messages will be saved in all those groups.
13233
13234@item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
13235When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
13236
13237@item @code{nil}
13238No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
13239@end table
13240
13241Let's illustrate:
13242
13243Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
13244@lisp
13245(setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
13246@end lisp
13247
13248Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
13249@lisp
13250(setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
13251@end lisp
13252
13253Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
13254@lisp
13255(setq gnus-message-archive-group
13256 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
13257 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
13258 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
13259@end lisp
13260
13261More complex stuff:
13262@lisp
13263(setq gnus-message-archive-group
13264 '((if (message-news-p)
13265 "misc-news"
13266 "misc-mail")))
13267@end lisp
13268
13269How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
13270messages in one file per month:
13271
13272@lisp
13273(setq gnus-message-archive-group
13274 '((if (message-news-p)
13275 "misc-news"
13276 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
13277@end lisp
13278
13279@c (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
13280@c use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
13281
13282Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
13283group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
13284you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
13285archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
13286Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
13287enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
13288group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
13289if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
13290nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
13291continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
13292
13293That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
13294different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
13295case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
13296this will disable archiving.
13297
13298@table @code
13299@item gnus-outgoing-message-group
13300@vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
13301All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
13302all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
13303you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
13304group names.
13305
13306If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
13307message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
13308current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
13309of names).
13310
13311This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
13312but the latter is the preferred method.
13313
13314@item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
13315@vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
13316If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
13317
13318@item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
13319@vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
13320If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
13321and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
13322@code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
13323non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
13324changed in the future.
13325
13326@end table
13327
13328
13329@node Posting Styles
13330@section Posting Styles
13331@cindex posting styles
13332@cindex styles
13333
13334All them variables, they make my head swim.
13335
13336So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
13337on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
13338and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
13339on?
13340
13341@vindex gnus-posting-styles
13342One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
13343variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
13344came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
13345a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
13346variable:
13347
13348@lisp
13349((".*"
13350 (signature "Peace and happiness")
13351 (organization "What me?"))
13352 ("^comp"
13353 (signature "Death to everybody"))
13354 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
13355 (organization "Emacs is it")))
13356@end lisp
13357
13358As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
13359@dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
13360``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
13361over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
13362applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
13363the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
13364@samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
13365signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
13366
13367The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
13368string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
13369If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
13370will look in the original article for a header whose name is
13371@var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
13372@var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
13373replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
13374followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
13375@code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
13376no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
13377referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
13378any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
13379said to @dfn{match}.
13380
13381Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
13382attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
13383addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
13384form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
13385@code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
13386contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
13387@var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
13388name can be one of:
13389
13390@itemize @bullet
13391@item @code{signature}
13392@item @code{signature-file}
13393@item @code{x-face-file}
13394@item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
13395@item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
13396@item @code{body}
13397@end itemize
13398
01c52d31
MB
13399Note that the @code{signature-file} attribute honors the variable
13400@code{message-signature-directory}.
13401
4009494e
GM
13402The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
13403this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
13404the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
13405name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
13406is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
13407
13408The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
13409zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
13410will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
13411will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
13412message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
13413are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable, which
13414is a vector of the following headers: number subject from date id
13415references chars lines xref extra.
13416
13417@vindex message-reply-headers
13418
13419If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
13420meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
13421of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
13422
13423@findex message-mail-p
13424@findex message-news-p
13425
13426So here's a new example:
13427
13428@lisp
13429(setq gnus-posting-styles
13430 '((".*"
13431 (signature-file "~/.signature")
13432 (name "User Name")
13433 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
13434 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
13435 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
13436 ("^rec.humor"
13437 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
13438 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
13439 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
13440 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
13441 (signature my-news-signature))
13442 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
13443 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
13444 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
13445 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
13446 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
13447 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
13448 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
13449 (address "user@@bar.foo")
13450 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
13451 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
13452 ("nnml:.*"
c57008f6 13453 (From (with-current-buffer gnus-article-buffer
4009494e
GM
13454 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
13455 ("^nn.+:"
13456 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
13457@end lisp
13458
13459The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
13460@code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
13461if you fill many roles.
13462You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
13463@xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
13464
13465@node Drafts
13466@section Drafts
13467@cindex drafts
13468
13469If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
13470you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
13471craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
13472the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
13473other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
13474
13475Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
13476some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
13477automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
13478If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
13479article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
13480group.)
13481
13482@cindex nndraft
13483@vindex nndraft-directory
13484The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
13485@code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
13486@samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
13487@code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
13488that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
13489read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
13490
13491If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
13492to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
13493unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
13494a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
13495behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
13496be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
13497simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
13498Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
13499correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
13500
13501@c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
13502@c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
13503@c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
13504@c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
13505@c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
13506@c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
13507@c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
13508@c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
13509@c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
13510@c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
13511@c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
13512@c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
13513@c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
13514@c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
13515@c
13516@c @vindex gnus-use-draft
13517@c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
13518@c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
13519
13520@findex gnus-draft-edit-message
13521@kindex D e (Draft)
13522When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
13523draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
13524that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
13525
13526Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
13527Articles}).
13528
13529@findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
13530@kindex D s (Draft)
13531@findex gnus-draft-send-message
13532@kindex D S (Draft)
13533If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
13534doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
13535(@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
13536process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
13537command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
13538in the buffer.
13539
13540@findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
13541@kindex D t (Draft)
13542If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
13543@kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
13544as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
13545
13546
13547@node Rejected Articles
13548@section Rejected Articles
13549@cindex rejected articles
13550
13551Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
13552doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
13553@emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
13554Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
13555
13556These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
13557(Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
13558fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
13559you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
13560articles until some later time when the server feels better.
13561
13562The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
13563(@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
13564typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
13565
13566@node Signing and encrypting
13567@section Signing and encrypting
13568@cindex using gpg
13569@cindex using s/mime
13570@cindex using smime
13571
13572Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
13573@acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
13574decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
13575@code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
13576
13577@vindex gnus-message-replysign
13578@vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
13579@vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
13580Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
13581messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
13582are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
13583@code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
13584@code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
13585@code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
13586automatically encrypted messages.
13587
13588Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
13589@acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
13590signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
13591
13592@table @kbd
13593
13594@item C-c C-m s s
13595@kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
13596@findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
13597
13598Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
13599
13600@item C-c C-m s o
13601@kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
13602@findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
13603
13604Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
13605
13606@item C-c C-m s p
13607@kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
13608@findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
13609
13610Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
13611
13612@item C-c C-m c s
13613@kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
13614@findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
13615
13616Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
13617
13618@item C-c C-m c o
13619@kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
13620@findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
13621
13622Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
13623
13624@item C-c C-m c p
13625@kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
13626@findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
13627
13628Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
13629
13630@item C-c C-m C-n
13631@kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
13632@findex mml-unsecure-message
13633Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
13634
13635@end table
13636
13637@xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
13638
13639@node Select Methods
13640@chapter Select Methods
13641@cindex foreign groups
13642@cindex select methods
13643
13644A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
13645default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
13646@acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
13647personal mail group.
13648
13649A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
13650a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
13651list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
13652@code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
13653name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
13654value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
13655
13656One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
13657we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
13658
13659The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
13660group as.
13661
13662For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
13663@samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
13664method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
13665@samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
13666back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
13667
13668The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
13669
13670@menu
13671* Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
13672* Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
13673* Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
13674* Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
13675* IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
13676* Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
13677* Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
13678* Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
13679* Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
13680@end menu
13681
13682
13683@node Server Buffer
13684@section Server Buffer
13685
13686Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
13687one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
13688connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
13689one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
13690the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
13691back end represents a virtual server.
13692
13693For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
13694different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
13695on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
13696use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
13697
13698These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
13699complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
13700@acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
13701hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
13702Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
13703server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
13704select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
13705
13706To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
13707(@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
13708
13709@menu
13710* Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
13711* Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
13712* Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
13713* Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
13714* Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
13715* Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
13716* Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
13717@end menu
13718
13719@vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
13720@code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
13721
13722
13723@node Server Buffer Format
13724@subsection Server Buffer Format
13725@cindex server buffer format
13726
13727@vindex gnus-server-line-format
13728You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
13729@code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
13730variable, with some simple extensions:
13731
13732@table @samp
13733
13734@item h
13735How the news is fetched---the back end name.
13736
13737@item n
13738The name of this server.
13739
13740@item w
13741Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
13742
13743@item s
13744The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
13745
13746@item a
13747Whether this server is agentized.
13748@end table
13749
13750@vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
13751The mode line can also be customized by using the
13752@code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
13753Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
13754
13755@table @samp
13756@item S
13757Server name.
13758
13759@item M
13760Server method.
13761@end table
13762
13763Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
13764
13765
13766@node Server Commands
13767@subsection Server Commands
13768@cindex server commands
13769
13770@table @kbd
13771
13772@item v
13773@kindex v (Server)
13774@cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
13775The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
13776command or better use it as a prefix key.
13777
13778@item a
13779@kindex a (Server)
13780@findex gnus-server-add-server
13781Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
13782
13783@item e
13784@kindex e (Server)
13785@findex gnus-server-edit-server
13786Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
13787
13788@item SPACE
13789@kindex SPACE (Server)
13790@findex gnus-server-read-server
13791Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
13792
13793@item q
13794@kindex q (Server)
13795@findex gnus-server-exit
13796Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
13797
13798@item k
13799@kindex k (Server)
13800@findex gnus-server-kill-server
13801Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
13802
13803@item y
13804@kindex y (Server)
13805@findex gnus-server-yank-server
13806Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
13807
13808@item c
13809@kindex c (Server)
13810@findex gnus-server-copy-server
13811Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
13812
13813@item l
13814@kindex l (Server)
13815@findex gnus-server-list-servers
13816List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
13817
13818@item s
13819@kindex s (Server)
13820@findex gnus-server-scan-server
13821Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
13822(@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
13823servers.
13824
13825@item g
13826@kindex g (Server)
13827@findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
13828Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
13829(@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
13830a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
13831
01c52d31
MB
13832@item z
13833@kindex z (Server)
13834@findex gnus-server-compact-server
13835
13836Compact all groups in the server under point
13837(@code{gnus-server-compact-server}). Currently implemented only in
13838nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes gaps between article numbers,
13839hence getting a correct total article count.
13840
4009494e
GM
13841@end table
13842
13843
13844@node Example Methods
13845@subsection Example Methods
13846
13847Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
13848
13849@lisp
13850(nntp "news.funet.fi")
13851@end lisp
13852
13853Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
13854
13855@lisp
13856(nnspool "")
13857@end lisp
13858
13859As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
13860back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
13861will.
13862
13863After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
13864@code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
13865
13866To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
13867port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
13868look like then:
13869
13870@lisp
13871(nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
13872@end lisp
13873
13874You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
13875variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
13876
13877@code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
13878you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
13879mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
13880your private mail:
13881
13882@lisp
13883(nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
13884@end lisp
13885
13886(This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
13887that.)
13888
13889Here's the method for a public spool:
13890
13891@lisp
13892(nnmh "public"
13893 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
13894 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
13895@end lisp
13896
13897@cindex proxy
13898@cindex firewall
13899
13900If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
13901server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
31fe2b00
SM
13902on the firewall machine and connect with
13903@uref{http://netcat.sourceforge.net/, netcat} from there to the
13904@acronym{NNTP} server.
4009494e
GM
13905Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
13906should probably look something like this:
13907
13908@lisp
13909(nntp "firewall"
31fe2b00 13910 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)
4009494e 13911 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
31fe2b00 13912 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host"))
4009494e
GM
13913@end lisp
13914
13915If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
13916compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
13917configuration to the example above:
13918
13919@lisp
13920 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13921@end lisp
13922
01c52d31
MB
13923See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}. Here's an example for
13924an indirect connection:
fbcbb58c 13925
01c52d31
MB
13926@lisp
13927(setq gnus-select-method
13928 '(nntp "indirect"
13929 (nntp-address "news.server.example")
13930 (nntp-via-user-name "intermediate_user_name")
13931 (nntp-via-address "intermediate.host.example")
13932 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
31fe2b00
SM
13933 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches ("-C"))
13934 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)))
01c52d31 13935@end lisp
4009494e 13936
fbcbb58c
KY
13937This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
13938provide automatic authorization, of course.
13939
4009494e
GM
13940If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
13941through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
31fe2b00 13942netcat connection to the news server as follows:
4009494e
GM
13943
13944@lisp
13945(nntp "outside"
13946 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
990e2c2f 13947 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
31fe2b00 13948 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
4009494e
GM
13949@end lisp
13950
4009494e
GM
13951
13952@node Creating a Virtual Server
13953@subsection Creating a Virtual Server
13954
13955If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
13956articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
13957
13958First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
13959would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
13960could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
13961
13962Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
13963
13964You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
13965@samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
13966Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
13967will contain the following:
13968
13969@lisp
13970(nnml "cache")
13971@end lisp
13972
13973Change that to:
13974
13975@lisp
13976(nnml "cache"
13977 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
13978 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
13979@end lisp
13980
13981Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
13982@kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
13983buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
13984
13985
13986@node Server Variables
13987@subsection Server Variables
13988@cindex server variables
13989@cindex server parameters
13990
13991One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
13992in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
13993variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
13994change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
13995won't change the ``derived'' variables.
13996
13997This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
13998@code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
13999directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
14000@code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
14001new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
14002@code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
14003variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
14004variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
14005manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
14006
14007@lisp
14008(nnml "public"
14009 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
14010 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
14011 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
14012@end lisp
14013
14014Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
14015
14016@node Servers and Methods
14017@subsection Servers and Methods
14018
14019Wherever you would normally use a select method
14020(e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
14021when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
14022instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
14023over.
14024
14025
14026@node Unavailable Servers
14027@subsection Unavailable Servers
14028
14029If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
14030@code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
14031with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
14032will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
14033actually the case or not.
14034
14035That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
14036Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
14037@samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
14038away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
14039to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
14040attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
14041attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
14042it will regard that server as ``down''.
14043
14044So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
14045How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
14046
14047You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
14048with the following commands:
14049
14050@table @kbd
14051
14052@item O
14053@kindex O (Server)
14054@findex gnus-server-open-server
14055Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
14056(@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
14057
14058@item C
14059@kindex C (Server)
14060@findex gnus-server-close-server
14061Close the connection (if any) to the server
14062(@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
14063
14064@item D
14065@kindex D (Server)
14066@findex gnus-server-deny-server
14067Mark the current server as unreachable
14068(@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
14069
14070@item M-o
14071@kindex M-o (Server)
14072@findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
14073Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
14074(@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
14075
14076@item M-c
14077@kindex M-c (Server)
14078@findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
14079Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
14080(@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
14081
14082@item R
14083@kindex R (Server)
14084@findex gnus-server-remove-denials
14085Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
14086(@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
14087
14088@item L
14089@kindex L (Server)
14090@findex gnus-server-offline-server
14091Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
14092
14093@end table
14094
14095
14096@node Getting News
14097@section Getting News
14098@cindex reading news
14099@cindex news back ends
14100
14101A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
14102only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
14103or it can read from a local spool.
14104
14105@menu
14106* NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
14107* News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
14108@end menu
14109
14110
14111@node NNTP
14112@subsection NNTP
14113@cindex nntp
14114
14115Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
14116You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
14117server as the, uhm, address.
14118
14119If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
14120third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
14121to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
14122that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
14123
14124The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
14125fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
14126you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
14127
14128The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
14129server:
14130
14131@table @code
14132
14133@item nntp-server-opened-hook
14134@vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
14135@cindex @sc{mode reader}
14136@cindex authinfo
14137@cindex authentication
14138@cindex nntp authentication
14139@findex nntp-send-authinfo
14140@findex nntp-send-mode-reader
14141is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
14142commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
14143default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
14144@code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
14145present in this hook.
14146
14147@item nntp-authinfo-function
14148@vindex nntp-authinfo-function
14149@findex nntp-send-authinfo
14150@vindex nntp-authinfo-file
14151This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
14152server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
14153through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
14154@code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
14155are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
14156format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
14157@code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
14158manual page, but here are the salient facts:
14159
14160@enumerate
14161@item
14162The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
14163
14164@item
14165Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
14166
14167The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
14168@samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
14169in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
14170@samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
14171deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
14172indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
14173@samp{force} is explained below.
14174
14175@end enumerate
14176
14177Here's an example file:
14178
14179@example
14180machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
14181machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
14182@end example
14183
14184The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
14185have to be first, for instance.
14186
14187In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
14188former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
14189user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
14190@samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
14191@var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
14192@samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
14193until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
14194
14195You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
14196that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
14197
14198@example
14199default force yes
14200@end example
14201
14202This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
14203previously mentioned.
14204
14205Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
14206
14207@item nntp-server-action-alist
14208@vindex nntp-server-action-alist
14209This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
14210taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
14211every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
14212
14213@lisp
14214(setq nntp-server-action-alist
14215 '(("innd" (ding))))
14216@end lisp
14217
14218You probably don't want to do that, though.
14219
14220The default value is
14221
14222@lisp
14223'(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
14224 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
14225 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
14226@end lisp
14227
14228This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
14229nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
14230
14231@item nntp-maximum-request
14232@vindex nntp-maximum-request
14233If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
14234will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
14235speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
14236waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
14237by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
14238your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
14239
14240@item nntp-connection-timeout
14241@vindex nntp-connection-timeout
14242If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
14243regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
14244responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
14245time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
14246somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
14247that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
14248connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
14249no timeouts are done.
14250
14251@item nntp-nov-is-evil
14252@vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
14253If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
14254variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
14255can be used.
14256
14257@item nntp-xover-commands
14258@vindex nntp-xover-commands
14259@cindex @acronym{NOV}
14260@cindex XOVER
14261List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
14262server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
14263"XOVERVIEW")}.
14264
14265@item nntp-nov-gap
14266@vindex nntp-nov-gap
14267@code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
14268the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
14269if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
14270article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
14271lines that you will not need. This variable says how
14272big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
14273@code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
14274network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
14275that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
14276@code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
14277
14278@item nntp-xref-number-is-evil
14279@vindex nntp-xref-number-is-evil
14280When Gnus refers to an article having the @code{Message-ID} that a user
14281specifies or having the @code{Message-ID} of the parent article of the
14282current one (@pxref{Finding the Parent}), Gnus sends a @code{HEAD}
14283command to the @acronym{NNTP} server to know where it is, and the server
14284returns the data containing the pairs of a group and an article number
14285in the @code{Xref} header. Gnus normally uses the article number to
14286refer to the article if the data shows that that article is in the
14287current group, while it uses the @code{Message-ID} otherwise. However,
14288some news servers, e.g., ones running Diablo, run multiple engines
14289having the same articles but article numbers are not kept synchronized
14290between them. In that case, the article number that appears in the
14291@code{Xref} header varies by which engine is chosen, so you cannot refer
14292to the parent article that is in the current group, for instance. If
14293you connect to such a server, set this variable to a non-@code{nil}
14294value, and Gnus never uses article numbers. For example:
14295
14296@lisp
14297(setq gnus-select-method
14298 '(nntp "newszilla"
14299 (nntp-address "newszilla.example.com")
14300 (nntp-xref-number-is-evil t)
14301 @dots{}))
14302@end lisp
14303
14304The default value of this server variable is @code{nil}.
14305
14306@item nntp-prepare-server-hook
14307@vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
14308A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
14309
14310@item nntp-record-commands
14311@vindex nntp-record-commands
14312If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
14313@acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
14314buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
14315that doesn't seem to work.
14316
14317@item nntp-open-connection-function
14318@vindex nntp-open-connection-function
14319It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
14320be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
14321parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
01c52d31
MB
14322Seven pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped
14323in two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
14324indirect ones (three pre-made).
4009494e
GM
14325
14326@item nntp-never-echoes-commands
14327@vindex nntp-never-echoes-commands
14328Non-@code{nil} means the nntp server never echoes commands. It is
14329reported that some nntps server doesn't echo commands. So, you may want
14330to set this to non-@code{nil} in the method for such a server setting
14331@code{nntp-open-connection-function} to @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream} for
14332example. The default value is @code{nil}. Note that the
14333@code{nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands} variable
14334overrides the @code{nil} value of this variable.
14335
14336@item nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
14337@vindex nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
14338List of functions that never echo commands. Add or set a function which
14339you set to @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to this list if it does
14340not echo commands. Note that a non-@code{nil} value of the
14341@code{nntp-never-echoes-commands} variable overrides this variable. The
14342default value is @code{(nntp-open-network-stream)}.
14343
14344@item nntp-prepare-post-hook
14345@vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
14346A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
14347@code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
14348recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
14349hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
14350inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
14351
14352@lisp
14353(add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
14354@end lisp
14355
14356Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
14357INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
14358
14359@end table
14360
14361@menu
14362* Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
14363* Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
14364* Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
01c52d31 14365* NNTP marks:: Storing marks for @acronym{NNTP} servers.
4009494e
GM
14366@end menu
14367
14368
14369@node Direct Functions
14370@subsubsection Direct Functions
14371@cindex direct connection functions
14372
14373These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
14374between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
14375functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
14376(@pxref{Common Variables}).
14377
14378@table @code
14379@findex nntp-open-network-stream
14380@item nntp-open-network-stream
14381This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
14382remote system.
14383
14384@findex nntp-open-tls-stream
14385@item nntp-open-tls-stream
14386Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
14387this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GNUTLS}
14388installed. You then define a server as follows:
14389
14390@lisp
14391;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
14392;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
14393;;
14394(nntp "snews.bar.com"
14395 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
83828b06 14396 (nntp-port-number 563)
4009494e
GM
14397 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
14398@end lisp
14399
14400@findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
14401@item nntp-open-ssl-stream
14402Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
14403this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
14404@uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
14405then define a server as follows:
14406
14407@lisp
14408;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
14409;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
14410;;
14411(nntp "snews.bar.com"
14412 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
14413 (nntp-port-number 563)
14414 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
14415@end lisp
14416
990e2c2f
SM
14417@findex nntp-open-netcat-stream
14418@item nntp-open-netcat-stream
31fe2b00
SM
14419Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server using the @code{netcat}
14420program. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have
14421the default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
4009494e
GM
14422of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
14423connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
14424@code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
14425
14426@lisp
14427(nntp "socksified"
14428 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
990e2c2f 14429 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
4009494e
GM
14430 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
14431@end lisp
14432
14433With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
14434session, which is not a good idea.
31fe2b00
SM
14435
14436@findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
14437@item nntp-open-telnet-stream
990e2c2f 14438Like @code{nntp-open-netcat-stream}, but uses @code{telnet} rather than
31fe2b00
SM
14439@code{netcat}. @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things
14440like line-end-conversion, but sometimes netcat is simply
14441not available. The previous example would turn into:
14442
14443@lisp
14444(nntp "socksified"
14445 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
14446 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
14447 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
14448 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
14449@end lisp
4009494e
GM
14450@end table
14451
14452
14453@node Indirect Functions
14454@subsubsection Indirect Functions
14455@cindex indirect connection functions
14456
14457These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
14458intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
14459All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
14460the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
14461things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
14462commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
14463
14464@table @code
31fe2b00
SM
14465@item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
14466@findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
14467Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then uses @code{netcat} to connect
4009494e
GM
14468to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
14469you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
14470
31fe2b00 14471@code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat}-specific variables:
4009494e
GM
14472
14473@table @code
14474@item nntp-via-rlogin-command
14475@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
14476Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
14477@samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
14478
14479@item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
14480@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
14481List of strings to be used as the switches to
14482@code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
14483@samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
31fe2b00 14484@samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections.
4009494e
GM
14485@end table
14486
31fe2b00
SM
14487@item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
14488@findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
14489Does essentially the same, but uses @code{telnet} instead of @samp{netcat}
01c52d31 14490to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the intermediate host.
31fe2b00 14491@code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things like
867d4bb3 14492line-end-conversion, but sometimes @code{netcat} is simply not available.
01c52d31 14493
31fe2b00 14494@code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
01c52d31
MB
14495
14496@table @code
31fe2b00
SM
14497@item nntp-telnet-command
14498@vindex nntp-telnet-command
01c52d31 14499Command used to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the
fbcbb58c 14500intermediate host. The default is @samp{telnet}.
01c52d31 14501
31fe2b00
SM
14502@item nntp-telnet-switches
14503@vindex nntp-telnet-switches
01c52d31 14504List of strings to be used as the switches to the
31fe2b00 14505@code{nntp-telnet-command} command. The default is @code{("-8")}.
01c52d31
MB
14506
14507@item nntp-via-rlogin-command
14508@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
14509Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
14510@samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
14511
14512@item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
14513@vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
14514List of strings to be used as the switches to
31fe2b00
SM
14515@code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. If you use @samp{ssh}, you may need to set
14516this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
14517the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
14518host. The default is @code{nil}.
01c52d31
MB
14519@end table
14520
31fe2b00
SM
14521Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
14522to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
14523
4009494e
GM
14524@item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
14525@findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
14526Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
14527@samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
14528
14529@code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
14530
14531@table @code
14532@item nntp-via-telnet-command
14533@vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
14534Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
14535@samp{telnet}.
14536
14537@item nntp-via-telnet-switches
14538@vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
14539List of strings to be used as the switches to the
14540@code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
14541
14542@item nntp-via-user-password
14543@vindex nntp-via-user-password
14544Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
14545
14546@item nntp-via-envuser
14547@vindex nntp-via-envuser
14548If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
14549server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
14550login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
14551
14552@item nntp-via-shell-prompt
14553@vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
14554Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
14555is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
14556
14557@end table
14558
01c52d31
MB
14559Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
14560to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
4009494e
GM
14561@end table
14562
14563
14564Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
14565functions:
14566
14567@table @code
14568
14569@item nntp-via-user-name
14570@vindex nntp-via-user-name
14571User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
14572
14573@item nntp-via-address
14574@vindex nntp-via-address
14575Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
14576
14577@end table
14578
14579
14580@node Common Variables
14581@subsubsection Common Variables
14582
14583The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
14584pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
14585affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
14586default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
14587variables individually).
14588
14589@table @code
14590
14591@item nntp-pre-command
14592@vindex nntp-pre-command
14593A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
14594connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
14595@code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
14596where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
14597
14598@item nntp-address
14599@vindex nntp-address
14600The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
14601
14602@item nntp-port-number
14603@vindex nntp-port-number
14604Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14605@samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
14606@acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
14607than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
14608@samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
14609not work with named ports.
14610
14611@item nntp-end-of-line
14612@vindex nntp-end-of-line
14613String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
14614server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
01c52d31 14615using a non native telnet connection function.
4009494e 14616
990e2c2f
SM
14617@item nntp-netcat-command
14618@vindex nntp-netcat-command
4009494e 14619Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
31fe2b00 14620@samp{netcat}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
4009494e 14621just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
31fe2b00 14622@samp{nc}.
4009494e 14623
990e2c2f
SM
14624@item nntp-netcat-switches
14625@vindex nntp-netcat-switches
14626A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-netcat-command}. The default
31fe2b00 14627is @samp{()}.
4009494e
GM
14628
14629@end table
14630
01c52d31
MB
14631@node NNTP marks
14632@subsubsection NNTP marks
14633@cindex storing NNTP marks
14634
14635Gnus stores marks (@pxref{Marking Articles}) for @acronym{NNTP}
14636servers in marks files. A marks file records what marks you have set
14637in a group and each file is specific to the corresponding server.
14638Marks files are stored in @file{~/News/marks}
14639(@code{nntp-marks-directory}) under a classic hierarchy resembling
14640that of a news server, for example marks for the group
14641@samp{gmane.discuss} on the news.gmane.org server will be stored in
14642the file @file{~/News/marks/news.gmane.org/gmane/discuss/.marks}.
14643
14644Marks files are useful because you can copy the @file{~/News/marks}
14645directory (using rsync, scp or whatever) to another Gnus installation,
14646and it will realize what articles you have read and marked. The data
14647in @file{~/News/marks} has priority over the same data in
14648@file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
14649
14650Note that marks files are very much server-specific: Gnus remembers
14651the article numbers so if you don't use the same servers on both
14652installations things are most likely to break (most @acronym{NNTP}
14653servers do not use the same article numbers as any other server).
14654However, if you use servers A, B, C on one installation and servers A,
14655D, E on the other, you can sync the marks files for A and then you'll
14656get synchronization for that server between the two installations.
14657
14658Using @acronym{NNTP} marks can possibly incur a performance penalty so
14659if Gnus feels sluggish, try setting the @code{nntp-marks-is-evil}
14660variable to @code{t}. Marks will then be stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
14661
14662Related variables:
14663
14664@table @code
14665
14666@item nntp-marks-is-evil
14667@vindex nntp-marks-is-evil
14668If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any marks files. The
14669default is @code{nil}.
14670
14671@item nntp-marks-directory
14672@vindex nntp-marks-directory
14673The directory where marks for nntp groups will be stored.
14674
14675@end table
14676
4009494e
GM
14677
14678@node News Spool
14679@subsection News Spool
14680@cindex nnspool
14681@cindex news spool
14682
14683Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
14684and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
14685contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
14686instance.
14687
14688Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
14689anything else) as the address.
14690
14691If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
14692native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
14693than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
14694You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
14695
14696@table @code
14697
14698@item nnspool-inews-program
14699@vindex nnspool-inews-program
14700Program used to post an article.
14701
14702@item nnspool-inews-switches
14703@vindex nnspool-inews-switches
14704Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
14705
14706@item nnspool-spool-directory
14707@vindex nnspool-spool-directory
14708Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
14709@file{/usr/spool/news/}.
14710
14711@item nnspool-nov-directory
14712@vindex nnspool-nov-directory
14713Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
14714@file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
14715
14716@item nnspool-lib-dir
14717@vindex nnspool-lib-dir
14718Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
14719
14720@item nnspool-active-file
14721@vindex nnspool-active-file
14722The name of the active file.
14723
14724@item nnspool-newsgroups-file
14725@vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
14726The name of the group descriptions file.
14727
14728@item nnspool-history-file
14729@vindex nnspool-history-file
14730The name of the news history file.
14731
14732@item nnspool-active-times-file
14733@vindex nnspool-active-times-file
14734The name of the active date file.
14735
14736@item nnspool-nov-is-evil
14737@vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
14738If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
14739that it finds.
14740
14741@item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14742@vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14743@cindex sed
14744If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
14745relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
14746@code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
14747there.
14748
14749@end table
14750
14751
14752@node Getting Mail
14753@section Getting Mail
14754@cindex reading mail
14755@cindex mail
14756
14757Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
14758course.
14759
14760@menu
14761* Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
14762* Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
14763* Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
14764* Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
14765* Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
14766* Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
14767* Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
14768* Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
14769* Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
14770* Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
14771* Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
14772* Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
14773* Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
14774@end menu
14775
14776
14777@node Mail in a Newsreader
14778@subsection Mail in a Newsreader
14779
14780If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
14781to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
14782of a culture shock.
14783
14784Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
14785it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
14786
14787Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
14788approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
14789messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
14790you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
14791
14792In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
14793
14794Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
14795deleted? How awful!
14796
14797But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
14798scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
14799the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
14800you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
14801Mail}.
14802
14803What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
14804mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
14805they want to treat a message.
14806
14807Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
14808via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
14809answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
14810need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
14811archived somewhere else.
14812
14813Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
14814These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
14815to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
14816order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
14817to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
14818
14819The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
14820but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
14821or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
14822
14823Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
14824like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
14825differently.
14826
14827Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
14828that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
14829to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
14830not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
14831instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
14832
14833I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
14834may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
14835you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
14836guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
14837Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
14838Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
14839You Do.)
14840
14841
14842@node Getting Started Reading Mail
14843@subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
14844
14845It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
14846mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
14847and things will happen automatically.
14848
14849For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
14850mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14851
14852@lisp
14853(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
14854@end lisp
14855
14856Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
14857articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
14858directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
14859be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
14860like any other group.
14861
14862You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
14863
14864@lisp
14865(setq nnmail-split-methods
14866 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14867 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14868 ("other" "")))
14869@end lisp
14870
14871This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
14872@samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
14873mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
14874last group.
14875
14876This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
14877give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
14878Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
14879
14880
14881@node Splitting Mail
14882@subsection Splitting Mail
14883@cindex splitting mail
14884@cindex mail splitting
14885@cindex mail filtering (splitting)
14886
14887@vindex nnmail-split-methods
14888The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
14889to be split into groups.
14890
14891@lisp
14892(setq nnmail-split-methods
14893 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14894 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14895 ("mail.other" "")))
14896@end lisp
14897
14898This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
14899these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
14900something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
14901element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
14902determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
14903contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
14904insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
14905
14906@lisp
14907("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
14908@end lisp
14909
14910@noindent
14911In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
14912the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14913
14914The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
14915called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
14916argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
14917mail belongs in that group.
14918
14919@cindex @samp{bogus} group
14920The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
14921expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
14922that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
14923processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
14924to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
14925that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
14926will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
14927splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
14928see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
14929
14930If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
14931function of your choice. This function will be called without any
14932arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
14933message. The function should return a list of group names that it
14934thinks should carry this mail message.
14935
14936Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
14937incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
14938some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
14939@code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
14940
14941@vindex nnmail-crosspost
14942The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
14943the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
14944@code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
14945that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
14946
14947@vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
14948@cindex crosspost
14949@cindex links
14950@code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
14951the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
14952links. If that's the case for you, set
14953@code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
14954variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
14955
14956@kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
14957@findex nnmail-split-history
14958If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
14959can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
14960where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
14961@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
14962Group Commands}).
14963
14964@vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
14965Header lines longer than the value of
14966@code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
14967function.
14968
14969@vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
14970@vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
14971By default, splitting does not decode headers, so you can not match on
14972non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. But it is useful if you want to match
14973articles based on the raw header data. To enable it, set the
14974@code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} variable to a non-@code{nil} value.
14975In addition, the value of the @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
14976variable is used for decoding non-@acronym{MIME} encoded string when
14977@code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} is non-@code{nil}. The default
14978value is @code{nil} which means not to decode non-@acronym{MIME} encoded
14979string. A suitable value for you will be @code{undecided} or be the
14980charset used normally in mails you are interested in.
14981
14982@vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14983By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
14984specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
14985(@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
14986@emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
14987@code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
14988splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
14989other kinds of entries.)
14990
14991Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
14992yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
14993all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
14994unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
14995boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
14996that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
14997come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
14998you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
14999month's rent money.
15000
15001
15002@node Mail Sources
15003@subsection Mail Sources
15004
15005Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
15006a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
15007maildir, for instance.
15008
15009@menu
15010* Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
15011* Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
15012* Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
15013@end menu
15014
15015
15016@node Mail Source Specifiers
15017@subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
15018@cindex POP
15019@cindex mail server
15020@cindex procmail
15021@cindex mail spool
15022@cindex mail source
15023
15024You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
15025(@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
15026
15027Here's an example:
15028
15029@lisp
15030(pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
15031@end lisp
15032
15033As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
15034element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
15035@dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
15036default values.
15037
a1da1e37
MB
15038The @code{mail-sources} is global for all mail groups. You can specify
15039an additional mail source for a particular group by including the
15040@code{group} mail specifier in @code{mail-sources}, and setting a
15041@code{mail-source} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) specifying
15042a single mail source. When this is used, @code{mail-sources} is
15043typically just @code{(group)}; the @code{mail-source} parameter for a
15044group might look like this:
15045
15046@lisp
15047(mail-source . (file :path "home/user/spools/foo.spool"))
15048@end lisp
15049
15050This means that the group's (and only this group's) messages will be
15051fetched from the spool file @samp{/user/spools/foo.spool}.
15052
4009494e
GM
15053The following mail source types are available:
15054
15055@table @code
15056@item file
15057Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
15058
15059Keywords:
15060
15061@table @code
15062@item :path
15063The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
15064environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
15065(usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
15066
15067@item :prescript
15068@itemx :postscript
15069Script run before/after fetching mail.
15070@end table
15071
15072An example file mail source:
15073
15074@lisp
15075(file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
15076@end lisp
15077
15078Or using the default file name:
15079
15080@lisp
15081(file)
15082@end lisp
15083
15084If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
15085to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
15086You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
15087mail spool while moving the mail.
15088
15089If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
15090
15091@lisp
15092(setq mail-sources
15093 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
15094@end lisp
15095
15096The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
15097
15098@example
15099#!/bin/sh
15100# getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
15101# flu@@iki.fi
15102
15103MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
15104TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
15105rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
15106@end example
15107
15108Alter this script to fit the @samp{movemail} and temporary
15109file you want to use.
15110
15111
15112@item directory
15113@vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
15114Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
15115when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
15116That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
15117directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
15118will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
15119to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
15120@code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
15121Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
15122if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
15123
15124@vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
15125There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
15126that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
15127applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
15128
15129Keywords:
15130
15131@table @code
15132@item :path
15133The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
15134value.
15135
15136@item :suffix
15137Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
15138@samp{.spool}.
15139
15140@item :predicate
15141Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
15142The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
15143filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
15144predicate are considered.
15145
15146@item :prescript
15147@itemx :postscript
15148Script run before/after fetching mail.
15149
15150@end table
15151
15152An example directory mail source:
15153
15154@lisp
15155(directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
15156 :suffix ".prcml")
15157@end lisp
15158
15159@item pop
15160Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
15161
15162Keywords:
15163
15164@table @code
15165@item :server
15166The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
15167@env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
15168
15169@item :port
15170The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
15171@samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
15172string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
15173Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
15174need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
15175
15176@item :user
15177The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
15178name.
15179
15180@item :password
15181The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
15182the user is prompted.
15183
15184@item :program
15185The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
15186should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
15187
15188@example
15189fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
15190@end example
15191
15192The valid format specifier characters are:
15193
15194@table @samp
15195@item t
15196The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
15197included in this string.
15198
15199@item s
15200The name of the server.
15201
15202@item P
15203The port number of the server.
15204
15205@item u
15206The user name to use.
15207
15208@item p
15209The password to use.
15210@end table
15211
15212The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
15213corresponding keywords.
15214
15215@item :prescript
15216A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
15217the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
15218
15219@item :postscript
15220A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
15221the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
15222
15223@item :function
15224The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
15225function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
15226mail should be moved to.
15227
15228@item :authentication
15229This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
15230and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
15231@code{password}.
15232
15233@end table
15234
15235@vindex pop3-movemail
15236@vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
15237If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
15238@code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server}
15239is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
15240after fetching when using @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers
15241maintain no state information between sessions, so what the client
15242believes is there and what is actually there may not match up. If they
15243do not, then you may get duplicate mails or the whole thing can fall
15244apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
15245
15246Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
15247Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
15248name, and default fetcher:
15249
15250@lisp
15251(pop)
15252@end lisp
15253
15254Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
15255
15256@lisp
15257(pop :server "my.pop.server"
15258 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
15259@end lisp
15260
15261Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
15262
15263@lisp
15264(pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
15265@end lisp
15266
15267@item maildir
15268Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
15269at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
15270contains exactly one mail.
15271
15272Keywords:
15273
15274@table @code
15275@item :path
15276The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
15277taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
15278@file{~/Maildir/}.
15279@item :subdirs
15280The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
15281@samp{("new" "cur")}.
15282
15283@c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
15284@c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
15285@c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
15286@c below.
15287
15288You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
15289from locking problems).
15290
15291@end table
15292
15293Two example maildir mail sources:
15294
15295@lisp
15296(maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
15297 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
15298@end lisp
15299
15300@lisp
15301(maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
15302 :subdirs ("new"))
15303@end lisp
15304
15305@item imap
15306Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
15307@acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
15308with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
15309to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
15310@acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for more information.
15311
15312Note that for the Kerberos, GSSAPI, @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} and STARTTLS support you
15313may need external programs and libraries, @xref{IMAP}.
15314
15315Keywords:
15316
15317@table @code
15318@item :server
15319The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
15320@env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
15321
15322@item :port
15323The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
15324@samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
15325
15326@item :user
15327The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
15328name.
15329
15330@item :password
15331The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
15332prompted.
15333
15334@item :stream
15335What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
15336symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
15337@samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
15338@samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
15339
15340@item :authentication
15341Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
15342one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
15343this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
15344@samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
15345
15346@item :program
15347When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
15348mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
15349@code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
15350
15351@example
15352ssh %s imapd
15353@end example
15354
01c52d31
MB
15355Make sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g.,
15356don't forget to redirect the error output to the void. The valid format
15357specifier characters are:
4009494e
GM
15358
15359@table @samp
15360@item s
15361The name of the server.
15362
15363@item l
15364User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
15365
15366@item p
15367The port number of the server.
15368@end table
15369
15370The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
15371corresponding keywords.
15372
15373@item :mailbox
15374The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
d55fe5bb 15375which normally is the mailbox which receives incoming mail.
4009494e
GM
15376
15377@item :predicate
15378The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
15379UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
15380sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
15381articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
15382Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
15383complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
15384
15385@item :fetchflag
15386How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
15387will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
15388would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
15389but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
15390
15391@item :dontexpunge
15392If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
15393mailbox after finishing the fetch.
15394
15395@end table
15396
15397An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
15398
15399@lisp
15400(imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
15401 :stream kerberos4
15402 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
15403@end lisp
15404
15405@item webmail
15406Get mail from a webmail server, such as @uref{http://www.hotmail.com/},
15407@uref{http://webmail.netscape.com/}, @uref{http://www.netaddress.com/},
15408@uref{http://mail.yahoo.com/}.
15409
15410NOTE: Webmail largely depends on cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
15411required for url "4.0pre.46".
15412
15413WARNING: Mails may be lost. NO WARRANTY.
15414
15415Keywords:
15416
15417@table @code
15418@item :subtype
15419The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
15420alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
15421
15422@item :user
15423The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
15424name.
15425
15426@item :password
15427The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
15428prompted.
15429
15430@item :dontexpunge
15431If non-@code{nil}, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to
15432trash folder after finishing the fetch.
15433
15434@end table
15435
15436An example webmail source:
15437
15438@lisp
15439(webmail :subtype 'hotmail
15440 :user "user-name"
15441 :password "secret")
15442@end lisp
a1da1e37
MB
15443
15444@item group
15445Get the actual mail source from the @code{mail-source} group parameter,
15446@xref{Group Parameters}.
15447
4009494e
GM
15448@end table
15449
15450@table @dfn
15451@item Common Keywords
15452Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
15453
15454Keywords:
15455
15456@table @code
15457@item :plugged
15458If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
15459use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
15460example:
15461
15462@lisp
15463(setq mail-sources
15464 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
15465 :suffix ""
15466 :plugged t)))
15467@end lisp
15468
15469Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
15470useful when you use local mail and news.
15471
15472@end table
15473@end table
15474
15475@subsubsection Function Interface
15476
15477Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
15478For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
15479the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
15480consider the following mail-source setting:
15481
15482@lisp
15483(setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
15484 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
15485@end lisp
15486
15487While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
15488is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
15489@code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
15490@code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
15491and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
15492
15493See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
15494
15495
15496@node Mail Source Customization
15497@subsubsection Mail Source Customization
15498
15499The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
15500fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
15501variables.
15502
15503@table @code
15504@item mail-source-crash-box
15505@vindex mail-source-crash-box
15506File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
15507@file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
15508
37a68866 15509@cindex Incoming*
4009494e
GM
15510@item mail-source-delete-incoming
15511@vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
15512If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
15513@code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
15514files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
37a68866
MB
15515(the deletion will only happen when receiving new mail). You may also
15516set @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
4009494e 15517@code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
2b968687
MB
15518@code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{10} in alpha Gnusae
15519and @code{2} in released Gnusae. @xref{Gnus Development}.
4009494e
GM
15520
15521@item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15522@vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15523If non-@code{nil}, ask for confirmation before deleting old incoming
15524files. This variable only applies when
15525@code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
15526
15527@item mail-source-ignore-errors
15528@vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
15529If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
15530
15531@item mail-source-directory
15532@vindex mail-source-directory
15533Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
15534default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
15535is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
15536@code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
15537
15538@item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15539@vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15540Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
15541@file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
15542@file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
15543relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
15544number.
15545
15546@item mail-source-default-file-modes
15547@vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
15548All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
15549
15550@item mail-source-movemail-program
15551@vindex mail-source-movemail-program
15552If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
15553@code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
15554
15555@end table
15556
15557
15558@node Fetching Mail
15559@subsubsection Fetching Mail
15560
15561@vindex mail-sources
4009494e
GM
15562The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
15563@code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
15564(@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
15565
b890d447
MB
15566If this variable is @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to
15567fetch mail by themselves.
4009494e
GM
15568
15569If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
15570@acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
15571
15572@lisp
15573(setq mail-sources
15574 '((file)
15575 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15576 :password "secret")))
15577@end lisp
15578
15579Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
15580
15581@lisp
15582(setq mail-sources
15583 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
15584 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15585 :user "user-name"
15586 :port "pop3"
15587 :password "secret")))
15588@end lisp
15589
15590
15591When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
15592inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
15593mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
15594invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
15595pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
15596shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
15597
15598
15599
15600@node Mail Back End Variables
15601@subsection Mail Back End Variables
15602
15603These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
15604mail back ends.
15605
15606@table @code
15607@vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15608@item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15609The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
15610use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
15611
15612@vindex nnmail-split-hook
15613@item nnmail-split-hook
15614@findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
15615@cindex RFC 1522 decoding
15616@cindex RFC 2047 decoding
15617Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
15618just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
15619free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
15620is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
15621in the buffer will show up in any files.
15622@code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
15623to this hook.
15624
15625@vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15626@vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15627@item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15628@itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15629These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
15630mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
15631starting to handle the new mail) and
15632@code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
15633is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
15634default file modes the new mail files get:
15635
15636@lisp
15637(add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15638 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
15639
15640(add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15641 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
15642@end lisp
15643
15644@item nnmail-use-long-file-names
15645@vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
15646If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
15647names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
15648(assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
15649@code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
15650the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
15651
15652@item nnmail-delete-file-function
15653@vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
15654@findex delete-file
15655Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
15656
15657@item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15658@vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15659If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
15660the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
15661discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
15662
15663@item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15664@vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15665This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
15666Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
15667recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
15668
15669This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
15670(@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
15671@code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
15672
15673@end table
15674
15675
15676@node Fancy Mail Splitting
15677@subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
15678@cindex mail splitting
15679@cindex fancy mail splitting
15680
15681@vindex nnmail-split-fancy
15682@findex nnmail-split-fancy
15683If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
15684doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
15685@code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
15686play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
15687
15688Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
15689
15690@lisp
15691;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
15692;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
15693;; @r{from real errors.}
15694(| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
15695 "mail.misc"))
15696 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
15697 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
15698 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
15699 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
15700 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
15701 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
15702 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
15703 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
15704 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
15705 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
15706 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
15707 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
15708 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
15709 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
15710 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
15711 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
15712 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
15713 "misc.misc")
15714@end lisp
15715
15716This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
15717(possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
15718splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
15719
15720@table @code
15721
15722@item group
15723If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
15724regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
15725
15726@c Don't fold this line.
15727@item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
15728The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
15729first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
15730@var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
15731@var{split}.
15732
15733If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
15734@var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
15735@var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
15736@var{split} is processed.
15737
15738The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
15739non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
15740variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
15741be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15742
15743@item (| @var{split} @dots{})
15744If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
15745bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
15746@var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
15747stored in one or more groups.
15748
15749@item (& @var{split} @dots{})
15750If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
15751process all @var{split}s in the list.
15752
15753@item junk
15754If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
15755this message. Use with extreme caution.
15756
15757@item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
15758If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
15759second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
15760arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
15761
15762@cindex body split
15763For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
15764body of the messages:
15765
15766@lisp
15767(defun split-on-body ()
15768 (save-excursion
15769 (save-restriction
15770 (widen)
15771 (goto-char (point-min))
15772 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
15773 "string.group"))))
15774@end lisp
15775
b890d447
MB
15776The buffer is narrowed to the header of the message in question when
15777@var{function} is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called
15778after @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
23f87bed 15779above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
4009494e
GM
15780not be downloaded by default. You need to set
15781@code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
15782(@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
15783
15784@item (! @var{func} @var{split})
15785If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
15786@var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
15787function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
15788should return a split.
15789
15790@item nil
15791If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
15792
15793@end table
15794
15795In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
15796
15797Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
15798according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
15799@var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
15800which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
15801for example,
15802
15803@example
15804(any "joe" "joemail")
15805@end example
15806
15807@noindent
15808messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
15809in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
15810of the following three ways:
15811
15812@enumerate
15813@item
15814@vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
15815You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
15816to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
15817match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
15818words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
15819@code{nil}.
15820
15821Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
15822
15823@item
15824@var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
15825a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
15826in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
15827@code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
15828@code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
15829
15830@item
15831You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
15832@samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
15833section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
15834are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15835@code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
15836ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15837non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15838@end enumerate
15839
15840@vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
15841@var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
15842they are expanded as specified by the variable
15843@code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
15844where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
15845contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
15846@code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
15847
15848@table @code
15849@item from
15850Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
15851@item to
15852Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
15853@samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
15854@item any
15855Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
15856@end table
15857
15858@vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
15859@code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
15860when all this splitting is performed.
15861
15862If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
15863information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
15864substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
15865
15866@example
15867(any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
15868@end example
15869
15870In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
15871will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
15872
15873If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
15874matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
15875up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
15876groupings 1 through 9.
15877
15878@vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
15879Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
15880lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
15881Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
15882groups when users send to an address using different case
15883(i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
15884is @code{t}.
15885
15886@findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
15887@code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
15888split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
15889you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
15890boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
15891working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
15892string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
15893messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
15894it once per thread.
15895
15896To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
15897and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
15898value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
15899using the colon feature, like so:
15900@lisp
15901(setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
15902 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
15903 nnmail-split-fancy
15904 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
15905 ;; @r{other splits go here}
15906 ))
15907@end lisp
15908
15909This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
15910non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
15911in the file specified by the variable
15912@code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
15913(the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
15914invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
15915at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
15916and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
15917for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
15918corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
15919@code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
15920recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
15921somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
15922still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
15923300 kBytes in size.)
15924@vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15925When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
15926also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
15927messages goes into the new group.
15928
15929Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
15930want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
15931outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
15932@code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
15933Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
15934``outgoing'' group.
15935
15936
15937@node Group Mail Splitting
15938@subsection Group Mail Splitting
15939@cindex mail splitting
15940@cindex group mail splitting
15941
15942@findex gnus-group-split
15943If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
15944maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
15945You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
15946parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
15947@code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
15948for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
15949from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
15950@code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
15951
15952Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
15953splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
15954parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
15955rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
15956
15957All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
15958@code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
15959the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
15960@code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
15961matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
15962group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
15963@code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
15964
15965If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
15966parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
15967parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
15968this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
15969@code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
15970@code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
15971@code{gnus-group-split}.
15972
15973@vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
15974@code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
15975by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
15976group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
15977group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
15978some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
15979that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
15980often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
15981complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
15982may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
15983personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
15984element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
15985with the rules extracted from group parameters.
15986
15987It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
15988been defined:
15989
15990@example
15991nnml:mail.bar:
15992((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
15993 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
15994nnml:mail.foo:
15995((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
15996 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
15997 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
15998 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
15999nnml:mail.others:
16000((split-spec . catch-all))
16001@end example
16002
16003Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
16004behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
16005@code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
16006
16007@lisp
16008(| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
16009 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
16010 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
16011 "mail.others")
16012@end lisp
16013
16014@findex gnus-group-split-fancy
16015If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
16016may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
16017splits like this:
16018
16019@lisp
16020(: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
16021@end lisp
16022
16023@var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
16024parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
16025@var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
16026single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
16027fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
16028If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
16029empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
16030Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
16031this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
16032
16033@findex gnus-group-split-setup
16034Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
16035slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
16036But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
16037used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
16038sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
16039@code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
16040@code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
16041scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
16042
16043@findex gnus-group-split-update
16044However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
16045@code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
16046@code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
16047automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
16048you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
16049
16050@lisp
16051(gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
16052@end lisp
16053
16054If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
16055will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
16056have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
16057don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
16058@code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
16059value.
16060
16061@vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
16062Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
16063by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
16064@code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
16065
16066@node Incorporating Old Mail
16067@subsection Incorporating Old Mail
16068@cindex incorporating old mail
16069@cindex import old mail
16070
16071Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
16072you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
16073back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
16074your mail groups.
16075
16076Doing so can be quite easy.
16077
16078To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
16079(@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
16080satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
16081file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
16082your @code{nnml} groups.
16083
16084Here's how:
16085
16086@enumerate
16087@item
16088Go to the group buffer.
16089
16090@item
16091Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
16092@code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
16093
16094@item
16095Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
16096
16097@item
16098Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
16099(@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
16100
16101@item
16102Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
16103@samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
16104@end enumerate
16105
16106All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
16107all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
16108have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
16109deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
16110sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
16111
16112Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
16113back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
16114using the new mail back end.
16115
16116
16117@node Expiring Mail
16118@subsection Expiring Mail
16119@cindex article expiry
16120@cindex expiring mail
16121
16122Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
16123you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
16124different approach to mail reading.
16125
16126Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
16127a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
16128actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
16129mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
16130fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
16131Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
16132course.
16133
16134To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
16135articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
16136that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
16137will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
16138deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
16139more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
16140will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
16141repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
16142NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
16143
16144You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
16145two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
16146with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
16147for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
16148considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
16149the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
16150@samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} and so on are considered
16151expirable.
16152
16153When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
16154who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
16155and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
16156(@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
16157into its own group.)
16158
16159Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
16160answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
16161advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
16162the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
16163between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
16164only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
16165total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
16166Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
16167scoring.
16168
16169@vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
16170Groups that match the regular expression
16171@code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
16172read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
16173expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
16174
16175By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
16176articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
16177before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
16178automatically, you can put something like the following in your
16179@file{~/.gnus.el} file:
16180
16181@vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
16182@lisp
16183(remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
16184 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
16185(add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
16186@end lisp
16187
16188Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
16189articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
16190will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
16191articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
16192mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
16193
16194Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
16195articles you have read to disappear after a while:
16196
16197@lisp
16198(setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
16199 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
16200@end lisp
16201
16202Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
16203@code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
16204
16205If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
16206auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
16207don't really mix very well.
16208
16209@vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
16210The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
16211expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
16212message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
16213days.
16214
16215Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
16216are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
16217have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
16218expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
16219everywhere else:
16220
16221@vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16222@lisp
16223(setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16224 (lambda (group)
16225 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
16226 31)
16227 ((string= group "mail.junk")
16228 1)
16229 ((string= group "important")
16230 'never)
16231 (t
16232 6))))
16233@end lisp
16234
16235The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
16236names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
16237
16238The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
16239@code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
16240necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
16241@code{never}.
16242
16243You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
16244change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
16245
16246@vindex nnmail-expiry-target
16247The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
16248However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
16249to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
16250@code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
16251parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
16252all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
16253parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
16254string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
16255moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
16256the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
16257from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
16258name or @code{delete}.
16259
16260Here's an example for specifying a group name:
16261@lisp
16262(setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
16263@end lisp
16264
16265@findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
16266@vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
16267Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
16268expire mail to groups according to the variable
16269@code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
16270
16271@lisp
16272 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
16273 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
16274 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
16275 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
16276 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
16277@end lisp
16278
16279With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
16280header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
16281get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
16282From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
16283to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
16284@code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
16285
16286@vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
16287If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
16288expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
16289easier for procmail users.
16290
16291@vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
16292By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
16293articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
16294parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
16295articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
16296caution. Even more dangerous is the
16297@code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
16298this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
16299which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
16300will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
16301crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
16302wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
16303@emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
16304with! So there!
16305
16306Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
16307
16308@vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
16309If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
16310commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
16311auto-expire turned on.
16312
b0b63450
MB
16313@vindex gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable
16314The expirable marks of articles will be removed when copying or moving
16315them to a group in which auto-expire is not turned on. This is for
16316preventing articles from being expired unintentionally. On the other
16317hand, to a group that has turned auto-expire on, the expirable marks of
16318articles that are copied or moved will not be changed by default. I.e.,
16319when copying or moving to such a group, articles that were expirable
16320will be left expirable and ones that were not expirable will not be
16321marked as expirable. So, even though in auto-expire groups, some
16322articles will never get expired (unless you read them again). If you
16323don't side with that behavior that unexpirable articles may be mixed
16324into auto-expire groups, you can set
16325@code{gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable} to a
16326non-@code{nil} value. In that case, articles that have been read will
16327be marked as expirable automatically when being copied or moved to a
16328group that has auto-expire turned on. The default value is @code{nil}.
16329
4009494e
GM
16330
16331@node Washing Mail
16332@subsection Washing Mail
16333@cindex mail washing
16334@cindex list server brain damage
16335@cindex incoming mail treatment
16336
16337Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
16338really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
16339prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
16340end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
16341Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
16342considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
16343
16344Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
16345} to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
16346be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
16347laugh.
16348
16349Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
16350displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
16351storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
16352various functions that can be put in these hooks.
16353
16354@table @code
16355@item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
16356@vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
16357This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
16358grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
16359the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
16360
16361@table @code
16362@item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
16363@findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
16364Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
16365Emacs running on MS machines.
16366
16367@end table
16368
16369@item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
16370@vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
16371This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
16372cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
16373
16374@table @code
16375@item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
16376@findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
16377Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
16378headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
16379
16380(Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
16381messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
16382of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
16383rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
16384into a feature by documenting it.)
16385
16386@item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
16387@findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
16388Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
16389beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
16390people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
16391strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
16392also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
16393@code{\\(..\\)}.
16394
16395For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
16396@samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
16397
16398@lisp
16399(setq nnmail-list-identifiers
16400 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
16401@end lisp
16402
16403This can also be done non-destructively with
16404@code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
16405
16406@item nnmail-remove-tabs
16407@findex nnmail-remove-tabs
16408Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
16409
01c52d31
MB
16410@item nnmail-ignore-broken-references
16411@findex nnmail-ignore-broken-references
16412@c @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
4009494e 16413@cindex Eudora
01c52d31
MB
16414@cindex Pegasus
16415Some mail user agents (e.g. Eudora and Pegasus) produce broken
16416@code{References} headers, but correct @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This
16417function will get rid of the @code{References} header if the headers
16418contain a line matching the regular expression
16419@code{nnmail-broken-references-mailers}.
4009494e
GM
16420
16421@end table
16422
16423@item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
16424@vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
16425This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
16426include:
16427
16428@table @code
16429@item article-de-quoted-unreadable
16430@findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
16431Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
16432
16433@end table
16434@end table
16435
16436
16437@node Duplicates
16438@subsection Duplicates
16439
16440@vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
16441@vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
16442@vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
16443@cindex duplicate mails
16444If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
16445receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
16446@code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
16447this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
16448@code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
16449default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
16450there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
16451variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
16452stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
16453@code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
16454default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
16455will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
16456that this is a duplicate of a different message.
16457
16458This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
16459will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
16460the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
16461@code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
16462
16463You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
16464@code{nil}.
16465
16466If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
16467@dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
16468methods:
16469
16470@lisp
16471(setq nnmail-split-fancy
16472 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
16473 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
16474 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
16475 (any mail "mail.misc")
16476 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16477 [...] ))
16478@end lisp
16479@noindent
16480Or something like:
16481@lisp
16482(setq nnmail-split-methods
16483 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
16484 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16485 [...]))
16486@end lisp
16487
16488Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
16489with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
16490@code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
16491using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
16492received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
16493
16494
16495@node Not Reading Mail
16496@subsection Not Reading Mail
16497
16498If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
16499habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
16500be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
16501
16502If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
16503@code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
16504mail, which should help.
16505
16506@vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16507@vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16508@vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16509@vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16510@vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16511This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
bc79f9ab
GM
16512happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old (pre-Emacs
1651323) Rmail file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
4009494e
GM
16514variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
16515the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
16516group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
16517
16518All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
16519narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
16520incoming mail.
16521
16522
16523@node Choosing a Mail Back End
16524@subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
16525
16526Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
16527file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
16528depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
16529
16530There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
16531back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
16532(because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
16533Spool}).
16534
16535@menu
16536* Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
bc79f9ab 16537* Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
4009494e
GM
16538* Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
16539* MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
16540* Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
16541* Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
16542* Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
16543@end menu
16544
16545
16546@node Unix Mail Box
16547@subsubsection Unix Mail Box
16548@cindex nnmbox
16549@cindex unix mail box
16550
16551@vindex nnmbox-active-file
16552@vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16553The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
16554mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
16555which group it belongs in.
16556
16557Virtual server settings:
16558
16559@table @code
16560@item nnmbox-mbox-file
16561@vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16562The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
16563@file{~/mbox}.
16564
16565@item nnmbox-active-file
16566@vindex nnmbox-active-file
16567The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
16568@file{~/.mbox-active}.
16569
16570@item nnmbox-get-new-mail
16571@vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16572If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
16573into groups. Default is @code{t}.
16574@end table
16575
16576
bc79f9ab
GM
16577@node Babyl
16578@subsubsection Babyl
4009494e 16579@cindex nnbabyl
4009494e
GM
16580
16581@vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16582@vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
bc79f9ab
GM
16583The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box to store mail.
16584@code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each mail article to say which
16585group it belongs in.
4009494e
GM
16586
16587Virtual server settings:
16588
16589@table @code
16590@item nnbabyl-mbox-file
16591@vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
bc79f9ab 16592The name of the Babyl file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
4009494e
GM
16593
16594@item nnbabyl-active-file
16595@vindex nnbabyl-active-file
bc79f9ab 16596The name of the active file for the Babyl file. The default is
4009494e
GM
16597@file{~/.rmail-active}
16598
16599@item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16600@vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16601If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
16602@code{t}
16603@end table
16604
16605
16606@node Mail Spool
16607@subsubsection Mail Spool
16608@cindex nnml
16609@cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
16610
16611The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
16612format. It should be used with some caution.
16613
16614@vindex nnml-directory
16615If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
16616one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
16617directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
16618variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
16619
16620You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
16621care of all that.
16622
16623If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
16624in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
16625own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
16626weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
16627having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
16628shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
16629know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
16630to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
16631
16632@code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
16633splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
16634@acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
16635fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
16636
16637@cindex self contained nnml servers
16638@cindex marks
16639When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
16640servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
16641similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
16642proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
01c52d31 16643for a group are usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
4009494e
GM
16644@code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
16645Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
16646to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
16647directory).
16648
16649If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
16650up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
16651them next time it starts.
16652
16653Virtual server settings:
16654
16655@table @code
16656@item nnml-directory
16657@vindex nnml-directory
16658All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
16659default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
16660is @file{~/Mail}).
16661
16662@item nnml-active-file
16663@vindex nnml-active-file
16664The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
16665@file{~/Mail/active}.
16666
16667@item nnml-newsgroups-file
16668@vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
16669The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16670Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
16671
16672@item nnml-get-new-mail
16673@vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16674If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
16675@code{t}.
16676
16677@item nnml-nov-is-evil
16678@vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
16679If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16680default is @code{nil}.
16681
16682@item nnml-nov-file-name
16683@vindex nnml-nov-file-name
16684The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
16685
16686@item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16687@vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16688Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
16689
16690@item nnml-marks-is-evil
16691@vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
16692If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
16693default is @code{nil}.
16694
16695@item nnml-marks-file-name
16696@vindex nnml-marks-file-name
16697The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
16698
16699@item nnml-use-compressed-files
16700@vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
16701If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
01c52d31
MB
16702files. This requires @code{auto-compression-mode} to be enabled
16703(@pxref{Compressed Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
16704If the value of @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is a string, it is used
16705as the file extension specifying the compression program. You can set it
16706to @samp{.bz2} if your Emacs supports it. A value of @code{t} is
16707equivalent to @samp{.gz}.
16708
16709@item nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16710@vindex nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16711Default size threshold for compressed message files. Message files with
16712bodies larger than that many characters will be automatically compressed
16713if @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil}.
4009494e
GM
16714
16715@end table
16716
16717@findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
16718If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
16719whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
16720nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
16721entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
16722might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
16723functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
16724Commands}).
16725
16726
16727@node MH Spool
16728@subsubsection MH Spool
16729@cindex nnmh
16730@cindex mh-e mail spool
16731
16732@code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
16733@acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
16734file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
16735@code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
16736for.
16737
16738Virtual server settings:
16739
16740@table @code
16741@item nnmh-directory
16742@vindex nnmh-directory
16743All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
16744default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
16745@file{~/Mail})
16746
16747@item nnmh-get-new-mail
16748@vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16749If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
16750@code{t}.
16751
16752@item nnmh-be-safe
16753@vindex nnmh-be-safe
16754If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
16755sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
16756they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
16757setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
16758use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
16759have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
16760@end table
16761
16762
16763@node Maildir
16764@subsubsection Maildir
16765@cindex nnmaildir
16766@cindex maildir
16767
16768@code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
16769corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
16770@uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
16771@uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
16772also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
16773within a maildir.
16774
16775Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
16776reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
16777your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
16778configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
16779can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
16780configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
16781that appear as group in Gnus.
16782
16783@code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
16784never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
16785corrupt its data in the filesystem.
16786
16787@code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
16788maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
16789another, and you will keep your marks.
16790
16791Virtual server settings:
16792
16793@table @code
16794@item directory
16795For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
16796you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
16797it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
16798choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
16799will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
16800filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
16801in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
16802scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
16803the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
16804@code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
16805
16806The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
16807which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
16808the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
16809only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
16810server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
16811don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
16812optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
16813@code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
16814use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
16815if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
16816value.
16817
16818@item target-prefix
16819This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
16820@code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
16821server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
16822closed.
16823
16824When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
16825created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
16826pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
16827So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
16828@code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
16829the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
16830@file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
16831@file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
16832@file{../maildirs/foo}.
16833
16834You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
16835create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
16836this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
16837with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
16838symlinks pointing to them will be).
16839
16840As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
16841then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
16842@code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
16843cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
16844@code{force} argument.
16845
16846@item directory-files
16847This should be a function with the same interface as
16848@code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
16849used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
16850parameter is optional; the default is
16851@code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
16852@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
16853@code{directory-files} otherwise.
16854(@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
16855server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
16856scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
16857
16858@item get-new-mail
16859If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
16860maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
16861the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
16862@code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
16863value is @code{nil}.
16864
16865Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
16866an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
16867that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
16868different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
16869remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
16870@end table
16871
16872@subsubsection Group parameters
16873
16874@code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
16875all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
16876default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
16877one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
16878functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
16879you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
16880another back end.
16881
16882If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
16883is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
16884original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
16885evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
16886different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
16887back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
16888numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
16889@code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
16890quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
16891
16892@table @code
16893@item expire-age
16894An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
16895before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
16896articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
16897@code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
16898@code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
16899@code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
16900and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
16901wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
1690260 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
16903An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
16904modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
16905delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
16906article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
16907
16908@item expire-group
16909If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
16910@example
16911"backend+server.address.string:group.name"
16912@end example
16913and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
16914to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
16915before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
16916group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
16917was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
16918destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
16919the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
16920you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
16921article. So that form can refer to
16922@code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
16923article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
16924does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
16925@code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
16926
16927@item read-only
16928If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
16929in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
16930from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
16931@file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
16932cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
16933@file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
16934containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
16935maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
16936a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
16937have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
16938contain extra copies of the articles.
16939
16940@item directory-files
16941A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
16942used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
16943group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
16944server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
16945
16946@item distrust-Lines:
16947If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
16948article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
16949@code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
16950
16951@item always-marks
16952A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
16953Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16954say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
16955marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
16956feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
16957in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16958
16959@item never-marks
16960A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
16961Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16962say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
16963stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
16964@code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
16965probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
16966abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16967
16968@item nov-cache-size
16969An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
16970speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
16971for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
16972worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
16973parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
16974the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
16975The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
16976and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
16977that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
16978that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
16979@code{read}, plus a little extra.
16980@end table
16981
16982@subsubsection Article identification
16983Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
16984Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
16985contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
16986@code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
16987the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
16988identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
16989@file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
16990about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
16991available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
16992request the article in the summary buffer.
16993
16994@subsubsection NOV data
16995An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
16996to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
16997@code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
16998@code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
16999need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
17000when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
17001force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
17002single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
17003file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
17004assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
17005with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
17006
17007@subsubsection Article marks
17008An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
17009@code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
17010When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
17011looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
17012asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
17013creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
17014rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
17015links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
17016
17017You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
17018@file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
17019your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
17020remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
17021this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
17022it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
17023type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
17024@kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
17025pick up the changes, and might undo them.
17026
17027
17028@node Mail Folders
17029@subsubsection Mail Folders
17030@cindex nnfolder
17031@cindex mbox folders
17032@cindex mail folders
17033
17034@code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
17035separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
17036@code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
17037numbers and arrival dates.
17038
17039@cindex self contained nnfolder servers
17040@cindex marks
17041When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
17042servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
17043similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
17044proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
17045Marks for a group are usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
17046with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
17047@code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder}
17048directory. Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to
17049backup, use @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup
17050into the @code{nnfolder} directory).
17051
17052Virtual server settings:
17053
17054@table @code
17055@item nnfolder-directory
17056@vindex nnfolder-directory
17057All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
17058directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
17059(whose default is @file{~/Mail})
17060
17061@item nnfolder-active-file
17062@vindex nnfolder-active-file
17063The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
17064
17065@item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
17066@vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
17067The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
17068Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
17069
17070@item nnfolder-get-new-mail
17071@vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
17072If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
17073default is @code{t}
17074
17075@item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
17076@vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
17077@cindex backup files
17078Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
17079backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
17080you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
17081following in your @file{.emacs} file:
17082
17083@lisp
17084(defun turn-off-backup ()
17085 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
17086
17087(add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
17088@end lisp
17089
17090@item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
17091@vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
17092Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
17093This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
17094extract some information from it before removing it.
17095
17096@item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
17097@vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
17098If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
17099default is @code{nil}.
17100
17101@item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
17102@vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
17103The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
17104
17105@item nnfolder-nov-directory
17106@vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
17107The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
17108@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
17109
17110@item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
17111@vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
17112If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
17113default is @code{nil}.
17114
17115@item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
17116@vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
17117The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
17118
17119@item nnfolder-marks-directory
17120@vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
17121The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If
17122@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
17123
17124@end table
17125
17126
17127@findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
17128@kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
17129If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
17130@code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
17131command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
17132@code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
17133though.
17134
17135@node Comparing Mail Back Ends
17136@subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
17137
17138First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
17139low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
17140is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
17141and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
17142mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
17143
17144The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
17145typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
17146in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
17147articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
17148access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
17149area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
17150@code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
17151actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
17152via NFS).
17153
17154The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
17155simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
17156format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
17157future. Here are some high and low points on each:
17158
17159@table @code
17160@item nnmbox
17161
17162UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
17163defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
17164they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
17165@samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
17166to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
17167@samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
17168historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
17169mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
17170this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
17171area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
17172(appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
17173to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
17174fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
17175what's where.
17176
17177@item nnbabyl
17178
17179Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
17180systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
17181reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
17182was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
17183format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
17184spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
17185headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
17186Rmail was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
17187and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
17188to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
17189VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
17190perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
17191headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
bc79f9ab
GM
17192course, and is still maintained within Emacs. Since Emacs 23, it
17193uses standard mbox format rather than Babyl.
4009494e
GM
17194
17195Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
17196file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
17197look at your mail.
17198
17199@item nnml
17200
17201@code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
17202actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
17203fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
17204lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
17205and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
17206Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
17207CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
17208or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
17209@dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
17210@acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
17211due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
17212file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
17213extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
17214provided by the active file and overviews.
17215
17216@code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
17217resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
17218files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
17219tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
17220the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
17221wins big.
17222
17223It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
17224FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
17225tiny files.
17226
17227@item nnmh
17228
17229The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
17230long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
17231individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
17232is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
17233active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
17234one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
17235slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
17236
17237@item nnfolder
17238
17239Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
17240method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
17241itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
17242little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
17243a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
17244can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
17245format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
17246it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
17247out how many messages there are in each separate group.
17248
17249If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
17250messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
17251only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
17252friendly mail back end all over.
17253
17254@item nnmaildir
17255
17256For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
17257incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
17258mail back ends.
17259
17260@code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
17261differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
17262filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
17263also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
17264per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}. (Use
17265@code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this slows
17266you down or takes up very much space, consider switching to
17267@uref{http://www.namesys.com/, ReiserFS} or another non-block-structured
17268file system.
17269
17270Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
17271as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
17272This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
17273organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
17274entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
17275require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
17276thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
17277whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
17278@code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
17279@code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
17280undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
17281
17282@code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
17283corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
17284them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
17285else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
17286it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
17287@code{nnmaildir}.
17288
17289@code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
17290(It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
17291and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
17292is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
17293parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
17294would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
17295removed in the future.
17296
17297Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
17298back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
17299on your file system.
17300
17301@code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
17302to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
17303
17304@end table
17305
17306
17307@node Browsing the Web
17308@section Browsing the Web
17309@cindex web
17310@cindex browsing the web
17311@cindex www
17312@cindex http
17313
17314Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
17315subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
17316eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
17317is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
17318and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
17319go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
17320even know what a news group is.
17321
17322The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
17323being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
17324they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
17325not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
17326you mad in the end.
17327
17328So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
17329to do it instead?
17330
17331Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
17332interfaces to these sources.
17333
17334@menu
17335* Archiving Mail::
17336* Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
17337* Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
17338* Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
17339* Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
17340* RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
17341* Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
17342@end menu
17343
17344All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
17345alternatives to work.
17346
17347The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
17348work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
17349is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
17350will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
17351though, you should be ok.
17352
17353One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
17354are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
17355cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
17356Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
17357leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
17358
17359@node Archiving Mail
17360@subsection Archiving Mail
17361@cindex archiving mail
17362@cindex backup of mail
17363
17364Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
17365@code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
17366For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
17367marks is fairly simple.
17368
17369(Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
17370requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
17371though.)
17372
17373To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
17374server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
17375to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
17376similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
17377adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
17378@ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
17379might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
17380before you restore the data.
17381
17382It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
17383@code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
17384For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
17385directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
17386file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
17387this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
17388buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
17389@code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
17390is unnecessary in that case.
17391
17392@node Web Searches
17393@subsection Web Searches
17394@cindex nnweb
17395@cindex Google
17396@cindex dejanews
17397@cindex gmane
17398@cindex Usenet searches
17399@cindex searching the Usenet
17400
17401It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
17402string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
17403those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
17404the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
17405searches without having to use a browser.
17406
17407The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
17408engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
17409then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
17410group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
17411Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
17412
17413@code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
17414groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
17415each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
17416pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
17417manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
17418Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
17419@code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
17420engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
17421of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
17422header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
17423group as read.
17424
17425If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
17426won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
01c52d31 17427providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'@^etre} is to
4009494e
GM
17428make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
17429community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
17430might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
17431
17432You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
17433(try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
17434installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
17435
17436Virtual server variables:
17437
17438@table @code
17439@item nnweb-type
17440@vindex nnweb-type
17441What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
17442are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
17443@code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
17444
17445@item nnweb-search
17446@vindex nnweb-search
17447The search string to feed to the search engine.
17448
17449@item nnweb-max-hits
17450@vindex nnweb-max-hits
17451Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
17452999.
17453
17454@item nnweb-type-definition
17455@vindex nnweb-type-definition
17456Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
17457with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
17458present:
17459
17460@table @code
17461@item article
17462Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
17463understands.
17464
17465@item map
17466Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
17467
17468@item search
17469Function to send the search string to the search engine.
17470
17471@item address
17472The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
17473to.
17474
17475@item id
17476Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
17477@end table
17478
17479@end table
17480
17481
17482@node Slashdot
17483@subsection Slashdot
17484@cindex Slashdot
17485@cindex nnslashdot
17486
17487@uref{http://slashdot.org/, Slashdot} is a popular news site, with
17488lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
17489let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
17490
17491The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
17492following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17493
17494@lisp
17495(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
17496 '((nnslashdot "")))
17497@end lisp
17498
17499This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
17500and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
17501a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
17502groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
17503groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
17504Methods}).
17505
17506If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
17507command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
17508
17509When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
17510comments), some light @acronym{HTML}izations will be performed. In
17511particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
17512@samp{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @samp{br} added to
17513the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @acronym{HTML}
17514directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
17515@acronym{HTML} forms.
17516
17517The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
17518
17519@table @code
17520@item nnslashdot-threaded
17521Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
17522default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
17523has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
17524threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
17525the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
17526but much, much slower than unthreaded.
17527
17528@item nnslashdot-login-name
17529@vindex nnslashdot-login-name
17530The login name to use when posting.
17531
17532@item nnslashdot-password
17533@vindex nnslashdot-password
17534The password to use when posting.
17535
17536@item nnslashdot-directory
17537@vindex nnslashdot-directory
17538Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
17539@file{~/News/slashdot/}.
17540
17541@item nnslashdot-active-url
17542@vindex nnslashdot-active-url
17543The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the
17544information on news articles and comments. The default is@*
17545@samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
17546
17547@item nnslashdot-comments-url
17548@vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
17549The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch comments.
17550
17551@item nnslashdot-article-url
17552@vindex nnslashdot-article-url
17553The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the news
17554article. The default is
17555@samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
17556
17557@item nnslashdot-threshold
17558@vindex nnslashdot-threshold
17559The score threshold. The default is -1.
17560
17561@item nnslashdot-group-number
17562@vindex nnslashdot-group-number
17563The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
17564updated. The default is 0.
17565
17566@end table
17567
17568
17569
17570@node Ultimate
17571@subsection Ultimate
17572@cindex nnultimate
17573@cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
17574
17575@uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/, The Ultimate Bulletin Board} is
17576probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
17577quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
17578information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
17579
17580The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
17581something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
17582http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @acronym{URL}
17583(not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
17584you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
17585site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
17586server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
17587
17588The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
17589
17590@table @code
17591@item nnultimate-directory
17592@vindex nnultimate-directory
17593The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is@*
17594@file{~/News/ultimate/}.
17595@end table
17596
17597
17598@node Web Archive
17599@subsection Web Archive
17600@cindex nnwarchive
17601@cindex Web Archive
17602
17603Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
17604@uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
17605@uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
17606interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
17607groups updated.
17608
17609@findex gnus-group-make-warchive-group
17610The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
17611something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
17612gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET @var{an_egroup} RET egroups RET
17613www.egroups.com RET @var{your@@email.address} RET}. (Substitute the
17614@var{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
17615@var{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
17616back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
17617
17618The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
17619
17620@table @code
17621@item nnwarchive-directory
17622@vindex nnwarchive-directory
17623The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is@*
17624@file{~/News/warchive/}.
17625
17626@item nnwarchive-login
17627@vindex nnwarchive-login
17628The account name on the web server.
17629
17630@item nnwarchive-passwd
17631@vindex nnwarchive-passwd
17632The password for your account on the web server.
17633@end table
17634
17635@node RSS
17636@subsection RSS
17637@cindex nnrss
17638@cindex RSS
17639
17640Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
17641@acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
17642sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
17643presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
17644changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
17645
17646@acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
17647possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
17648
17649Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
17650system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
17651text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
17652group names.
17653
17654@kindex G R (Group)
17655Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
17656prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
17657The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
17658and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
17659
17660An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
17661the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
17662subscribe to groups.
17663
17664The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
17665@code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
17666names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
17667coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
26b9f88d
MB
17668variable or other. Also @xref{Non-ASCII Group Names}, for more
17669information.
4009494e
GM
17670
17671The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
17672@acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
17673and a @samp{text/html} part.
17674
17675@cindex OPML
17676You can also use the following commands to import and export your
17677subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
17678Markup Language).
17679
17680@defun nnrss-opml-import file
17681Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
17682file.
17683@end defun
17684
17685@defun nnrss-opml-export
17686Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
17687@acronym{OPML} format.
17688@end defun
17689
17690The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
17691
17692@table @code
17693@item nnrss-directory
17694@vindex nnrss-directory
17695The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
17696@file{~/News/rss/}.
17697
17698@item nnrss-file-coding-system
17699@vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
17700The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
17701data files. The default is the value of
17702@code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
17703in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
17704
01c52d31
MB
17705@item nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17706@vindex nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17707Some feeds update constantly article fields during their publications,
17708e.g. to indicate the number of comments. However, if there is
17709a difference between the local article and the distant one, the latter
17710is considered to be new. To avoid this and discard some fields, set this
17711variable to the list of fields to be ignored. The default is
17712@code{'(slash:comments)}.
17713
4009494e
GM
17714@item nnrss-use-local
17715@vindex nnrss-use-local
17716@findex nnrss-generate-download-script
17717If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
17718the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
17719the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
17720download script using @command{wget}.
17721
17722@item nnrss-wash-html-in-text-plain-parts
17723Non-@code{nil} means that @code{nnrss} renders text in @samp{text/plain}
17724parts as @acronym{HTML}. The function specified by the
17725@code{mm-text-html-renderer} variable (@pxref{Display Customization,
17726,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) will be used
17727to render text. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default, text will
17728simply be folded. Leave it @code{nil} if you prefer to see
17729@samp{text/html} parts.
17730@end table
17731
17732The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
17733the summary buffer.
17734
17735@lisp
17736(add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
17737(setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
17738
17739(defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
17740 (let ((descr
17741 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
17742 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
17743@end lisp
17744
17745The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
17746summary buffer.
17747
17748@lisp
17749(require 'browse-url)
17750
01c52d31 17751(defun browse-nnrss-url (arg)
4009494e
GM
17752 (interactive "p")
17753 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
17754 (mail-header-extra
17755 (gnus-data-header
17756 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
17757 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
17758 (if url
17759 (progn
17760 (browse-url (cdr url))
17761 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
17762 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
17763
17764(eval-after-load "gnus"
17765 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
17766 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
17767(add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
17768@end lisp
17769
9b3ebcb6 17770Even if you have added @samp{text/html} to the
4009494e
GM
17771@code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
17772Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
17773Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
17774more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
17775@samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
17776@code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
17777Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
17778@code{nnrss} groups:
17779
17780@lisp
17781;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
17782(eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
17783 '(add-to-list
17784 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
17785 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
17786 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
17787
17788;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
17789(add-to-list
17790 'gnus-parameters
17791 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
17792@end lisp
17793
17794
17795@node Customizing W3
17796@subsection Customizing W3
17797@cindex W3
17798@cindex html
17799@cindex url
17800@cindex Netscape
17801
17802Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
17803alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
17804manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
17805users.
17806
17807For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
17808using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
17809browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
17810
17811@lisp
17812(eval-after-load "w3"
17813 '(progn
17814 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
17815 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
17816 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
17817 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
17818 (browse-url url)
17819 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
17820@end lisp
17821
17822Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
17823@acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
17824follow the link.
17825
17826
17827@node IMAP
17828@section IMAP
17829@cindex nnimap
17830@cindex @acronym{IMAP}
17831
17832@acronym{IMAP} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or @dots{}),
17833think of it as a modernized @acronym{NNTP}. Connecting to a @acronym{IMAP}
17834server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
17835specify the network address of the server.
17836
17837@acronym{IMAP} has two properties. First, @acronym{IMAP} can do
17838everything that @acronym{POP} can, it can hence be viewed as a
17839@acronym{POP++}. Secondly, @acronym{IMAP} is a mail storage protocol,
17840similar to @acronym{NNTP} being a news storage protocol---however,
17841@acronym{IMAP} offers more features than @acronym{NNTP} because news
17842is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.
17843
17844If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a @acronym{POP++}, use an imap
17845entry in @code{mail-sources}. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from
17846the @acronym{IMAP} server and store them on the local disk. This is
17847not the usage described in this section---@xref{Mail Sources}.
17848
17849If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
17850entry in @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}. With this, Gnus will
17851manipulate mails stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server. This is the kind of
17852usage explained in this section.
17853
17854A server configuration in @file{~/.gnus.el} with a few @acronym{IMAP}
17855servers might look something like the following. (Note that for
17856@acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you need external programs and libraries,
17857see below.)
17858
17859@lisp
17860(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
17861 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; @r{no special configuration}
17862 ; @r{perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:}
17863 (nnimap "dolk"
17864 (nnimap-address "localhost")
17865 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
17866 ; @r{a UW server running on localhost}
17867 (nnimap "barbar"
17868 (nnimap-server-port 143)
17869 (nnimap-address "localhost")
17870 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
17871 ; @r{anonymous public cyrus server:}
17872 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
17873 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
17874 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
17875 (nnimap-stream network))
17876 ; @r{a ssl server on a non-standard port:}
17877 (nnimap "vic20"
17878 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
17879 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
17880 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
17881@end lisp
17882
17883After defining the new server, you can subscribe to groups on the
17884server using normal Gnus commands such as @kbd{U} in the Group Buffer
17885(@pxref{Subscription Commands}) or via the Server Buffer
17886(@pxref{Server Buffer}).
17887
17888The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
17889server:
17890
17891@table @code
17892
17893@item nnimap-address
17894@vindex nnimap-address
17895
17896The address of the remote @acronym{IMAP} server. Defaults to the virtual
17897server name if not specified.
17898
17899@item nnimap-server-port
17900@vindex nnimap-server-port
17901Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}.
17902
17903Note that this should be an integer, example server specification:
17904
17905@lisp
17906(nnimap "mail.server.com"
17907 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
17908@end lisp
17909
17910@item nnimap-list-pattern
17911@vindex nnimap-list-pattern
17912String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
17913This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
17914interested in a few---some servers export your home directory via
17915@acronym{IMAP}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
17916@file{~/Mail/*} then.
17917
17918The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
17919REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
17920Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
17921mailbox.
17922
17923Example server specification:
17924
17925@lisp
17926(nnimap "mail.server.com"
17927 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
17928 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
17929@end lisp
17930
17931@item nnimap-stream
17932@vindex nnimap-stream
17933The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
17934will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
17935of @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}. (@acronym{IMAP} over
17936@acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can
17937be automatically detected, but it's not widely deployed yet.)
17938
17939Example server specification:
17940
17941@lisp
17942(nnimap "mail.server.com"
17943 (nnimap-stream ssl))
17944@end lisp
17945
17946Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
17947
17948@itemize @bullet
17949@item
17950@dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
17951@samp{gsasl} or @samp{imtest} program.
17952@item
17953@dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the @samp{imtest} program.
17954@item
17955@dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
17956@acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}). Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
17957@samp{starttls}.
17958@item
17959@dfn{tls:} Connect through @acronym{TLS}. Requires GNUTLS (the program
17960@samp{gnutls-cli}).
17961@item
17962@dfn{ssl:} Connect through @acronym{SSL}. Requires OpenSSL (the program
17963@samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
17964@item
17965@dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start @acronym{IMAP} connection.
17966@item
17967@dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
17968@end itemize
17969
17970@vindex imap-kerberos4-program
17971The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD. If you're
17972using @samp{imtest} from Cyrus IMAPD < 2.0.14 (which includes version
179731.5.x and 1.6.x) you need to frob @code{imap-process-connection-type}
17974to make @code{imap.el} use a pty instead of a pipe when communicating
17975with @samp{imtest}. You will then suffer from a line length
17976restrictions on @acronym{IMAP} commands, which might make Gnus seem to hang
17977indefinitely if you have many articles in a mailbox. The variable
17978@code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
17979program.
17980
17981For @acronym{TLS} connection, the @code{gnutls-cli} program from GNUTLS is
17982needed. It is available from
17983@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/}.
17984
17985@vindex imap-gssapi-program
17986This parameter specifies a list of command lines that invoke a GSSAPI
17987authenticated @acronym{IMAP} stream in a subshell. They are tried
17988sequentially until a connection is made, or the list has been
17989exhausted. By default, @samp{gsasl} from GNU SASL, available from
17990@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gsasl/}, and the @samp{imtest}
17991program from Cyrus IMAPD (see @code{imap-kerberos4-program}), are
17992tried.
17993
17994@vindex imap-ssl-program
17995For @acronym{SSL} connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
17996@uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
17997and nnimap support it too---although the most recent versions of
17998SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
17999useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
18000work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
18001to OpenSSL/SSLeay.
18002
18003@vindex imap-shell-program
18004@vindex imap-shell-host
01c52d31
MB
18005For @acronym{IMAP} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the
18006variable @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call. Make
18007sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g., don't
18008forget to redirect the error output to the void.
4009494e
GM
18009
18010@item nnimap-authenticator
18011@vindex nnimap-authenticator
18012
18013The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
18014will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
18015
18016Example server specification:
18017
18018@lisp
18019(nnimap "mail.server.com"
18020 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
18021@end lisp
18022
18023Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
18024
18025@itemize @bullet
18026@item
18027@dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Requires
18028external program @code{gsasl} or @code{imtest}.
18029@item
18030@dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos 4 authentication. Requires external program
18031@code{imtest}.
18032@item
18033@dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Requires
18034external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
18035@item
18036@dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
18037@item
18038@dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
18039@item
18040@dfn{anonymous:} Login as ``anonymous'', supplying your email address as password.
18041@end itemize
18042
18043@item nnimap-expunge-on-close
18044@cindex expunging
18045@vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
18046Unlike Parmenides the @acronym{IMAP} designers have decided things that
18047don't exist actually do exist. More specifically, @acronym{IMAP} has
18048this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
18049delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
18050nnimap does when you delete an article in Gnus (with @kbd{B DEL} or
18051similar).
18052
18053Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
18054@code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
18055running in circles yet?
18056
18057Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
18058when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
18059variable.
18060
18061The possible options are:
18062
18063@table @code
18064
18065@item always
18066The default behavior, delete all articles marked as ``Deleted'' when
18067closing a mailbox.
18068@item never
18069Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
18070the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @acronym{IMAP} clients
18071may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
18072manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
18073@item ask
18074When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
18075articles or not.
18076
18077@end table
18078
18079@item nnimap-importantize-dormant
18080@vindex nnimap-importantize-dormant
18081
18082If non-@code{nil} (the default), marks dormant articles as ticked (as
18083well), for other @acronym{IMAP} clients. Within Gnus, dormant articles will
18084naturally still (only) be marked as dormant. This is to make dormant
18085articles stand out, just like ticked articles, in other @acronym{IMAP}
18086clients. (In other words, Gnus has two ``Tick'' marks and @acronym{IMAP}
18087has only one.)
18088
18089Probably the only reason for frobbing this would be if you're trying
18090enable per-user persistent dormant flags, using something like:
18091
18092@lisp
18093(setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-flag-alist)
18094 (format "gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
18095(setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-predicate-alist)
18096 (format "KEYWORD gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
18097@end lisp
18098
18099In this case, you would not want the per-user dormant flag showing up
18100as ticked for other users.
18101
18102@item nnimap-expunge-search-string
18103@cindex expunging
18104@vindex nnimap-expunge-search-string
18105@cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
18106
18107This variable contain the @acronym{IMAP} search command sent to server when
18108searching for articles eligible for expiring. The default is
18109@code{"UID %s NOT SINCE %s"}, where the first @code{%s} is replaced by
18110UID set and the second @code{%s} is replaced by a date.
18111
18112Probably the only useful value to change this to is
18113@code{"UID %s NOT SENTSINCE %s"}, which makes nnimap use the Date: in
18114messages instead of the internal article date. See section 6.4.4 of
18115RFC 2060 for more information on valid strings.
18116
18117However, if @code{nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil}
18118is true, this variable has no effect since the search logic
18119is reversed, as described below.
18120
18121@item nnimap-authinfo-file
18122@vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
18123
18124A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
18125(almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
18126variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
18127@ref{NNTP}. An example of an .authinfo line for an IMAP server, is:
18128
18129@example
18130machine students.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis port imap
18131@end example
18132
18133Note that it should be @code{port imap}, or @code{port 143}, if you
18134use a @code{nnimap-stream} of @code{tls} or @code{ssl}, even if the
18135actual port number used is port 993 for secured IMAP. For
18136convenience, Gnus will accept @code{port imaps} as a synonym of
18137@code{port imap}.
18138
18139@item nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
18140@vindex nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
18141
18142Unselect mailboxes before looking for new mail in them. Some servers
18143seem to need this under some circumstances; it was reported that
18144Courier 1.7.1 did.
18145
18146@item nnimap-nov-is-evil
18147@vindex nnimap-nov-is-evil
18148@cindex Courier @acronym{IMAP} server
18149@cindex @acronym{NOV}
18150
18151Never generate or use a local @acronym{NOV} database. Defaults to the
18152value of @code{gnus-agent}.
18153
18154Using a @acronym{NOV} database usually makes header fetching much
18155faster, but it uses the @code{UID SEARCH UID} command, which is very
18156slow on some servers (notably some versions of Courier). Since the Gnus
18157Agent caches the information in the @acronym{NOV} database without using
18158the slow command, this variable defaults to true if the Agent is in use,
18159and false otherwise.
18160
18161@item nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil
18162@vindex nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil
18163@cindex Courier @acronym{IMAP} server
18164@cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
18165
18166Avoid the @code{UID SEARCH UID @var{message numbers} NOT SINCE
18167@var{date}} command, which is slow on some @acronym{IMAP} servers
18168(notably, some versions of Courier). Instead, use @code{UID SEARCH SINCE
18169@var{date}} and prune the list of expirable articles within Gnus.
18170
18171When Gnus expires your mail (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), it starts with a
18172list of expirable articles and asks the IMAP server questions like ``Of
18173these articles, which ones are older than a week?'' While this seems
18174like a perfectly reasonable question, some IMAP servers take a long time
18175to answer it, since they seemingly go looking into every old article to
18176see if it is one of the expirable ones. Curiously, the question ``Of
18177@emph{all} articles, which ones are newer than a week?'' seems to be
18178much faster to answer, so setting this variable causes Gnus to ask this
18179question and figure out the answer to the real question itself.
18180
18181This problem can really sneak up on you: when you first configure Gnus,
18182everything works fine, but once you accumulate a couple thousand
18183messages, you start cursing Gnus for being so slow. On the other hand,
18184if you get a lot of email within a week, setting this variable will
18185cause a lot of network traffic between Gnus and the IMAP server.
18186
01c52d31
MB
18187@item nnimap-logout-timeout
18188@vindex nnimap-logout-timeout
18189
18190There is a case where a connection to a @acronym{IMAP} server is unable
18191to close, when connecting to the server via a certain kind of network,
18192e.g. @acronym{VPN}. In that case, it will be observed that a connection
18193between Emacs and the local network looks alive even if the server has
18194closed a connection for some reason (typically, a timeout).
18195Consequently, Emacs continues waiting for a response from the server for
18196the @code{LOGOUT} command that Emacs sent, or hangs in other words. If
18197you are in such a network, setting this variable to a number of seconds
18198will be helpful. If it is set, a hung connection will be closed
18199forcibly, after this number of seconds from the time Emacs sends the
18200@code{LOGOUT} command. It should not be too small value but too large
18201value will be inconvenient too. Perhaps the value 1.0 will be a good
18202candidate but it might be worth trying some other values.
18203
18204Example server specification:
18205
18206@lisp
18207(nnimap "mail.server.com"
18208 (nnimap-logout-timeout 1.0))
18209@end lisp
18210
4009494e
GM
18211@end table
18212
18213@menu
18214* Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
18215* Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
18216* Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
18217* Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
18218* A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
18219* Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
18220@end menu
18221
18222
18223
18224@node Splitting in IMAP
18225@subsection Splitting in IMAP
18226@cindex splitting imap mail
18227
18228Splitting is something Gnus users have loved and used for years, and now
18229the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
18230@acronym{IMAP} servers have server side splitting and those that have
18231splitting seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that
18232@acronym{IMAP} support for Gnus has to do its own splitting.
18233
18234And it does.
18235
18236(Incidentally, people seem to have been dreaming on, and Sieve has
18237gaining a market share and is supported by several IMAP servers.
18238Fortunately, Gnus support it too, @xref{Sieve Commands}.)
18239
18240Here are the variables of interest:
18241
18242@table @code
18243
18244@item nnimap-split-crosspost
18245@cindex splitting, crosspost
18246@cindex crosspost
18247@vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
18248
18249If non-@code{nil}, do crossposting if several split methods match the
18250mail. If @code{nil}, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule}
18251found will be used.
18252
18253Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
18254
18255@item nnimap-split-inbox
18256@cindex splitting, inbox
18257@cindex inbox
18258@vindex nnimap-split-inbox
18259
18260A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @acronym{IMAP}
18261mailboxes to split from. Defaults to @code{nil}, which means that
18262splitting is disabled!
18263
18264@lisp
18265(setq nnimap-split-inbox
18266 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
18267@end lisp
18268
18269No nnmail equivalent.
18270
18271@item nnimap-split-rule
18272@cindex splitting, rules
18273@vindex nnimap-split-rule
18274
18275New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
18276this variable.
18277
18278This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
18279sublist gives the name of the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox to move articles
18280matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
18281Neither did I, we need examples.
18282
18283@lisp
18284(setq nnimap-split-rule
18285 '(("INBOX.nnimap"
18286 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
18287 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
18288 ("INBOX.private" "")))
18289@end lisp
18290
18291This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
18292INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
18293into INBOX.junk and everything else in INBOX.private.
18294
18295The first string may contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by
18296replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
18297instance:
18298
18299@lisp
18300("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
18301@end lisp
18302
18303The first element can also be the symbol @code{junk} to indicate that
18304matching messages should simply be deleted. Use with care.
18305
18306The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
18307called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
18308containing the headers of the article. It should return a
18309non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
18310
18311Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
18312match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
18313nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
18314of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
18315unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
18316them every time you fetch new mail.)
18317
18318These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
18319end. The first rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have
18320crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.
18321
18322This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
18323be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
18324thinks the article should be split to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
18325
18326The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs to.
18327
18328To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
18329even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
18330the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
18331
18332@lisp
18333(setq nnimap-split-rule
18334 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
18335 ("junk" "From:.*Simon"))))
18336 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
18337 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
18338 ("junk" my-junk-func))))))
18339@end lisp
18340
18341The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
18342may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
18343@code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
18344Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
18345rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
18346group/function elements.
18347
18348Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
18349
18350@item nnimap-split-predicate
18351@cindex splitting
18352@vindex nnimap-split-predicate
18353
18354Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
18355split, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
18356
18357This might be useful if you use another @acronym{IMAP} client to read mail in
18358your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
18359regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
18360@samp{UNDELETED}.
18361
18362@item nnimap-split-fancy
18363@cindex splitting, fancy
18364@findex nnimap-split-fancy
18365@vindex nnimap-split-fancy
18366
18367It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
18368@code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
18369splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
18370
18371However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
18372nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
18373@code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
18374rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
18375
18376Example:
18377
18378@lisp
18379(setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
18380 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
18381@end lisp
18382
18383Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
18384
18385@item nnimap-split-download-body
18386@findex nnimap-split-download-body
18387@vindex nnimap-split-download-body
18388
18389Set to non-@code{nil} to download entire articles during splitting.
18390This is generally not required, and will slow things down
18391considerably. You may need it if you want to use an advanced
18392splitting function that analyzes the body to split the article.
18393
18394@end table
18395
18396@node Expiring in IMAP
18397@subsection Expiring in IMAP
18398@cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
18399
18400Even though @code{nnimap} is not a proper @code{nnmail} derived back
18401end, it supports most features in regular expiring (@pxref{Expiring
18402Mail}). Unlike splitting in @acronym{IMAP} (@pxref{Splitting in
18403IMAP}) it does not clone the @code{nnmail} variables (i.e., creating
18404@var{nnimap-expiry-wait}) but reuse the @code{nnmail} variables. What
18405follows below are the variables used by the @code{nnimap} expiry
18406process.
18407
18408A note on how the expire mark is stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server is
18409appropriate here as well. The expire mark is translated into a
18410@code{imap} client specific mark, @code{gnus-expire}, and stored on the
18411message. This means that likely only Gnus will understand and treat
18412the @code{gnus-expire} mark properly, although other clients may allow
18413you to view client specific flags on the message. It also means that
18414your server must support permanent storage of client specific flags on
18415messages. Most do, fortunately.
18416
18417If expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail seems very slow, try setting the server
18418variable @code{nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil}.
18419
18420@table @code
18421
18422@item nnmail-expiry-wait
18423@item nnmail-expiry-wait-function
18424
18425These variables are fully supported. The expire value can be a
18426number, the symbol @code{immediate} or @code{never}.
18427
18428@item nnmail-expiry-target
18429
18430This variable is supported, and internally implemented by calling the
18431@code{nnmail} functions that handle this. It contains an optimization
18432that if the destination is a @acronym{IMAP} group on the same server, the
18433article is copied instead of appended (that is, uploaded again).
18434
18435@end table
18436
18437@node Editing IMAP ACLs
18438@subsection Editing IMAP ACLs
18439@cindex editing imap acls
18440@cindex Access Control Lists
18441@cindex Editing @acronym{IMAP} ACLs
18442@kindex G l (Group)
18443@findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
18444
18445ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @acronym{IMAP} for
18446limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
18447@acronym{IMAP} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
18448doesn't.
18449
18450To edit an ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
18451(@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with an ACL
18452editing window with detailed instructions.
18453
18454Some possible uses:
18455
18456@itemize @bullet
18457@item
18458Giving ``anyone'' the ``lrs'' rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
18459on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
18460follow the list without subscribing to it.
18461@item
18462At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
18463``anyone'' posting ("p") capabilities to have ``plussing'' work (that is,
18464mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox
18465INBOX.mailbox).
18466@end itemize
18467
18468@node Expunging mailboxes
18469@subsection Expunging mailboxes
18470@cindex expunging
18471
18472@cindex expunge
18473@cindex manual expunging
18474@kindex G x (Group)
18475@findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
18476
18477If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-on-close},
18478you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
18479manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
18480
18481Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
18482delete them.
18483
18484@node A note on namespaces
18485@subsection A note on namespaces
18486@cindex IMAP namespace
18487@cindex namespaces
18488
18489The @acronym{IMAP} protocol has a concept called namespaces, described
18490by the following text in the RFC2060:
18491
18492@display
184935.1.2. Mailbox Namespace Naming Convention
18494
18495 By convention, the first hierarchical element of any mailbox name
18496 which begins with "#" identifies the "namespace" of the remainder of
18497 the name. This makes it possible to disambiguate between different
18498 types of mailbox stores, each of which have their own namespaces.
18499
18500 For example, implementations which offer access to USENET
18501 newsgroups MAY use the "#news" namespace to partition the USENET
18502 newsgroup namespace from that of other mailboxes. Thus, the
18503 comp.mail.misc newsgroup would have an mailbox name of
18504 "#news.comp.mail.misc", and the name "comp.mail.misc" could refer
18505 to a different object (e.g. a user's private mailbox).
18506@end display
18507
18508While there is nothing in this text that warrants concern for the
18509@acronym{IMAP} implementation in Gnus, some servers use namespace
18510prefixes in a way that does not work with how Gnus uses mailbox names.
18511
18512Specifically, University of Washington's @acronym{IMAP} server uses
18513mailbox names like @code{#driver.mbx/read-mail} which are valid only
18514in the @sc{create} and @sc{append} commands. After the mailbox is
18515created (or a messages is appended to a mailbox), it must be accessed
18516without the namespace prefix, i.e. @code{read-mail}. Since Gnus do
18517not make it possible for the user to guarantee that user entered
18518mailbox names will only be used with the CREATE and APPEND commands,
18519you should simply not use the namespace prefixed mailbox names in
18520Gnus.
18521
18522See the UoW IMAPD documentation for the @code{#driver.*/} prefix
18523for more information on how to use the prefixes. They are a power
18524tool and should be used only if you are sure what the effects are.
18525
18526@node Debugging IMAP
18527@subsection Debugging IMAP
18528@cindex IMAP debugging
18529@cindex protocol dump (IMAP)
18530
18531@acronym{IMAP} is a complex protocol, more so than @acronym{NNTP} or
18532@acronym{POP3}. Implementation bugs are not unlikely, and we do our
18533best to fix them right away. If you encounter odd behavior, chances
18534are that either the server or Gnus is buggy.
18535
18536If you are familiar with network protocols in general, you will
18537probably be able to extract some clues from the protocol dump of the
18538exchanges between Gnus and the server. Even if you are not familiar
18539with network protocols, when you include the protocol dump in
18540@acronym{IMAP}-related bug reports you are helping us with data
18541critical to solving the problem. Therefore, we strongly encourage you
18542to include the protocol dump when reporting IMAP bugs in Gnus.
18543
18544
18545@vindex imap-log
18546Because the protocol dump, when enabled, generates lots of data, it is
18547disabled by default. You can enable it by setting @code{imap-log} as
18548follows:
18549
18550@lisp
18551(setq imap-log t)
18552@end lisp
18553
18554This instructs the @code{imap.el} package to log any exchanges with
18555the server. The log is stored in the buffer @samp{*imap-log*}. Look
18556for error messages, which sometimes are tagged with the keyword
18557@code{BAD}---but when submitting a bug, make sure to include all the
18558data.
18559
18560@node Other Sources
18561@section Other Sources
18562
18563Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
18564below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
18565newsgroups.
18566
18567@menu
18568* Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
18569* Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
18570* Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
18571* SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
18572* Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
18573@end menu
18574
18575
18576@node Directory Groups
18577@subsection Directory Groups
18578@cindex nndir
18579@cindex directory groups
18580
18581If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
18582it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
18583names, of course.
18584
18585This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
18586successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
18587packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
18588back end to read directories. Big deal.
18589
18590@code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
18591enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
18592@file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
18593@code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
18594directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
18595
18596@code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
18597
18598@code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
18599articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
18600whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
18601methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
18602
18603
18604@node Anything Groups
18605@subsection Anything Groups
18606@cindex nneething
18607
18608From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
18609directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
18610pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
18611true.
18612
18613When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
18614directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
18615a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
18616After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
18617@code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
18618file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
18619few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
18620just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
18621@code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
18622file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
18623elements.
18624
18625All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
18626with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
18627newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
18628in the article buffer, just as usual.
18629
18630If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
18631a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
18632traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
18633Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
18634
18635There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
18636doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
18637will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
18638are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
18639normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
18640article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
18641other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
18642be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
18643
18644Some variables:
18645
18646@table @code
18647@item nneething-map-file-directory
18648@vindex nneething-map-file-directory
18649All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
18650in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
18651
18652@item nneething-exclude-files
18653@vindex nneething-exclude-files
18654All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
18655auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
18656
18657@item nneething-include-files
18658@vindex nneething-include-files
18659Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
18660non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
18661
18662@item nneething-map-file
18663@vindex nneething-map-file
18664Name of the map files.
18665@end table
18666
18667
18668@node Document Groups
18669@subsection Document Groups
18670@cindex nndoc
18671@cindex documentation group
18672@cindex help group
18673
18674@code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
18675as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
18676
18677@table @code
18678@cindex Babyl
4009494e 18679@item babyl
bc79f9ab 18680The Babyl format.
4009494e
GM
18681
18682@cindex mbox
18683@cindex Unix mbox
18684@item mbox
18685The standard Unix mbox file.
18686
18687@cindex MMDF mail box
18688@item mmdf
18689The MMDF mail box format.
18690
18691@item news
18692Several news articles appended into a file.
18693
18694@cindex rnews batch files
18695@item rnews
18696The rnews batch transport format.
18697
18698@item nsmail
18699Netscape mail boxes.
18700
18701@item mime-parts
18702@acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
18703
18704@item standard-digest
18705The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
18706
18707@item mime-digest
18708A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
18709
18710@item lanl-gov-announce
18711Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
18712
18713@cindex forwarded messages
18714@item rfc822-forward
18715A message forwarded according to RFC822.
18716
18717@item outlook
18718The Outlook mail box.
18719
18720@item oe-dbx
18721The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
18722
18723@item exim-bounce
18724A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
18725
18726@item forward
18727A message forwarded according to informal rules.
18728
18729@item rfc934
18730An RFC934-forwarded message.
18731
18732@item mailman
18733A mailman digest.
18734
18735@item clari-briefs
18736A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
18737
18738@item slack-digest
18739Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
18740
18741@item mail-in-mail
18742The last resort.
18743@end table
18744
18745You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
18746that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
18747@code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
18748file is.
18749
18750@code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
18751it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
18752group. And that's it.
18753
18754If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
18755new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
18756that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
18757to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
18758@code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
18759(@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
18760the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
18761using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
18762file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
18763delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
18764
18765Virtual server variables:
18766
18767@table @code
18768@item nndoc-article-type
18769@vindex nndoc-article-type
18770This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
18771@code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
18772@code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
18773@code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
18774@code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
18775
18776@item nndoc-post-type
18777@vindex nndoc-post-type
18778This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
18779a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
18780and @code{news}.
18781@end table
18782
18783@menu
18784* Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
18785@end menu
18786
18787
18788@node Document Server Internals
18789@subsubsection Document Server Internals
18790
18791Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
18792difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
18793looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
18794and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
18795
18796First, here's an example document type definition:
18797
18798@example
18799(mmdf
18800 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
18801 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
18802@end example
18803
18804The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
18805regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
18806variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
18807types can be defined with very few settings:
18808
18809@table @code
18810@item first-article
18811If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
18812something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
18813totally ignored.
18814
18815@item article-begin
18816This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
18817says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
18818complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
18819use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
18820
18821@item article-begin-function
18822If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
18823of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
18824
18825@item head-begin
18826If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
18827article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
18828simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
18829
18830@item head-begin-function
18831If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
18832the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
18833
18834@item head-end
18835This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
18836@samp{^$}---the empty line.
18837
18838@item body-begin
18839This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
18840to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
18841a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
18842
18843@item body-begin-function
18844If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
18845of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
18846
18847@item body-end
18848If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
18849more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
18850can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
18851
18852@item body-end-function
18853If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
18854the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
18855
18856@item file-begin
18857If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
18858before this regexp will be totally ignored.
18859
18860@item file-end
18861If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
18862regexp will be totally ignored.
18863
18864@end table
18865
18866So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
18867file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
18868few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
18869news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
18870something that's palatable for Gnus:
18871
18872@table @code
18873@item prepare-body-function
18874If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
18875will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
18876document has encoded some parts of its contents.
18877
18878@item article-transform-function
18879If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
18880meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
18881body of the article.
18882
18883@item generate-head-function
18884If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
18885understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
18886expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
18887called when requesting the headers of all articles.
18888
18889@item generate-article-function
18890If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
18891Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
18892parameter when requesting all articles.
18893
18894@item dissection-function
18895If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
18896overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
18897@code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
18898@code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
18899@code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
18900@code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
18901
18902@end table
18903
18904Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
18905digests:
18906
18907@example
18908(standard-digest
18909 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
18910 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
18911 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
18912 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
18913 (head-end . "^ ?$")
18914 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
18915 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
18916 (subtype digest guess))
18917@end example
18918
18919We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
18920text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
18921each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
18922the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
18923run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
18924
18925To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
18926@code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
18927is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
18928where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
18929The alist is traversed sequentially, and
18930@code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
18931So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
18932@code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
18933@code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
18934is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
18935correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
18936means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
18937
18938
18939@node SOUP
18940@subsection SOUP
18941@cindex SOUP
18942@cindex offline
18943
18944In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
18945are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
18946With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
18947
18948Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
18949@code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
18950transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
18951newsreaders.
18952
18953However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
18954easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
18955that interested in doing things properly.
18956
18957A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
18958and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
18959fiddly.
18960
18961First some terminology:
18962
18963@table @dfn
18964
18965@item server
18966This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
18967get news and/or mail from.
18968
18969@item home machine
18970This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
18971on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
18972
18973@item packet
18974Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
18975of packets:
18976
18977@table @dfn
18978@item message packets
18979These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
18980messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
18981default, where @var{x} is a number.
18982
18983@item response packets
18984These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
18985replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
18986default, where @var{x} is a number.
18987
18988@end table
18989
18990@end table
18991
18992
18993@enumerate
18994
18995@item
18996You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
18997use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
18998can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
18999s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
19000
19001@item
19002You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
19003
19004@item
19005You put the packet in your home directory.
19006
19007@item
19008You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
19009the native or secondary server.
19010
19011@item
19012You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
19013want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
19014
19015@item
19016You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
19017packet.
19018
19019@item
19020You transfer this packet to the server.
19021
19022@item
19023You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
19024
19025@item
19026You then repeat until you die.
19027
19028@end enumerate
19029
19030So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
19031reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
19032
19033@menu
19034* SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
19035* SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
19036* SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
19037@end menu
19038
19039
19040@node SOUP Commands
19041@subsubsection SOUP Commands
19042
19043These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
19044
19045@table @kbd
19046@item G s b
19047@kindex G s b (Group)
19048@findex gnus-group-brew-soup
19049Pack all unread articles in the current group
19050(@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
19051process/prefix convention.
19052
19053@item G s w
19054@kindex G s w (Group)
19055@findex gnus-soup-save-areas
19056Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
19057
19058@item G s s
19059@kindex G s s (Group)
19060@findex gnus-soup-send-replies
19061Send all replies from the replies packet
19062(@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
19063
19064@item G s p
19065@kindex G s p (Group)
19066@findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
19067Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
19068
19069@item G s r
19070@kindex G s r (Group)
19071@findex nnsoup-pack-replies
19072Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
19073
19074@item O s
19075@kindex O s (Summary)
19076@findex gnus-soup-add-article
19077This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
19078(@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
19079convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
19080
19081@end table
19082
19083
19084There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
19085thingies:
19086
19087@table @code
19088
19089@item gnus-soup-directory
19090@vindex gnus-soup-directory
19091Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
19092@sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
19093
19094@item gnus-soup-replies-directory
19095@vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
19096This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
19097reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
19098
19099@item gnus-soup-prefix-file
19100@vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
19101Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
19102@samp{gnus-prefix}.
19103
19104@item gnus-soup-packer
19105@vindex gnus-soup-packer
19106A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
19107@samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
19108
19109@item gnus-soup-unpacker
19110@vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
19111Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
19112@samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
19113
19114@item gnus-soup-packet-directory
19115@vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
19116Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
19117
19118@item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
19119@vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
19120Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
19121@code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
19122
19123@end table
19124
19125
19126@node SOUP Groups
19127@subsubsection SOUP Groups
19128@cindex nnsoup
19129
19130@code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
19131read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
19132you can read them at leisure.
19133
19134These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
19135
19136@table @code
19137
19138@item nnsoup-tmp-directory
19139@vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
19140When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
19141directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
19142
19143@item nnsoup-directory
19144@vindex nnsoup-directory
19145@code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
19146The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
19147
19148@item nnsoup-replies-directory
19149@vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
19150All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
19151reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/}.
19152
19153@item nnsoup-replies-format-type
19154@vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
19155The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
19156(rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
19157shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
19158
19159@item nnsoup-replies-index-type
19160@vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
19161The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
19162means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
19163
19164@item nnsoup-active-file
19165@vindex nnsoup-active-file
19166Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
19167file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
19168this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
19169@file{~/SOUP/active}.
19170
19171@item nnsoup-packer
19172@vindex nnsoup-packer
19173Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
19174is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
19175
19176@item nnsoup-unpacker
19177@vindex nnsoup-unpacker
19178Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
19179default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
19180
19181@item nnsoup-packet-directory
19182@vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
19183Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
19184@file{~/}.
19185
19186@item nnsoup-packet-regexp
19187@vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
19188Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
19189@samp{Soupout}.
19190
19191@item nnsoup-always-save
19192@vindex nnsoup-always-save
19193If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
19194
19195@end table
19196
19197
19198@node SOUP Replies
19199@subsubsection SOUP Replies
19200
19201Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
19202up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
19203more for that to happen.
19204
19205@findex nnsoup-set-variables
19206The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
19207variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
19208@sc{soup} system.
19209
19210In specific, this is what it does:
19211
19212@lisp
19213(setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
19214(setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
19215@end lisp
19216
19217And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
19218system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
19219@sc{soup}ed you use the second.
19220
19221
19222@node Mail-To-News Gateways
19223@subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
19224@cindex mail-to-news gateways
19225@cindex gateways
19226
19227If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
19228or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
19229The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
19230
19231Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
19232used to post with.
19233
19234Server variables:
19235
19236@table @code
19237@item nngateway-address
19238@vindex nngateway-address
19239This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
19240
19241@item nngateway-header-transformation
19242@vindex nngateway-header-transformation
19243News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
19244for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
19245transformation should be called, and defaults to
19246@code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
19247narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
19248gateway address.
19249
19250This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
19251@code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
19252For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
19253
19254@example
19255Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
19256@end example
19257
19258will get this @code{To} header inserted:
19259
19260@example
19261To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
19262@end example
19263
19264The following pre-defined functions exist:
19265
19266@findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
19267@table @code
19268
19269@item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
19270Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
19271@var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
19272
19273@findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
19274
19275@item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
19276Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
19277@code{nngateway-address}.
19278@end table
19279
19280@end table
19281
19282Here's an example:
19283
19284@lisp
19285(setq gnus-post-method
19286 '(nngateway
19287 "mail2news@@replay.com"
19288 (nngateway-header-transformation
19289 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
19290@end lisp
19291
19292So, to use this, simply say something like:
19293
19294@lisp
19295(setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
19296@end lisp
19297
19298
19299
19300@node Combined Groups
19301@section Combined Groups
19302
19303Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
19304groups.
19305
19306@menu
19307* Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
19308* Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
19309@end menu
19310
19311
19312@node Virtual Groups
19313@subsection Virtual Groups
19314@cindex nnvirtual
19315@cindex virtual groups
19316@cindex merging groups
19317
19318An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
19319other groups.
19320
19321For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
19322put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
19323big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
19324
19325You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
19326regexp to match component groups.
19327
19328All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
19329component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
19330article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
19331came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
19332shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
19333@kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
19334and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
19335(@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
19336
19337Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
19338newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
19339
19340@lisp
19341(nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
19342@end lisp
19343
19344The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
19345smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
19346
19347Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
19348idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
19349If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
19350and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
19351
19352@example
19353"^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
19354@end example
19355
19356(Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
19357shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
19358characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
19359
19360This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
19361end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
19362the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
19363sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
19364(@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
19365
19366One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
19367group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
19368zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
19369
19370@vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
19371If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
19372is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
19373articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
19374and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
19375been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
19376when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
19377have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
19378that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
19379just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
19380it---it'll have much the same effect.
19381
19382@code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
19383When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
19384has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
19385whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
19386there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
19387and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
19388not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
19389
19390@kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
19391line from the article you respond to in these cases.
19392
19393@code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
19394from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
19395inherited.
19396
19397
19398@node Kibozed Groups
19399@subsection Kibozed Groups
19400@cindex nnkiboze
19401@cindex kibozing
19402
19403@dfn{Kibozing} is defined by the @acronym{OED} as ``grepping through
19404(parts of) the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will
19405do this for you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @acronym{NNTP} server
19406down to a halt with useless requests! Oh happiness!
19407
19408@kindex G k (Group)
19409To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
19410buffer.
19411
19412The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
19413@code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
19414@code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between
19415@code{nnkiboze} and @code{nnvirtual} end.
19416
19417In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an
19418@code{nnkiboze} group must have a score file to say what articles are
19419to be included in the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
19420
19421@kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
19422@findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
19423You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
19424@code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time.
19425Lots of time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the
19426headers from all the articles in all the component groups and run them
19427through the scoring process to determine if there are any articles in
19428the groups that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
19429
19430Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
19431regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
19432@acronym{NNTP} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
19433Stranger things have happened.
19434
19435@code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
19436and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
19437
19438@vindex nnkiboze-directory
19439The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
19440@code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/kiboze/} by default.
19441One contains the @acronym{NOV} header lines for all the articles in
19442the group, and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store
19443information on what groups have been searched through to find
19444component articles.
19445
19446Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
19447their @acronym{NOV} lines removed from the @acronym{NOV} file.
19448
19449
19450@node Email Based Diary
19451@section Email Based Diary
19452@cindex diary
19453@cindex email based diary
19454@cindex calendar
19455
19456This section describes a special mail back end called @code{nndiary},
19457and its companion library @code{gnus-diary}. It is ``special'' in the
19458sense that it is not meant to be one of the standard alternatives for
19459reading mail with Gnus. See @ref{Choosing a Mail Back End} for that.
19460Instead, it is used to treat @emph{some} of your mails in a special way,
19461namely, as event reminders.
19462
19463Here is a typical scenario:
19464
19465@itemize @bullet
19466@item
19467You've got a date with Andy Mc Dowell or Bruce Willis (select according
19468to your sexual preference) in one month. You don't want to forget it.
19469@item
19470So you send a ``reminder'' message (actually, a diary one) to yourself.
19471@item
19472You forget all about it and keep on getting and reading new mail, as usual.
19473@item
19474From time to time, as you type `g' in the group buffer and as the date
19475is getting closer, the message will pop up again to remind you of your
19476appointment, just as if it were new and unread.
19477@item
19478Read your ``new'' messages, this one included, and start dreaming again
19479of the night you're gonna have.
19480@item
19481Once the date is over (you actually fell asleep just after dinner), the
19482message will be automatically deleted if it is marked as expirable.
19483@end itemize
19484
19485The Gnus Diary back end has the ability to handle regular appointments
19486(that wouldn't ever be deleted) as well as punctual ones, operates as a
19487real mail back end and is configurable in many ways. All of this is
19488explained in the sections below.
19489
19490@menu
19491* The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
19492* The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
19493* Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
19494@end menu
19495
19496
19497@node The NNDiary Back End
19498@subsection The NNDiary Back End
19499@cindex nndiary
19500@cindex the nndiary back end
19501
19502@code{nndiary} is a back end very similar to @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
19503Spool}). Actually, it could appear as a mix of @code{nnml} and
19504@code{nndraft}. If you know @code{nnml}, you're already familiar with
19505the message storing scheme of @code{nndiary}: one file per message, one
19506directory per group.
19507
19508 Before anything, there is one requirement to be able to run
19509@code{nndiary} properly: you @emph{must} use the group timestamp feature
19510of Gnus. This adds a timestamp to each group's parameters. @ref{Group
19511Timestamp} to see how it's done.
19512
19513@menu
19514* Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
19515* Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
19516* Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
19517@end menu
19518
19519@node Diary Messages
19520@subsubsection Diary Messages
19521@cindex nndiary messages
19522@cindex nndiary mails
19523
19524@code{nndiary} messages are just normal ones, except for the mandatory
19525presence of 7 special headers. These headers are of the form
19526@code{X-Diary-<something>}, @code{<something>} being one of
19527@code{Minute}, @code{Hour}, @code{Dom}, @code{Month}, @code{Year},
19528@code{Time-Zone} and @code{Dow}. @code{Dom} means ``Day of Month'', and
19529@code{dow} means ``Day of Week''. These headers actually behave like
19530crontab specifications and define the event date(s):
19531
19532@itemize @bullet
19533@item
19534For all headers except the @code{Time-Zone} one, a header value is
19535either a star (meaning all possible values), or a list of fields
19536(separated by a comma).
19537@item
19538A field is either an integer, or a range.
19539@item
19540A range is two integers separated by a dash.
19541@item
19542Possible integer values are 0--59 for @code{Minute}, 0--23 for
19543@code{Hour}, 1--31 for @code{Dom}, 1--12 for @code{Month}, above 1971
19544for @code{Year} and 0--6 for @code{Dow} (0 meaning Sunday).
19545@item
19546As a special case, a star in either @code{Dom} or @code{Dow} doesn't
19547mean ``all possible values'', but ``use only the other field''. Note
19548that if both are star'ed, the use of either one gives the same result.
19549@item
19550The @code{Time-Zone} header is special in that it can only have one
19551value (@code{GMT}, for instance). A star doesn't mean ``all possible
19552values'' (because it makes no sense), but ``the current local time
19553zone''. Most of the time, you'll be using a star here. However, for a
19554list of available time zone values, see the variable
19555@code{nndiary-headers}.
19556@end itemize
19557
19558As a concrete example, here are the diary headers to add to your message
19559for specifying ``Each Monday and each 1st of month, at 12:00, 20:00,
1956021:00, 22:00, 23:00 and 24:00, from 1999 to 2010'' (I'll let you find
19561what to do then):
19562
19563@example
19564X-Diary-Minute: 0
19565X-Diary-Hour: 12, 20-24
19566X-Diary-Dom: 1
19567X-Diary-Month: *
19568X-Diary-Year: 1999-2010
19569X-Diary-Dow: 1
19570X-Diary-Time-Zone: *
19571@end example
19572
19573@node Running NNDiary
19574@subsubsection Running NNDiary
19575@cindex running nndiary
19576@cindex nndiary operation modes
19577
19578@code{nndiary} has two modes of operation: ``traditional'' (the default)
19579and ``autonomous''. In traditional mode, @code{nndiary} does not get new
19580mail by itself. You have to move (@kbd{B m}) or copy (@kbd{B c}) mails
19581from your primary mail back end to nndiary groups in order to handle them
19582as diary messages. In autonomous mode, @code{nndiary} retrieves its own
19583mail and handles it independently from your primary mail back end.
19584
19585One should note that Gnus is not inherently designed to allow several
19586``master'' mail back ends at the same time. However, this does make
19587sense with @code{nndiary}: you really want to send and receive diary
19588messages to your diary groups directly. So, @code{nndiary} supports
19589being sort of a ``second primary mail back end'' (to my knowledge, it is
19590the only back end offering this feature). However, there is a limitation
19591(which I hope to fix some day): respooling doesn't work in autonomous
19592mode.
19593
19594In order to use @code{nndiary} in autonomous mode, you have several
19595things to do:
19596
19597@itemize @bullet
19598@item
19599Allow @code{nndiary} to retrieve new mail by itself. Put the following
19600line in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
19601
19602@lisp
19603(setq nndiary-get-new-mail t)
19604@end lisp
19605@item
19606You must arrange for diary messages (those containing @code{X-Diary-*}
19607headers) to be split in a private folder @emph{before} Gnus treat them.
19608Again, this is needed because Gnus cannot (yet ?) properly handle
19609multiple primary mail back ends. Getting those messages from a separate
19610source will compensate this misfeature to some extent.
19611
19612As an example, here's my procmailrc entry to store diary files in
19613@file{~/.nndiary} (the default @code{nndiary} mail source file):
19614
19615@example
19616:0 HD :
19617* ^X-Diary
19618.nndiary
19619@end example
19620@end itemize
19621
19622Once this is done, you might want to customize the following two options
19623that affect the diary mail retrieval and splitting processes:
19624
19625@defvar nndiary-mail-sources
19626This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
19627@code{mail-sources} variable. It obeys the same syntax, and defaults to
19628@code{(file :path "~/.nndiary")}.
19629@end defvar
19630
19631@defvar nndiary-split-methods
19632This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
19633@code{nnmail-split-methods} variable. It obeys the same syntax.
19634@end defvar
19635
19636 Finally, you may add a permanent @code{nndiary} virtual server
19637(something like @code{(nndiary "diary")} should do) to your
19638@code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}.
19639
19640 Hopefully, almost everything (see the TODO section in
19641@file{nndiary.el}) will work as expected when you restart Gnus: in
19642autonomous mode, typing @kbd{g} and @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer, will
19643also get your new diary mails and split them according to your
19644diary-specific rules, @kbd{F} will find your new diary groups etc.
19645
19646@node Customizing NNDiary
19647@subsubsection Customizing NNDiary
19648@cindex customizing nndiary
19649@cindex nndiary customization
19650
19651Now that @code{nndiary} is up and running, it's time to customize it.
19652The custom group is called @code{nndiary} (no, really ?!). You should
19653browse it to figure out which options you'd like to tweak. The following
19654two variables are probably the only ones you will want to change:
19655
19656@defvar nndiary-reminders
19657This is the list of times when you want to be reminded of your
19658appointments (e.g. 3 weeks before, then 2 days before, then 1 hour
19659before and that's it). Remember that ``being reminded'' means that the
19660diary message will pop up as brand new and unread again when you get new
19661mail.
19662@end defvar
19663
19664@defvar nndiary-week-starts-on-monday
19665Rather self-explanatory. Otherwise, Sunday is assumed (this is the
19666default).
19667@end defvar
19668
19669
19670@node The Gnus Diary Library
19671@subsection The Gnus Diary Library
19672@cindex gnus-diary
19673@cindex the gnus diary library
19674
19675Using @code{nndiary} manually (I mean, writing the headers by hand and
19676so on) would be rather boring. Fortunately, there is a library called
19677@code{gnus-diary} written on top of @code{nndiary}, that does many
19678useful things for you.
19679
19680 In order to use it, add the following line to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
19681
19682@lisp
19683(require 'gnus-diary)
19684@end lisp
19685
19686 Also, you shouldn't use any @code{gnus-user-format-function-[d|D]}
19687(@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} provides both of these
19688(sorry if you used them before).
19689
19690
19691@menu
19692* Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
19693* Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
19694* Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
19695* Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
19696@end menu
19697
19698@node Diary Summary Line Format
19699@subsubsection Diary Summary Line Format
19700@cindex diary summary buffer line
19701@cindex diary summary line format
19702
19703Displaying diary messages in standard summary line format (usually
19704something like @samp{From Joe: Subject}) is pretty useless. Most of
19705the time, you're the one who wrote the message, and you mostly want to
19706see the event's date.
19707
19708 @code{gnus-diary} provides two supplemental user formats to be used in
19709summary line formats. @code{D} corresponds to a formatted time string
19710for the next occurrence of the event (e.g. ``Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00''),
19711while @code{d} corresponds to an approximative remaining time until the
19712next occurrence of the event (e.g. ``in 6 months, 1 week'').
19713
19714 For example, here's how Joe's birthday is displayed in my
19715@code{nndiary+diary:birthdays} summary buffer (note that the message is
19716expirable, but will never be deleted, as it specifies a periodic event):
19717
19718@example
19719 E Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00: Joe's birthday (in 6 months, 1 week)
19720@end example
19721
19722In order to get something like the above, you would normally add the
19723following line to your diary groups'parameters:
19724
19725@lisp
19726(gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z %uD: %(%s%) (%ud)\n")
19727@end lisp
19728
19729However, @code{gnus-diary} does it automatically (@pxref{Diary Group
19730Parameters}). You can however customize the provided summary line format
19731with the following user options:
19732
19733@defvar gnus-diary-summary-line-format
19734Defines the summary line format used for diary groups (@pxref{Summary
19735Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} uses it to automatically update the
19736diary groups'parameters.
19737@end defvar
19738
19739@defvar gnus-diary-time-format
19740Defines the format to display dates in diary summary buffers. This is
19741used by the @code{D} user format. See the docstring for details.
19742@end defvar
19743
19744@defvar gnus-diary-delay-format-function
19745Defines the format function to use for displaying delays (remaining
19746times) in diary summary buffers. This is used by the @code{d} user
19747format. There are currently built-in functions for English and French;
19748you can also define your own. See the docstring for details.
19749@end defvar
19750
19751@node Diary Articles Sorting
19752@subsubsection Diary Articles Sorting
19753@cindex diary articles sorting
19754@cindex diary summary lines sorting
19755@findex gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule
19756@findex gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule
19757@findex gnus-article-sort-by-schedule
19758
19759@code{gnus-diary} provides new sorting functions (@pxref{Sorting the
19760Summary Buffer} ) called @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule},
19761@code{gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule} and
19762@code{gnus-article-sort-by-schedule}. These functions let you organize
19763your diary summary buffers from the closest event to the farthest one.
19764
19765@code{gnus-diary} automatically installs
19766@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule} as a menu item in the summary
19767buffer's ``sort'' menu, and the two others as the primary (hence
19768default) sorting functions in the group parameters (@pxref{Diary Group
19769Parameters}).
19770
19771@node Diary Headers Generation
19772@subsubsection Diary Headers Generation
19773@cindex diary headers generation
19774@findex gnus-diary-check-message
19775
19776@code{gnus-diary} provides a function called
19777@code{gnus-diary-check-message} to help you handle the @code{X-Diary-*}
19778headers. This function ensures that the current message contains all the
19779required diary headers, and prompts you for values or corrections if
19780needed.
19781
19782 This function is hooked into the @code{nndiary} back end, so that
19783moving or copying an article to a diary group will trigger it
d55fe5bb
MB
19784automatically. It is also bound to @kbd{C-c C-f d} in
19785@code{message-mode} and @code{article-edit-mode} in order to ease the
19786process of converting a usual mail to a diary one.
4009494e
GM
19787
19788 This function takes a prefix argument which will force prompting of
19789all diary headers, regardless of their presence or validity. That way,
19790you can very easily reschedule an already valid diary message, for
19791instance.
19792
19793@node Diary Group Parameters
19794@subsubsection Diary Group Parameters
19795@cindex diary group parameters
19796
19797When you create a new diary group, or visit one, @code{gnus-diary}
19798automatically checks your group parameters and if needed, sets the
19799summary line format to the diary-specific value, installs the
19800diary-specific sorting functions, and also adds the different
19801@code{X-Diary-*} headers to the group's posting-style. It is then easier
19802to send a diary message, because if you use @kbd{C-u a} or @kbd{C-u m}
19803on a diary group to prepare a message, these headers will be inserted
19804automatically (although not filled with proper values yet).
19805
19806@node Sending or Not Sending
19807@subsection Sending or Not Sending
19808
19809Well, assuming you've read all of the above, here are two final notes on
19810mail sending with @code{nndiary}:
19811
19812@itemize @bullet
19813@item
19814@code{nndiary} is a @emph{real} mail back end. You really send real diary
19815messsages for real. This means for instance that you can give
19816appointments to anybody (provided they use Gnus and @code{nndiary}) by
19817sending the diary message to them as well.
19818@item
19819However, since @code{nndiary} also has a @code{request-post} method, you
19820can also use @kbd{C-u a} instead of @kbd{C-u m} on a diary group and the
19821message won't actually be sent; just stored locally in the group. This
19822comes in very handy for private appointments.
19823@end itemize
19824
19825@node Gnus Unplugged
19826@section Gnus Unplugged
19827@cindex offline
19828@cindex unplugged
19829@cindex agent
19830@cindex Gnus agent
19831@cindex Gnus unplugged
19832
19833In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
19834on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
19835was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
19836read news. Believe it or not.
19837
19838Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
19839modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
19840would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
19841the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
19842have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
19843
19844Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
19845@code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
19846for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
19847functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
19848reading news on a machine.
19849
19850Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
01c52d31
MB
19851fact, you don't have to configure anything as the agent is now enabled
19852by default (@pxref{Agent Variables, gnus-agent}).
4009494e
GM
19853
19854Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
19855
19856@menu
19857* Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
19858* Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
19859* Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
19860* Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
19861* Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
19862* Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
19863* Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
01c52d31 19864* Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
4009494e
GM
19865* Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
19866* Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
19867* Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
19868* Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
19869* Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
19870* Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
19871@end menu
19872
19873
19874@node Agent Basics
19875@subsection Agent Basics
19876
19877First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
19878
19879The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
19880connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
19881When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
19882Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
19883
19884The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
19885connected to the net continuously.
19886
19887@dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
19888machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
19889
19890You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
19891shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
19892is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
19893say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
19894you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
19895
19896Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
19897that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
19898can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
19899servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
19900they're kinda like plugged always).
19901
19902So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
19903connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
19904servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
19905the culprit.
19906
19907Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
19908reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
19909server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
19910server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
19911will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
19912
19913Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
19914
19915@itemize @bullet
19916
19917@item
19918@findex gnus-unplugged
19919You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
19920Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
19921already fetched while in this mode.
19922
19923@item
19924You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
19925your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
19926to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
19927as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
19928Source Specifiers}).
19929
19930@item
19931You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
19932news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
19933@kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
19934all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
19935articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
19936
19937@item
19938After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
19939unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
19940then you read the news offline.
19941
19942@item
19943And then you go to step 2.
19944@end itemize
19945
19946Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
19947the Agent.
19948
19949@itemize @bullet
19950
19951@item
19952Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
19953back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
19954Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
19955@kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
19956Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
19957added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
19958all @code{nntp} and @code{nnimap} servers in @code{gnus-select-method} and
19959@code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} are agentized.
19960
19961@item
19962Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
19963you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
19964parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
19965is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
19966
19967Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
19968(@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
19969to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
19970parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
19971to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
19972your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
19973configure them.
19974
19975@item
19976Uhm@dots{} that's it.
19977@end itemize
19978
19979
19980@node Agent Categories
19981@subsection Agent Categories
19982
19983One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
19984newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
19985There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
19986find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
19987to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
19988mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
19989you're interested in the articles anyway.
19990
19991One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
19992downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
19993groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
19994category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
19995buffer for creating and managing categories.
19996
19997If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
19998Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
19999alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
20000difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
20001less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
20002sink.
20003
20004Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
20005a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
20006the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
20007parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
20008variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
20009of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
20010your settings.
20011
20012@menu
20013* Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
20014* Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
20015* Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
20016@end menu
20017
20018
20019@node Category Syntax
20020@subsubsection Category Syntax
20021
20022A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
20023category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
20024customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
20025listed below.
20026
20027@cindex Agent Parameters
20028@table @code
01c52d31 20029@item agent-groups
4009494e
GM
20030The list of groups that are in this category.
20031
01c52d31 20032@item agent-predicate
4009494e
GM
20033A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
20034are eligible for downloading; and
20035
01c52d31 20036@item agent-score
4009494e
GM
20037a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
20038deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
20039score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
20040
01c52d31 20041@item agent-enable-expiration
4009494e
GM
20042a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
20043this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
20044fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
20045only groups that should not be expired.
20046
01c52d31 20047@item agent-days-until-old
4009494e
GM
20048an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
20049before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
20050
01c52d31 20051@item agent-low-score
4009494e
GM
20052an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
20053
01c52d31 20054@item agent-high-score
4009494e
GM
20055an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
20056
01c52d31 20057@item agent-short-article
4009494e
GM
20058an integer that overrides the value of
20059@code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
20060
01c52d31 20061@item agent-long-article
4009494e
GM
20062an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
20063
01c52d31 20064@item agent-enable-undownloaded-faces
4009494e 20065a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
01c52d31
MB
20066undownloaded articles using the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face}
20067faces. Any symbol other than @code{nil} will enable the use of
20068undownloaded faces.
4009494e
GM
20069@end table
20070
20071The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
20072created.
20073
20074Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
20075that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
20076group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
20077category.
20078
20079A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
20080@code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
20081article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
20082predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
20083
20084Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
20085their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
20086@code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
20087
20088To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
20089download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
20090operators sprinkled in between.
20091
20092Perhaps some examples are in order.
20093
20094Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
20095for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
20096
20097@lisp
20098short
20099@end lisp
20100
20101Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
20102short (for some value of ``short'').
20103
20104Here's a more complex predicate:
20105
20106@lisp
20107(or high
20108 (and
20109 (not low)
20110 (not long)))
20111@end lisp
20112
20113This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
20114or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
20115drift.
20116
20117The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
20118@code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
20119@samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
20120
20121The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
20122you want to do, you can write your own.
20123
20124When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
20125bound to the value determined by calling
20126@code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
20127example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
20128@code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
20129means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
20130predicate to individual groups.
20131
20132@table @code
20133@item short
20134True if the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
20135lines; default 100.
20136
20137@item long
20138True if the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
20139lines; default 200.
20140
20141@item low
20142True if the article has a download score less than
20143@code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
20144
20145@item high
20146True if the article has a download score greater than
20147@code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
20148
20149@item spam
20150True if the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
20151heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
20152checksum and sees whether articles match.
20153
20154@item true
20155Always true.
20156
20157@item false
20158Always false.
20159@end table
20160
20161If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
20162to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
20163@code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
20164useful values.
20165
20166For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
20167that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
20168more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
20169something along the lines of the following:
20170
20171@lisp
20172(defun my-article-old-p ()
20173 "Say whether an article is old."
20174 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
20175 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
20176@end lisp
20177
20178with the predicate then defined as:
20179
20180@lisp
20181(not my-article-old-p)
20182@end lisp
20183
20184or you could append your predicate to the predefined
20185@code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
20186wherever.
20187
20188@lisp
20189(require 'gnus-agent)
20190(setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
20191 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
20192 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
20193@end lisp
20194
20195and simply specify your predicate as:
20196
20197@lisp
20198(not old)
20199@end lisp
20200
20201If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
20202misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
20203always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
20204just don't give a damn.
20205
20206The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
20207category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
20208individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
20209new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
20210parameters like so:
20211
20212@lisp
20213(agent-predicate . short)
20214@end lisp
20215
20216This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
20217Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
20218@code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
20219
20220The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
20221
20222@lisp
20223(agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
20224@end lisp
20225
20226The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
20227entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
20228predicate is assumed to be a list.
20229
20230
20231Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
20232normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
20233seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
20234following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
20235@code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
20236@code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
20237
20238As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
20239to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
20240it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
20241if it's to be specific to that group.
20242
20243In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
20244three forms:
20245
20246@enumerate
20247@item
20248Score rule
20249
20250This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
20251subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
20252
20253example:
20254
20255@itemize @bullet
20256@item
20257Category specification
20258
20259@lisp
20260(("from"
20261 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
20262("lines"
20263 (500 -100 nil <)))
20264@end lisp
20265
20266@item
20267Group/Topic Parameter specification
20268
20269@lisp
20270(agent-score ("from"
20271 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
20272 ("lines"
20273 (500 -100 nil <)))
20274@end lisp
20275
20276Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
20277@end itemize
20278
20279@item
20280Agent score file
20281
20282These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
20283keywords stated above.
20284
20285example:
20286
20287@itemize @bullet
20288@item
20289Category specification
20290
20291@lisp
20292("~/News/agent.SCORE")
20293@end lisp
20294
20295or perhaps
20296
20297@lisp
20298("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
20299@end lisp
20300
20301@item
20302Group Parameter specification
20303
20304@lisp
20305(agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
20306@end lisp
20307
20308Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
20309about parenthesis?
20310@end itemize
20311
20312@item
20313Use @code{normal} score files
20314
20315If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
20316your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
20317@code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
20318@code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
20319
20320These directives in either the category definition or a group's
20321parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
20322files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
20323relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
20324
20325@itemize @bullet
20326@item
20327Category Specification
20328
20329@lisp
20330file
20331@end lisp
20332
20333@item
20334Group Parameter specification
20335
20336@lisp
20337(agent-score . file)
20338@end lisp
20339@end itemize
20340@end enumerate
20341
20342@node Category Buffer
20343@subsubsection Category Buffer
20344
20345You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
20346When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
20347the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
20348
20349The following commands are available in this buffer:
20350
20351@table @kbd
20352@item q
20353@kindex q (Category)
20354@findex gnus-category-exit
20355Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
20356
20357@item e
20358@kindex e (Category)
20359@findex gnus-category-customize-category
20360Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
20361parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
20362
20363@item k
20364@kindex k (Category)
20365@findex gnus-category-kill
20366Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
20367
20368@item c
20369@kindex c (Category)
20370@findex gnus-category-copy
20371Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
20372
20373@item a
20374@kindex a (Category)
20375@findex gnus-category-add
20376Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
20377
20378@item p
20379@kindex p (Category)
20380@findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
20381Edit the predicate of the current category
20382(@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
20383
20384@item g
20385@kindex g (Category)
20386@findex gnus-category-edit-groups
20387Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
20388(@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
20389
20390@item s
20391@kindex s (Category)
20392@findex gnus-category-edit-score
20393Edit the download score rule of the current category
20394(@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
20395
20396@item l
20397@kindex l (Category)
20398@findex gnus-category-list
20399List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
20400@end table
20401
20402
20403@node Category Variables
20404@subsubsection Category Variables
20405
20406@table @code
20407@item gnus-category-mode-hook
20408@vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
20409Hook run in category buffers.
20410
20411@item gnus-category-line-format
20412@vindex gnus-category-line-format
20413Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
20414Variables}). Valid elements are:
20415
20416@table @samp
20417@item c
20418The name of the category.
20419
20420@item g
20421The number of groups in the category.
20422@end table
20423
20424@item gnus-category-mode-line-format
20425@vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
20426Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
20427
20428@item gnus-agent-short-article
20429@vindex gnus-agent-short-article
20430Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
20431
20432@item gnus-agent-long-article
20433@vindex gnus-agent-long-article
20434Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
20435
20436@item gnus-agent-low-score
20437@vindex gnus-agent-low-score
20438Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
204390.
20440
20441@item gnus-agent-high-score
20442@vindex gnus-agent-high-score
20443Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
204440.
20445
20446@item gnus-agent-expire-days
20447@vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
20448The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
20449local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
20450the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
20451just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
20452important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
20453article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
20454read.
20455Default 7.
20456
20457@item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
20458@vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
20459Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
20460retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
20461you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
20462you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
20463have to enable expiration in selected groups.
20464
20465@end table
20466
20467
20468@node Agent Commands
20469@subsection Agent Commands
20470@findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
20471@kindex J j (Agent)
20472
20473All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
20474(@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
20475toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
20476
20477
20478@menu
20479* Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
20480* Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
20481* Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
20482@end menu
20483
20484
20485
20486
20487@node Group Agent Commands
20488@subsubsection Group Agent Commands
20489
20490@table @kbd
20491@item J u
20492@kindex J u (Agent Group)
20493@findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
20494Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
20495(@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
20496
20497@item J c
20498@kindex J c (Agent Group)
20499@findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
20500Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
20501
20502@item J s
20503@kindex J s (Agent Group)
20504@findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
20505Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
20506(@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
20507
20508@item J S
20509@kindex J S (Agent Group)
20510@findex gnus-group-send-queue
20511Send all sendable messages in the queue group
20512(@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
20513
20514@item J a
20515@kindex J a (Agent Group)
20516@findex gnus-agent-add-group
20517Add the current group to an Agent category
20518(@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
20519process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
20520
20521@item J r
20522@kindex J r (Agent Group)
20523@findex gnus-agent-remove-group
20524Remove the current group from its category, if any
20525(@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
20526process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
20527
20528@item J Y
20529@kindex J Y (Agent Group)
20530@findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
20531Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
20532
20533
20534@end table
20535
20536
20537@node Summary Agent Commands
20538@subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
20539
20540@table @kbd
20541@item J #
20542@kindex J # (Agent Summary)
20543@findex gnus-agent-mark-article
20544Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
20545
20546@item J M-#
20547@kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
20548@findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
20549Remove the downloading mark from the article
20550(@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
20551
20552@cindex %
20553@item @@
20554@kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
20555@findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
20556Toggle whether to download the article
20557(@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
20558default.
20559
20560@item J c
20561@kindex J c (Agent Summary)
20562@findex gnus-agent-catchup
20563Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
20564
20565@item J S
20566@kindex J S (Agent Summary)
20567@findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
20568Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
20569(@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
20570
20571@item J s
20572@kindex J s (Agent Summary)
01c52d31 20573@findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series
4009494e 20574Download all processable articles in this group.
01c52d31 20575(@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series}).
4009494e
GM
20576
20577@item J u
20578@kindex J u (Agent Summary)
20579@findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
20580Download all downloadable articles in the current group
20581(@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
20582
20583@end table
20584
20585
20586@node Server Agent Commands
20587@subsubsection Server Agent Commands
20588
20589@table @kbd
20590@item J a
20591@kindex J a (Agent Server)
20592@findex gnus-agent-add-server
20593Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
20594(@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
20595
20596@item J r
20597@kindex J r (Agent Server)
20598@findex gnus-agent-remove-server
20599Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
20600Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
20601
20602@end table
20603
20604
20605@node Agent Visuals
20606@subsection Agent Visuals
20607
20608If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
20609active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
20610stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
20611something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
20612placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
20613there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
20614When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
20615placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
20616You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
20617placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
20618
20619While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
20620available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
20621fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
20622way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
20623less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
20624adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
20625the download status of each article so that you always know which
20626articles will be available when unplugged.
20627
20628The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
20629@code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
20630a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
20631Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
20632will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
20633other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
20634@samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
20635(@samp{ }) will be displayed.
20636
20637The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
20638are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
20639result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
20640that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
20641face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
20642tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
20643conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
20644that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
20645to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
20646
20647If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
20648each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
20649undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
20650being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
01c52d31
MB
20651downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear. For those
20652users using the agent to improve online performance by caching the NOV
20653database (most users since 5.10.2), the undownloaded faces may appear
20654to be an absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since none
20655of their articles have been fetched into the Agent, all of the
20656normal faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces.
20657
20658If you would like to use the undownloaded faces, you must enable the
20659undownloaded faces by setting the @code{agent-enable-undownloaded-faces}
20660group parameter to @code{t}. This parameter, like all other agent
20661parameters, may be set on an Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}),
20662a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic Parameters}), or an individual group
20663(@pxref{Group Parameters}).
20664
20665The one problem common to all users using the agent is how quickly it
20666can consume disk space. If you using the agent on many groups, it is
20667even more difficult to effectively recover disk space. One solution
20668is the @samp{%F} format available in @code{gnus-group-line-format}.
20669This format will display the actual disk space used by articles
20670fetched into both the agent and cache. By knowing which groups use
20671the most space, users know where to focus their efforts when ``agent
20672expiring'' articles.
4009494e
GM
20673
20674@node Agent as Cache
20675@subsection Agent as Cache
20676
20677When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
20678articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
20679Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
20680in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
20681buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
20682are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
20683consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
20684article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
20685server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
20686
20687If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
20688@pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
20689plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
20690synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
20691sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
20692
20693@node Agent Expiry
20694@subsection Agent Expiry
20695
20696@vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
20697@findex gnus-agent-expire
20698@kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
20699@kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
20700@findex gnus-agent-expire-group
20701@cindex agent expiry
20702@cindex Gnus agent expiry
20703@cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
20704
20705The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
20706least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
20707special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
20708commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
20709@code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
20710that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
20711efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
20712@kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
20713
20714Note that other functions, e.g. @code{gnus-request-expire-articles},
20715might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you to keep the agent
20716synchronized with the group.
20717
20718The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
20719prevent expiration in selected groups.
20720
20721@vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
20722If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
20723expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
20724and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
20725are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
20726be kept indefinitely.
20727
20728If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
20729perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
20730commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
20731@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
20732
20733@node Agent Regeneration
20734@subsection Agent Regeneration
20735
20736@cindex agent regeneration
20737@cindex Gnus agent regeneration
20738@cindex regeneration
20739
20740The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
20741due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
20742@code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
20743to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
20744internal inconsistencies.
20745
20746For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
20747downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
20748know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
20749failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
20750@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
20751such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
20752
20753@findex gnus-agent-regenerate
20754@kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
20755The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
20756@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
20757you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
20758recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
20759
20760@findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
20761@kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
20762The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
20763of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
20764then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
20765are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
20766agent as unread.
20767
01c52d31
MB
20768@node Agent and flags
20769@subsection Agent and flags
4009494e 20770
01c52d31
MB
20771The Agent works with any Gnus back end including those, such as
20772nnimap, that store flags (read, ticked, etc) on the server. Sadly,
20773the Agent does not actually know which backends keep their flags in
20774the backend server rather than in @file{.newsrc}. This means that the
20775Agent, while unplugged or disconnected, will always record all changes
20776to the flags in its own files.
4009494e 20777
01c52d31
MB
20778When you plug back in, Gnus will then check to see if you have any
20779changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the
20780server. This behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
4009494e
GM
20781
20782@vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
20783If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
20784never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
20785the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
20786ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
20787any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
20788
20789If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
20790re-connect, you can do it manually with the
20791@code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
20792in the group buffer.
20793
01c52d31
MB
20794Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
20795all local flags to the server, but rather by incrementally updated the
20796server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
20797the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group then
20798re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
20799removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
20800operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
20801directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
20802
20803@node Agent and IMAP
20804@subsection Agent and IMAP
20805
20806The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
20807since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
20808@acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
20809make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
20810
4009494e
GM
20811Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
20812expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
20813
20814@itemize @bullet
20815
20816@item
20817Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
20818
20819@item
20820Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
20821
20822@end itemize
20823
4009494e
GM
20824@node Outgoing Messages
20825@subsection Outgoing Messages
20826
01c52d31
MB
20827By default, when Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail
20828and news) are stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}).
20829You can view them there after posting, and edit them at will.
4009494e 20830
01c52d31
MB
20831You can control the circumstances under which outgoing mail is queued
20832(see @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail}, @pxref{Agent Variables}). Outgoing
20833news is always queued when Gnus is unplugged, and never otherwise.
4009494e 20834
01c52d31
MB
20835You can send the messages either from the draft group with the special
20836commands available there, or you can use the @kbd{J S} command in the
20837group buffer to send all the sendable messages in the draft group.
20838Posting news will only work when Gnus is plugged, but you can send
20839mail at any time.
4009494e 20840
01c52d31
MB
20841If sending mail while unplugged does not work for you and you worry
20842about hitting @kbd{J S} by accident when unplugged, you can have Gnus
20843ask you to confirm your action (see
20844@code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue}, @pxref{Agent Variables}).
4009494e
GM
20845
20846@node Agent Variables
20847@subsection Agent Variables
20848
20849@table @code
01c52d31
MB
20850@item gnus-agent
20851@vindex gnus-agent
20852Is the agent enabled? The default is @code{t}. When first enabled,
20853the agent will use @code{gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods} to
20854automatically mark some back ends as agentized. You may change which
20855back ends are agentized using the agent commands in the server buffer.
20856
20857To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
20858(@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
20859
20860
4009494e
GM
20861@item gnus-agent-directory
20862@vindex gnus-agent-directory
20863Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
20864@file{~/News/agent/}.
20865
20866@item gnus-agent-handle-level
20867@vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
20868Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
20869be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
20870which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
20871by default.
20872
20873@item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
20874@vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
20875Hook run when connecting to the network.
20876
20877@item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
20878@vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
20879Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
20880
20881@item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
20882@vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
20883Hook run when finished fetching articles.
20884
20885@item gnus-agent-cache
20886@vindex gnus-agent-cache
20887Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
20888articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
20889The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
20890
20891@item gnus-agent-go-online
20892@vindex gnus-agent-go-online
20893If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
20894automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
20895@code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
20896offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
20897other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
20898online status.
20899
20900@item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
20901@vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
20902If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
20903mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
20904thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
20905read. The default is @code{t}.
20906
01c52d31
MB
20907@item gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
20908@vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
20909If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
20910never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
20911the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
20912ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
20913any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
20914
4009494e
GM
20915@item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
20916@vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
20917If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
20918agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
20919downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
20920the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
20921are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
20922into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
20923the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
20924over and over again.
20925
20926@item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
20927@vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
20928The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
20929them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
20930the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
20931have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
20932limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
20933performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
20934connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
20935@code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
20936However, all articles parsed prior to loosing the connection will be
20937available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
20938see any cycling.
20939
20940@item gnus-server-unopen-status
20941@vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
20942Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
20943variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
20944Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
20945whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
20946Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
20947for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
20948is only valid if the Agent is used.
20949
20950@item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
20951@vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
20952Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
20953that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
20954buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
20955agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
20956
20957The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
20958@code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
20959have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
20960ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
20961(maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
20962
01c52d31
MB
20963@item gnus-agent-queue-mail
20964@vindex gnus-agent-queue-mail
20965When @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail} is @code{always}, Gnus will always
20966queue mail rather than sending it straight away. When @code{t}, Gnus
20967will queue mail when unplugged only. When @code{nil}, never queue
20968mail. The default is @code{t}.
20969
20970@item gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
20971@vindex gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
20972When @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue} is non-@code{nil} Gnus will
20973prompt you to confirm that you really wish to proceed if you hit
20974@kbd{J S} while unplugged. The default is @code{nil}.
20975
4009494e
GM
20976@item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
20977@vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
20978If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
20979@file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
20980automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
01c52d31
MB
20981which back ends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
20982to agentize remote back ends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
4009494e
GM
20983as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
20984If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
20985removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
20986start Gnus. The default is @samp{(nntp nnimap)}.
20987
20988@end table
20989
20990
20991@node Example Setup
20992@subsection Example Setup
20993
20994If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
20995setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
20996@file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
20997
20998@lisp
20999;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
21000;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
21001(setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
21002
21003;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
21004;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
21005(setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
21006
21007;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
21008(setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
21009
21010;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
21011;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
21012;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
21013@end lisp
21014
21015That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
21016edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
21017gnus}.
21018
21019If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
21020automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
21021subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
21022@acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
21023command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
21024once.
21025
21026After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
21027groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
21028command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
21029subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
21030back all the killed groups.)
21031
21032You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
21033with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
21034find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
21035
21036
21037@node Batching Agents
21038@subsection Batching Agents
21039@findex gnus-agent-batch
21040
21041Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
21042written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
21043following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
21044
21045You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
21046following incantation:
21047
21048@example
21049#!/bin/sh
21050emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
21051@end example
21052
21053
21054@node Agent Caveats
21055@subsection Agent Caveats
21056
21057The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
21058newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
21059may ask:
21060
21061@table @dfn
21062@item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
21063
21064@strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
21065@code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
21066@code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
21067
21068@item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
21069the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
21070
21071@strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
21072
21073@end table
21074
21075In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
21076articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
21077locally stored articles.
21078
21079
21080@node Scoring
21081@chapter Scoring
21082@cindex scoring
21083
21084Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
21085scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
21086something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
21087attention!
21088
21089@vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
21090All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
21091which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
21092interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
21093@code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
21094
21095Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
21096before generating the summary buffer.
21097
21098There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
21099entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
21100lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
21101
21102There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
21103Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
21104temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
21105silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
21106
21107@menu
21108* Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
21109* Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
21110* Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
21111* Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
21112* Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
21113* Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
21114* Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
21115* Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
21116* Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
21117* Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
21118* Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
21119* Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
21120* Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
21121* Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
4009494e
GM
21122* Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
21123* Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
21124@end menu
21125
21126
21127@node Summary Score Commands
21128@section Summary Score Commands
21129@cindex score commands
21130
21131The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
21132score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
21133previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
21134@dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
21135entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
21136
21137The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
21138if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
21139some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
21140score file the current one.
21141
21142General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
21143
21144@table @kbd
21145
21146@item V s
21147@kindex V s (Summary)
21148@findex gnus-summary-set-score
21149Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
21150
21151@item V S
21152@kindex V S (Summary)
21153@findex gnus-summary-current-score
21154Display the score of the current article
21155(@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
21156
21157@item V t
21158@kindex V t (Summary)
21159@findex gnus-score-find-trace
21160Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
21161(@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
21162may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
21163current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
21164score file and edit it.
21165
21166@item V w
21167@kindex V w (Summary)
21168@findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
21169List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
21170
21171@item V R
21172@kindex V R (Summary)
21173@findex gnus-summary-rescore
21174Run the current summary through the scoring process
21175(@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
21176around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
21177effect you're having.
21178
21179@item V c
21180@kindex V c (Summary)
21181@findex gnus-score-change-score-file
21182Make a different score file the current
21183(@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
21184
21185@item V e
21186@kindex V e (Summary)
21187@findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
21188Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
21189You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
21190File Editing}).
21191
21192@item V f
21193@kindex V f (Summary)
21194@findex gnus-score-edit-file
21195Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
21196(@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
21197
21198@item V F
21199@kindex V F (Summary)
21200@findex gnus-score-flush-cache
21201Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
21202after editing score files.
21203
21204@item V C
21205@kindex V C (Summary)
21206@findex gnus-score-customize
21207Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
21208(@code{gnus-score-customize}).
21209
21210@end table
21211
21212The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
21213
21214@table @kbd
21215
21216@item V m
21217@kindex V m (Summary)
21218@findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
21219Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
21220read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
21221
21222@item V x
21223@kindex V x (Summary)
21224@findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
21225Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
21226expunge all articles below this score
21227(@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
21228@end table
21229
21230The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
21231pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
21232them.)
21233
21234@findex gnus-summary-increase-score
21235@findex gnus-summary-lower-score
21236
21237@enumerate
21238@item
21239The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
21240or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
21241@item
21242The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
21243keys are available:
21244@table @kbd
21245
21246@item a
21247Score on the author name.
21248
21249@item s
21250Score on the subject line.
21251
21252@item x
21253Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
21254
21255@item r
21256Score on the @code{References} line.
21257
21258@item d
21259Score on the date.
21260
21261@item l
21262Score on the number of lines.
21263
21264@item i
21265Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
21266
21267@item e
21268Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
21269if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
21270
21271@item f
21272Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
21273the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
21274@file{ADAPT} files.)
21275
21276@item b
21277Score on the body.
21278
21279@item h
21280Score on the head.
21281
21282@item t
21283Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
21284files.)
21285
21286@end table
21287
21288@item
21289The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
21290what headers you are scoring on.
21291
21292@table @code
21293
21294@item strings
21295
21296@table @kbd
21297
21298@item e
21299Exact matching.
21300
21301@item s
21302Substring matching.
21303
21304@item f
21305Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
21306
21307@item r
21308Regexp matching
21309@end table
21310
21311@item date
21312@table @kbd
21313
21314@item b
21315Before date.
21316
21317@item a
21318After date.
21319
21320@item n
21321This date.
21322@end table
21323
21324@item number
21325@table @kbd
21326
21327@item <
21328Less than number.
21329
21330@item =
21331Equal to number.
21332
21333@item >
21334Greater than number.
21335@end table
21336@end table
21337
21338@item
21339The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
21340expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
21341or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
21342file.
21343@table @kbd
21344
21345@item t
21346Temporary score entry.
21347
21348@item p
21349Permanent score entry.
21350
21351@item i
21352Immediately scoring.
21353@end table
21354
21355@item
21356If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
21357the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
21358in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
21359
21360@end enumerate
21361
21362So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
21363exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
21364score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
21365temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
21366
21367To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
21368a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
21369defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
21370``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
21371t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
21372
21373These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
21374(@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
21375(or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
21376says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
21377current score file.
21378
21379@vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
21380The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
21381pretend they are keymaps or not.
21382
21383
21384@node Group Score Commands
21385@section Group Score Commands
21386@cindex group score commands
21387
21388There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
21389
21390@table @kbd
21391
01c52d31
MB
21392@item W e
21393@kindex W e (Group)
21394@findex gnus-score-edit-all-score
21395Edit the apply-to-all-groups all.SCORE file. You will be popped into
21396a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score File Editing}).
21397
4009494e
GM
21398@item W f
21399@kindex W f (Group)
21400@findex gnus-score-flush-cache
21401Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
21402all the time. This command will flush the cache
21403(@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
21404
21405@end table
21406
21407You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
21408
21409@findex gnus-batch-score
21410@cindex batch scoring
21411@example
21412$ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
21413@end example
21414
21415
21416@node Score Variables
21417@section Score Variables
21418@cindex score variables
21419
21420@table @code
21421
21422@item gnus-use-scoring
21423@vindex gnus-use-scoring
21424If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
21425general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
21426
21427@item gnus-kill-killed
21428@vindex gnus-kill-killed
21429If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
21430articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
21431may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
21432to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
21433group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
21434variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
21435
21436@item gnus-kill-files-directory
21437@vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
21438All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
21439initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
21440This is @file{~/News/} by default.
21441
21442@item gnus-score-file-suffix
21443@vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
21444Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
21445(@file{SCORE} by default.)
21446
21447@item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
21448@vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
21449@cindex score cache
21450All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
bbbe940b 21451score files. However, this might make your Emacs grow big and
4009494e
GM
21452bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
21453to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
21454@file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
21455@file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
21456variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
21457be cached.
21458
21459@item gnus-save-score
21460@vindex gnus-save-score
21461If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
21462scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
21463Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
21464
21465If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
21466with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
21467across group visits.
21468
21469@item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
21470@vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
21471Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
21472score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
21473ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
21474We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
21475manually entered data.
21476
21477@item gnus-summary-default-score
21478@vindex gnus-summary-default-score
21479Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
21480
21481@item gnus-summary-expunge-below
21482@vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
21483Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
21484this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
21485articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
21486and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
21487
21488@item gnus-score-over-mark
21489@vindex gnus-score-over-mark
21490Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
21491default. Default is @samp{+}.
21492
21493@item gnus-score-below-mark
21494@vindex gnus-score-below-mark
21495Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
21496default. Default is @samp{-}.
21497
21498@item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
21499@vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
21500Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
21501is called with the name of the group as the argument.
21502
21503Predefined functions available are:
21504@table @code
21505
21506@item gnus-score-find-single
21507@findex gnus-score-find-single
21508Only apply the group's own score file.
21509
21510@item gnus-score-find-bnews
21511@findex gnus-score-find-bnews
21512Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
21513default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
21514@file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
21515@file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
21516@samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
21517then a regexp match is done.
21518
21519This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
21520all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
21521
21522The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
21523try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
21524files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
21525file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
21526
21527@item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
21528@findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
21529Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
21530can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
21531@file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
21532server.
21533
21534@end table
21535This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
21536these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
21537all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
21538functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
21539that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
21540should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
21541ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
21542Phu.
21543
21544For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
21545overall score file, you could use the value
21546@example
21547(list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
21548 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
21549@end example
21550
21551@item gnus-score-expiry-days
21552@vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
21553This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
21554entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
21555are expired. It's 7 by default.
21556
21557@item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
21558@vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
21559If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
21560been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
21561controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
21562matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
21563variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
21564have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
21565
21566@item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
21567@vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
21568Function called with the name of the score file just written.
21569
21570@item gnus-score-thread-simplify
21571@vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
21572If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
21573simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
21574threading---according to the current value of
21575@code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
21576@code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
21577simplified in this manner.
21578
21579@end table
21580
21581
21582@node Score File Format
21583@section Score File Format
21584@cindex score file format
21585
21586A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
21587single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
21588everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
21589
21590Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
21591
21592@lisp
21593(("from"
21594 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
21595 ("Per Abrahamsen")
21596 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
21597 ("subject"
21598 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
21599 ("xref"
21600 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
21601 ("lines"
21602 (2 -100 nil <))
21603 (mark 0)
21604 (expunge -1000)
21605 (mark-and-expunge -10)
21606 (read-only nil)
21607 (orphan -10)
21608 (adapt t)
21609 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
21610 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
21611 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
21612 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
21613 (eval (ding)))
21614@end lisp
21615
21616This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
21617Scoring}, for a different approach.
21618
21619Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
21620@code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
21621has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
21622
21623Six keys are supported by this alist:
21624
21625@table @code
21626
21627@item STRING
21628If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
21629match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
21630@code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
21631@code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
21632these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
21633article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
21634will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
21635perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
21636perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
21637last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
21638final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
21639entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
21640to articles that matches these score entries.
21641
21642Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
21643score entry has one to four elements.
21644@enumerate
21645
21646@item
21647The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
21648be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
21649integer.
21650
21651@item
21652If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
21653element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
21654interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
21655is successful. If this element is not present, the
21656@code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
21657instead. This is 1000 by default.
21658
21659@item
21660If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
21661element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
21662which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
21663element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
21664represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
21665
21666@item
21667If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
21668element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
21669whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
21670be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
21671@table @dfn
21672
21673@item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
21674For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
21675well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
21676@code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
21677element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
21678be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
21679that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
21680one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
21681@code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
21682instead, if you feel like.
21683
21684@item Extra
21685Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
21686gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
21687case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
21688header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
21689@file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
21690host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
21691overviews:
21692
21693@lisp
21694("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
21695 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
21696@end lisp
21697
21698@item Lines, Chars
21699These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
21700@code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
21701
21702These predicates are true if
21703
21704@example
21705(PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
21706@end example
21707
21708evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
21709@code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
21710following form:
21711
21712@lisp
21713(< header-value 4)
21714@end lisp
21715
21716Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
21717the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
21718(It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
21719it's not. I think.)
21720
21721When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
21722@code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
21723up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
21724you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
21725
21726@item Date
21727For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
21728@code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
21729ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
21730this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
21731Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
21732sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
21733quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
21734
21735@cindex ISO8601
21736@cindex date
21737A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
21738date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
21739ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
21740you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
21741every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
21742for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
21743this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
21744the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
21745whole family, eh?)
21746
21747@item Head, Body, All
21748These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
21749header uses.
21750
21751@item Followup
21752This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
21753@code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
21754articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
21755you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
21756decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
21757trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
21758uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
21759files.)
21760
21761@item Thread
21762This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
21763key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
21764article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
21765match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
21766has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
21767matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
21768This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
21769even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
21770@code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
21771undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
21772key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
21773@end table
21774@end enumerate
21775
21776@cindex score file atoms
21777@item mark
21778The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
21779lower than this number will be marked as read.
21780
21781@item expunge
21782The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
21783lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
21784
21785@item mark-and-expunge
21786The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
21787lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
21788summary buffer.
21789
21790@item thread-mark-and-expunge
21791The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
21792a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
21793and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
21794says how to compute the total score for a thread.
21795
21796@item files
21797The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
21798are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
21799this one was.
21800
21801@item exclude-files
21802The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
21803not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
21804other.
21805
21806@item eval
994ff697 21807The value of this entry will be @code{eval}ed. This element will be
4009494e
GM
21808ignored when handling global score files.
21809
21810@item read-only
21811Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
21812should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
21813@dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
21814apply-to-all-groups score files.)
21815
21816@item orphan
21817The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
21818parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
21819some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
21820will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
21821
21822You can do this with the following two score file entries:
21823
21824@example
21825 (orphan -500)
21826 (mark-and-expunge -100)
21827@end example
21828
21829When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
21830threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
b1519d85 21831interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{c y}) the
4009494e
GM
21832rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
21833interesting threads, plus any new threads.
21834
21835I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
21836interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
21837scoring rules exist.
21838
21839@item adapt
21840This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
21841default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
21842adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
21843list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
21844or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
21845adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
21846scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
21847@code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
21848not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
21849groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
21850insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
21851it.
21852
21853@item adapt-file
21854All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
21855will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
21856if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
21857file for a number of groups.
21858
21859@item local
21860@cindex local variables
21861The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
21862@var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
21863current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
21864convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
21865groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
21866be evaluated.
21867@end table
21868
21869
21870@node Score File Editing
21871@section Score File Editing
21872
21873You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
21874might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
21875with a mode for that.
21876
21877It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
21878additional commands:
21879
21880@table @kbd
21881
21882@item C-c C-c
21883@kindex C-c C-c (Score)
87035689 21884@findex gnus-score-edit-exit
4009494e 21885Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
87035689 21886(@code{gnus-score-edit-exit}).
4009494e
GM
21887
21888@item C-c C-d
21889@kindex C-c C-d (Score)
21890@findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
21891Insert the current date in numerical format
21892(@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
21893you were wondering.
21894
21895@item C-c C-p
21896@kindex C-c C-p (Score)
21897@findex gnus-score-pretty-print
21898The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
21899intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
21900first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
21901you.
21902
21903@end table
21904
21905Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
21906
21907@vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
21908@code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
21909
21910In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
21911@kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
21912
21913
21914@node Adaptive Scoring
21915@section Adaptive Scoring
21916@cindex adaptive scoring
21917
21918If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
21919happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
21920stupidity, to be precise.
21921
21922@vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
21923When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
21924article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
21925these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
21926You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
21927@code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
21928words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
21929@code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
21930variable to @code{(word line)}.
21931
21932@vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
21933To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
21934the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
21935might look something like this:
21936
21937@lisp
21938(setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
21939 '((gnus-unread-mark)
21940 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
21941 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
21942 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
21943 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
21944 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
21945 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
21946 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
21947 (gnus-ancient-mark)
21948 (gnus-low-score-mark)
21949 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
21950@end lisp
21951
21952As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
21953variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
21954a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
21955pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
21956that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
21957@code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
21958entries.
21959
21960Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
21961will be applied to each article.
21962
21963To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
21964articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
21965score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
21966lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
21967
21968If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
21969@code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
21970That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
21971should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
21972
21973If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
21974the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
21975probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
21976adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
21977
21978The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
21979@code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
21980@code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
21981@code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
21982on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
21983current article, thereby matching the following thread.
21984
21985If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
21986to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
21987changes result in articles getting marked as read.
21988
21989After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
21990become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
21991the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
21992
21993You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
21994by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
21995let you use different rules in different groups.
21996
21997@vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
21998The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
21999group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
22000is @file{ADAPT}.
22001
01c52d31
MB
22002@vindex gnus-adaptive-pretty-print
22003Adaptive score files can get huge and are not meant to be edited by
22004human hands. If @code{gnus-adaptive-pretty-print} is @code{nil} (the
22005deafult) those files will not be written in a human readable way.
22006
4009494e
GM
22007@vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
22008When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
22009give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
22010matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
22011the length of the match is less than
22012@code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
22013this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
22014this problem.
22015
22016@vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
22017As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
22018headers. If you adapt on words, the
22019@code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
22020each instance of a word should add given a mark.
22021
22022@lisp
22023(setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
22024 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
22025 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
22026 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
22027 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
22028@end lisp
22029
22030This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
22031word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
22032@code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
22033score with 30 points.
22034
22035@vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
22036@vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
22037Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
22038will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
22039@code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
22040
22041@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
22042Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
22043scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
22044an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
22045variable defaults to @code{nil}.
22046
22047@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
22048When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
22049syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
22050it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
22051
22052@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
22053If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
22054word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
22055below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
22056
22057@vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
22058If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
22059won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
22060for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
22061lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
22062
22063After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
22064@code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
22065what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
22066
22067Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
22068likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
22069that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
22070rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
22071
22072
22073@node Home Score File
22074@section Home Score File
22075
22076The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
22077@dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
22078for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
22079@samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
22080
22081However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
22082a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
22083could perhaps use the same home score file.
22084
22085@vindex gnus-home-score-file
22086The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
22087be:
22088
22089@enumerate
22090@item
22091A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
22092groups.
22093
22094@item
22095A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
22096file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
22097parameter.
22098
22099@item
22100A list. The elements in this list can be:
22101
22102@enumerate
22103@item
22104@code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
22105group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
22106
22107@item
22108A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
22109be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
22110name of the group as the parameter.
22111
22112@item
22113A string. Use the string as the home score file.
22114@end enumerate
22115
22116The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
22117for matches.
22118
22119@end enumerate
22120
22121So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
22122
22123@lisp
22124(setq gnus-home-score-file
22125 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
22126@end lisp
22127
22128If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
22129@file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
22130
22131@findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
22132@lisp
22133(setq gnus-home-score-file
22134 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
22135@end lisp
22136
22137This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
22138Other functions include
22139
22140@table @code
22141@item gnus-current-home-score-file
22142@findex gnus-current-home-score-file
22143Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
22144commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
22145
22146@end table
22147
22148If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
22149another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
22150their own home score files:
22151
22152@lisp
22153(setq gnus-home-score-file
22154 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
22155 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
22156 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
22157 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
22158@end lisp
22159
22160@vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
22161@code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
22162@code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
22163is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
22164specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
22165
22166In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
22167@code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
22168(@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
22169Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
22170precedence over this variable.
22171
22172
22173@node Followups To Yourself
22174@section Followups To Yourself
22175
22176Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
22177the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
22178this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
22179articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
22180respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
22181to easily note when people answer what you've said.
22182
22183@table @code
22184
22185@item gnus-score-followup-article
22186@findex gnus-score-followup-article
22187This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
22188article.
22189
22190@item gnus-score-followup-thread
22191@findex gnus-score-followup-thread
22192This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
22193your own article.
22194@end table
22195
22196@vindex message-sent-hook
22197These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
22198@code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
22199@lisp
22200(add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
22201@end lisp
22202
22203
22204If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
22205the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
22206mine:
22207
22208@example
22209<x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
22210<x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
22211@end example
22212
22213So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
22214exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
22215myself:
22216
22217@lisp
22218("references"
22219 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
22220 1000 nil r))
22221@end lisp
22222
22223Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
22224is system-dependent.
22225
22226
22227@node Scoring On Other Headers
22228@section Scoring On Other Headers
22229@cindex scoring on other headers
22230
22231Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
22232headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
22233other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
22234that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
22235matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
22236
58333467
MB
22237@vindex gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring
22238You can inhibit this slow scoring on headers or body by setting the
22239variable @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring}. If
22240@code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring} is regexp, slow scoring is inhibited if
22241the group matches the regexp. If it is t, slow scoring on it is
22242inhibited for all groups.
22243
22244Now, there's not much you can do about the slowness for news groups, but for
4009494e
GM
22245mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
22246it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
22247a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
22248@samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
22249
22250Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
22251
22252@lisp
22253(setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
22254 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
22255@end lisp
22256
22257Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
22258@kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
22259time if you have much mail.
22260
22261Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
22262so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
22263
22264See? Simple.
22265
22266
22267@node Scoring Tips
22268@section Scoring Tips
22269@cindex scoring tips
22270
22271@table @dfn
22272
22273@item Crossposts
22274@cindex crossposts
22275@cindex scoring crossposts
22276If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
22277the @code{Xref} header.
22278@lisp
22279("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
22280@end lisp
22281
22282@item Multiple crossposts
22283If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
22284more than, say, 3 groups:
22285@lisp
22286("xref"
22287 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
22288 -1000 nil r))
22289@end lisp
22290
22291@item Matching on the body
22292This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
22293Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
22294you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
22295keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
22296and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
22297will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
22298@code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
22299the matches.
22300
22301@item Marking as read
22302You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
22303number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
22304in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
22305@lisp
22306((mark -100))
22307@end lisp
22308You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
22309
22310@item Negated character classes
22311If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
22312That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
22313@code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
22314@end table
22315
22316
22317@node Reverse Scoring
22318@section Reverse Scoring
22319@cindex reverse scoring
22320
22321If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
22322subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
22323like this in your score file:
22324
22325@lisp
22326(("subject"
22327 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
22328 (mark 1)
22329 (expunge 1))
22330@end lisp
22331
22332So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
22333rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
22334
22335
22336@node Global Score Files
22337@section Global Score Files
22338@cindex global score files
22339
22340Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
22341nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
22342in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
22343
22344What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
22345all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
22346big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
22347
22348@vindex gnus-global-score-files
22349All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
22350@code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
22351or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
22352files are applicable to which group.
22353
22354To use the score file
22355@file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
22356all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
22357say this:
22358
22359@lisp
22360(setq gnus-global-score-files
22361 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
22362 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
22363@end lisp
22364
22365@findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
22366@noindent
22367Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
22368directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
22369If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
22370use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
22371
22372Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
22373somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
22374
22375If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
22376just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
22377world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
22378wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
22379sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
22380premises! Yay! The net is saved!
22381
22382Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
22383head:
22384
22385@itemize @bullet
22386
22387@item
22388Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
22389@item
22390To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
22391@item
22392Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
22393@item
22394Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
22395lowered out of existence.
22396@item
22397Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
22398articles completely.
22399
22400@item
22401Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
22402should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
22403old articles for a long time.
22404@end itemize
22405
22406@dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
22407in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
22408Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
22409holding our breath yet?
22410
22411
22412@node Kill Files
22413@section Kill Files
22414@cindex kill files
22415
22416Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
22417entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
22418Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
22419
22420In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
22421than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
22422files into score files.
22423
22424Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
22425forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
22426sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
22427that isn't a very good idea.
22428
22429Normal kill files look like this:
22430
22431@lisp
22432(gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
22433(gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
22434(gnus-expunge "X")
22435@end lisp
22436
22437This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
22438marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
22439
22440Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
22441encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
22442interpreting it.
22443
22444Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
22445
22446@table @kbd
22447
22448@item M-k
22449@kindex M-k (Summary)
22450@findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
22451Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
22452
22453@item M-K
22454@kindex M-K (Summary)
22455@findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
22456Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
22457@end table
22458
22459Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
22460
22461@table @kbd
22462
22463@item M-k
22464@kindex M-k (Group)
22465@findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
22466Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
22467
22468@item M-K
22469@kindex M-K (Group)
22470@findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
22471Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
22472@end table
22473
22474Kill file variables:
22475
22476@table @code
22477@item gnus-kill-file-name
22478@vindex gnus-kill-file-name
22479A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
22480@file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
22481this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
22482The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
22483course) is just called @file{KILL}.
22484
22485@vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
22486@item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
22487If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
22488kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
22489kills.
22490
22491@item gnus-apply-kill-hook
22492@vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
22493@findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
22494@findex gnus-apply-kill-file
22495A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
22496@code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
22497kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
22498hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
22499kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
22500
22501@item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
22502@vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
22503A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
22504
22505@end table
22506
22507
22508@node Converting Kill Files
22509@section Converting Kill Files
22510@cindex kill files
22511@cindex converting kill files
22512
22513If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
22514score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
22515the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
22516by hand.
22517
e3e955fe
MB
22518The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Emacs by default.
22519You can fetch it from the contrib directory of the Gnus distribution or
22520from
22521@uref{http://heim.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
4009494e
GM
22522
22523If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
22524non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
22525hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
22526before.
22527
22528
4009494e
GM
22529@node Advanced Scoring
22530@section Advanced Scoring
22531
22532Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
22533really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
22534about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
22535read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
22536want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
22537
22538By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
22539scoring patterns.
22540
22541@menu
22542* Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
22543* Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
22544* Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
22545@end menu
22546
22547
22548@node Advanced Scoring Syntax
22549@subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
22550
22551Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
22552Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
22553element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
22554non-@code{nil} value.
22555
22556These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
22557operator, and various match operators.
22558
22559Logical operators:
22560
22561@table @code
22562@item &
22563@itemx and
22564This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
22565one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
22566evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
22567@code{true}.
22568
22569@item |
22570@itemx or
22571This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
22572one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
22573then this operator will return @code{false}.
22574
22575@item !
22576@itemx not
22577